You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.

24364 lines
648KB

  1. @chapter Filtering Introduction
  2. @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  3. Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
  4. In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
  5. outputs.
  6. To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
  7. following filtergraph.
  8. @verbatim
  9. [main]
  10. input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
  11. | ^
  12. |[tmp] [flip]|
  13. +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
  14. @end verbatim
  15. This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
  16. stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
  17. back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
  18. following command to achieve this:
  19. @example
  20. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
  21. @end example
  22. The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
  23. onto the bottom half of the output video.
  24. Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
  25. linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
  26. @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
  27. @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
  28. chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
  29. example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
  30. the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
  31. The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
  32. @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
  33. away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
  34. @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
  35. split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
  36. lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
  37. Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
  38. after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
  39. by a colon.
  40. There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
  41. audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
  42. output.
  43. @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  44. @chapter graph2dot
  45. @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
  46. The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
  47. directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
  48. corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
  49. Invoke the command:
  50. @example
  51. graph2dot -h
  52. @end example
  53. to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
  54. You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
  55. the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
  56. of the filtergraph.
  57. For example the sequence of commands:
  58. @example
  59. echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
  60. tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
  61. dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
  62. display graph.png
  63. @end example
  64. can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
  65. described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
  66. a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
  67. For example if your command line is of the form:
  68. @example
  69. ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
  70. @end example
  71. your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
  72. @example
  73. nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
  74. @end example
  75. you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
  76. filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
  77. @c man end GRAPH2DOT
  78. @chapter Filtergraph description
  79. @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  80. A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
  81. cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
  82. filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
  83. filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
  84. side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
  85. Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
  86. registered in the application, which defines the features and the
  87. number of input and output pads of the filter.
  88. A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
  89. output pads is called a "sink".
  90. @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
  91. @section Filtergraph syntax
  92. A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
  93. @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
  94. @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
  95. @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
  96. @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
  97. @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
  98. A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
  99. connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
  100. represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
  101. A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
  102. filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
  103. descriptions.
  104. A filter is represented by a string of the form:
  105. [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}@@@var{id}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
  106. @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
  107. described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
  108. the filter classes registered in the program optionally followed by "@@@var{id}".
  109. The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
  110. "=@var{arguments}".
  111. @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
  112. initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
  113. @itemize
  114. @item
  115. A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
  116. @item
  117. A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
  118. the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
  119. declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
  120. @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
  121. @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
  122. @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
  123. @item
  124. A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
  125. pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
  126. follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
  127. @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
  128. @end itemize
  129. If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
  130. takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
  131. @samp{|}.
  132. The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
  133. and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
  134. within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
  135. terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
  136. @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
  137. The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
  138. followed by a list of link labels.
  139. A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
  140. or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
  141. ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
  142. the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
  143. associated to the output pads.
  144. When two link labels with the same name are found in the
  145. filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
  146. created.
  147. If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
  148. unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
  149. For example in the filterchain
  150. @example
  151. nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
  152. @end example
  153. the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
  154. instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
  155. "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
  156. output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
  157. which are both unlabelled.
  158. In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
  159. specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
  160. specified, "out" is assumed.
  161. In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
  162. pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
  163. filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
  164. Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
  165. conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
  166. for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
  167. @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  168. to the filtergraph description.
  169. Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
  170. @example
  171. @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
  172. @var{FILTER_NAME} ::= @var{NAME}["@@"@var{NAME}]
  173. @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
  174. @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  175. @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
  176. @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{FILTER_NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  177. @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
  178. @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
  179. @end example
  180. @anchor{filtergraph escaping}
  181. @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
  182. Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
  183. escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
  184. section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
  185. information about the employed escaping procedure.
  186. A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
  187. value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
  188. separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
  189. A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
  190. may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
  191. characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
  192. Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
  193. need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
  194. characters contained within it.
  195. For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
  196. the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
  197. @example
  198. this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
  199. @end example
  200. This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
  201. @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
  202. @example
  203. text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
  204. @end example
  205. A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
  206. description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
  207. filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
  208. @example
  209. drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
  210. @end example
  211. (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
  212. also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
  213. Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
  214. filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
  215. escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
  216. @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
  217. previous string will finally result in:
  218. @example
  219. -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
  220. @end example
  221. @chapter Timeline editing
  222. Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
  223. supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
  224. evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
  225. the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
  226. next filter in the filtergraph.
  227. The expression accepts the following values:
  228. @table @samp
  229. @item t
  230. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  231. @item n
  232. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
  233. @item pos
  234. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  235. @item w
  236. @item h
  237. width and height of the input frame if video
  238. @end table
  239. Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
  240. to re-define the expression.
  241. Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
  242. rules.
  243. For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
  244. minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
  245. @example
  246. smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
  247. curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
  248. @end example
  249. See @code{ffmpeg -filters} to view which filters have timeline support.
  250. @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  251. @anchor{commands}
  252. @chapter Changing options at runtime with a command
  253. Some options can be changed during the operation of the filter using
  254. a command. These options are marked 'T' on the output of
  255. @command{ffmpeg} @option{-h filter=<name of filter>}.
  256. The name of the command is the name of the option and the argument is
  257. the new value.
  258. @anchor{framesync}
  259. @chapter Options for filters with several inputs (framesync)
  260. @c man begin OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  261. Some filters with several inputs support a common set of options.
  262. These options can only be set by name, not with the short notation.
  263. @table @option
  264. @item eof_action
  265. The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
  266. one of the following values:
  267. @table @option
  268. @item repeat
  269. Repeat the last frame (the default).
  270. @item endall
  271. End both streams.
  272. @item pass
  273. Pass the main input through.
  274. @end table
  275. @item shortest
  276. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  277. terminates. Default value is 0.
  278. @item repeatlast
  279. If set to 1, force the filter to extend the last frame of secondary streams
  280. until the end of the primary stream. A value of 0 disables this behavior.
  281. Default value is 1.
  282. @end table
  283. @c man end OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  284. @chapter Audio Filters
  285. @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
  286. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  287. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  288. The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
  289. build.
  290. Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
  291. @section acompressor
  292. A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
  293. Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
  294. improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
  295. of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
  296. If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
  297. afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
  298. but can also destroy a track completely).
  299. The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
  300. the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
  301. it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
  302. Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
  303. @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
  304. So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
  305. of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
  306. the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
  307. levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
  308. @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
  309. before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
  310. has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
  311. than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  312. The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
  313. @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
  314. raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
  315. source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
  316. hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
  317. The filter accepts the following options:
  318. @table @option
  319. @item level_in
  320. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  321. @item mode
  322. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  323. Default is @code{downward}.
  324. @item threshold
  325. If a signal of stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
  326. reduction.
  327. By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  328. @item ratio
  329. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  330. rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  331. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  332. @item attack
  333. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  334. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  335. @item release
  336. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  337. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  338. @item makeup
  339. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  340. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  341. @item knee
  342. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  343. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  344. @item link
  345. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
  346. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
  347. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  348. @item detection
  349. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  350. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
  351. @item mix
  352. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  353. Range is between 0 and 1.
  354. @end table
  355. @section acontrast
  356. Simple audio dynamic range compression/expansion filter.
  357. The filter accepts the following options:
  358. @table @option
  359. @item contrast
  360. Set contrast. Default is 33. Allowed range is between 0 and 100.
  361. @end table
  362. @section acopy
  363. Copy the input audio source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  364. testing purposes.
  365. @section acrossfade
  366. Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
  367. The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
  368. The filter accepts the following options:
  369. @table @option
  370. @item nb_samples, ns
  371. Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
  372. At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
  373. silent. Default is 44100.
  374. @item duration, d
  375. Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
  376. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  377. for the accepted syntax.
  378. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  379. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  380. @item overlap, o
  381. Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
  382. @item curve1
  383. Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
  384. @item curve2
  385. Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
  386. For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
  387. @end table
  388. @subsection Examples
  389. @itemize
  390. @item
  391. Cross fade from one input to another:
  392. @example
  393. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  394. @end example
  395. @item
  396. Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
  397. @example
  398. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  399. @end example
  400. @end itemize
  401. @section acrossover
  402. Split audio stream into several bands.
  403. This filter splits audio stream into two or more frequency ranges.
  404. Summing all streams back will give flat output.
  405. The filter accepts the following options:
  406. @table @option
  407. @item split
  408. Set split frequencies. Those must be positive and increasing.
  409. @item order
  410. Set filter order, can be @var{2nd}, @var{4th} or @var{8th}.
  411. Default is @var{4th}.
  412. @end table
  413. @section acrusher
  414. Reduce audio bit resolution.
  415. This filter is bit crusher with enhanced functionality. A bit crusher
  416. is used to audibly reduce number of bits an audio signal is sampled
  417. with. This doesn't change the bit depth at all, it just produces the
  418. effect. Material reduced in bit depth sounds more harsh and "digital".
  419. This filter is able to even round to continuous values instead of discrete
  420. bit depths.
  421. Additionally it has a D/C offset which results in different crushing of
  422. the lower and the upper half of the signal.
  423. An Anti-Aliasing setting is able to produce "softer" crushing sounds.
  424. Another feature of this filter is the logarithmic mode.
  425. This setting switches from linear distances between bits to logarithmic ones.
  426. The result is a much more "natural" sounding crusher which doesn't gate low
  427. signals for example. The human ear has a logarithmic perception,
  428. so this kind of crushing is much more pleasant.
  429. Logarithmic crushing is also able to get anti-aliased.
  430. The filter accepts the following options:
  431. @table @option
  432. @item level_in
  433. Set level in.
  434. @item level_out
  435. Set level out.
  436. @item bits
  437. Set bit reduction.
  438. @item mix
  439. Set mixing amount.
  440. @item mode
  441. Can be linear: @code{lin} or logarithmic: @code{log}.
  442. @item dc
  443. Set DC.
  444. @item aa
  445. Set anti-aliasing.
  446. @item samples
  447. Set sample reduction.
  448. @item lfo
  449. Enable LFO. By default disabled.
  450. @item lforange
  451. Set LFO range.
  452. @item lforate
  453. Set LFO rate.
  454. @end table
  455. @section acue
  456. Delay audio filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. See the @ref{cue}
  457. filter.
  458. @section adeclick
  459. Remove impulsive noise from input audio.
  460. Samples detected as impulsive noise are replaced by interpolated samples using
  461. autoregressive modelling.
  462. @table @option
  463. @item w
  464. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to
  465. @code{100}. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  466. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  467. @item o
  468. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  469. @code{50} to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  470. Setting this to a very high value increases impulsive noise removal but makes
  471. whole process much slower.
  472. @item a
  473. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  474. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{2} percent. This option also
  475. controls quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  476. @item t
  477. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  478. Default value is @code{2}.
  479. This controls the strength of impulsive noise which is going to be removed.
  480. The lower value, the more samples will be detected as impulsive noise.
  481. @item b
  482. Set burst fusion, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is @code{0} to
  483. @code{10}. Default value is @code{2}.
  484. If any two samples detected as noise are spaced less than this value then any
  485. sample between those two samples will be also detected as noise.
  486. @item m
  487. Set overlap method.
  488. It accepts the following values:
  489. @table @option
  490. @item a
  491. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly
  492. changed with this method.
  493. @item s
  494. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  495. @end table
  496. Default value is @code{a}.
  497. @end table
  498. @section adeclip
  499. Remove clipped samples from input audio.
  500. Samples detected as clipped are replaced by interpolated samples using
  501. autoregressive modelling.
  502. @table @option
  503. @item w
  504. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to @code{100}.
  505. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  506. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  507. @item o
  508. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from @code{50}
  509. to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  510. @item a
  511. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  512. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{8} percent. This option also controls
  513. quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  514. @item t
  515. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  516. Default value is @code{10}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  517. @item n
  518. Set size of histogram used to detect clips. Allowed range is from @code{100} to @code{9999}.
  519. Default value is @code{1000}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  520. @item m
  521. Set overlap method.
  522. It accepts the following values:
  523. @table @option
  524. @item a
  525. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly changed
  526. with this method.
  527. @item s
  528. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  529. @end table
  530. Default value is @code{a}.
  531. @end table
  532. @section adelay
  533. Delay one or more audio channels.
  534. Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
  535. The filter accepts the following option:
  536. @table @option
  537. @item delays
  538. Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
  539. Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
  540. smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
  541. If you want to delay exact number of samples, append 'S' to number.
  542. If you want instead to delay in seconds, append 's' to number.
  543. @item all
  544. Use last set delay for all remaining channels. By default is disabled.
  545. This option if enabled changes how option @code{delays} is interpreted.
  546. @end table
  547. @subsection Examples
  548. @itemize
  549. @item
  550. Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
  551. the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  552. @example
  553. adelay=1500|0|500
  554. @end example
  555. @item
  556. Delay second channel by 500 samples, the third channel by 700 samples and leave
  557. the first channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  558. @example
  559. adelay=0|500S|700S
  560. @end example
  561. @item
  562. Delay all channels by same number of samples:
  563. @example
  564. adelay=delays=64S:all=1
  565. @end example
  566. @end itemize
  567. @section aderivative, aintegral
  568. Compute derivative/integral of audio stream.
  569. Applying both filters one after another produces original audio.
  570. @section aecho
  571. Apply echoing to the input audio.
  572. Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
  573. (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
  574. effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
  575. sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
  576. original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
  577. loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
  578. Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
  579. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  580. @table @option
  581. @item in_gain
  582. Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
  583. @item out_gain
  584. Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
  585. @item delays
  586. Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
  587. separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
  588. Default is @code{1000}.
  589. @item decays
  590. Set list of loudness of reflected signals separated by '|'.
  591. Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
  592. Default is @code{0.5}.
  593. @end table
  594. @subsection Examples
  595. @itemize
  596. @item
  597. Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
  598. @example
  599. aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
  600. @end example
  601. @item
  602. If delay is very short, then it sounds like a (metallic) robot playing music:
  603. @example
  604. aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
  605. @end example
  606. @item
  607. A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
  608. @example
  609. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
  610. @end example
  611. @item
  612. Same as above but with one more mountain:
  613. @example
  614. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
  615. @end example
  616. @end itemize
  617. @section aemphasis
  618. Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
  619. emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
  620. signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
  621. this recording medium.
  622. Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
  623. restore the distortion of the frequency response.
  624. The filter accepts the following options:
  625. @table @option
  626. @item level_in
  627. Set input gain.
  628. @item level_out
  629. Set output gain.
  630. @item mode
  631. Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
  632. use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
  633. @item type
  634. Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
  635. @table @option
  636. @item col
  637. select Columbia.
  638. @item emi
  639. select EMI.
  640. @item bsi
  641. select BSI (78RPM).
  642. @item riaa
  643. select RIAA.
  644. @item cd
  645. select Compact Disc (CD).
  646. @item 50fm
  647. select 50µs (FM).
  648. @item 75fm
  649. select 75µs (FM).
  650. @item 50kf
  651. select 50µs (FM-KF).
  652. @item 75kf
  653. select 75µs (FM-KF).
  654. @end table
  655. @end table
  656. @section aeval
  657. Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
  658. This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
  659. which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
  660. It accepts the following parameters:
  661. @table @option
  662. @item exprs
  663. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
  664. the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  665. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  666. output channels.
  667. @item channel_layout, c
  668. Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
  669. specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
  670. use by default the same input channel layout.
  671. @end table
  672. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
  673. @table @option
  674. @item ch
  675. channel number of the current expression
  676. @item n
  677. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  678. @item s
  679. sample rate
  680. @item t
  681. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
  682. @item nb_in_channels
  683. @item nb_out_channels
  684. input and output number of channels
  685. @item val(CH)
  686. the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
  687. @end table
  688. Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
  689. dedicated filter.
  690. @subsection Examples
  691. @itemize
  692. @item
  693. Half volume:
  694. @example
  695. aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
  696. @end example
  697. @item
  698. Invert phase of the second channel:
  699. @example
  700. aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
  701. @end example
  702. @end itemize
  703. @anchor{afade}
  704. @section afade
  705. Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
  706. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  707. @table @option
  708. @item type, t
  709. Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
  710. @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
  711. @item start_sample, ss
  712. Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
  713. effect. Default is 0.
  714. @item nb_samples, ns
  715. Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
  716. the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  717. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  718. the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
  719. @item start_time, st
  720. Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
  721. The value must be specified as a time duration; see
  722. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  723. for the accepted syntax.
  724. If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
  725. @item duration, d
  726. Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
  727. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  728. for the accepted syntax.
  729. At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  730. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  731. the output audio will be silence.
  732. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  733. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  734. @item curve
  735. Set curve for fade transition.
  736. It accepts the following values:
  737. @table @option
  738. @item tri
  739. select triangular, linear slope (default)
  740. @item qsin
  741. select quarter of sine wave
  742. @item hsin
  743. select half of sine wave
  744. @item esin
  745. select exponential sine wave
  746. @item log
  747. select logarithmic
  748. @item ipar
  749. select inverted parabola
  750. @item qua
  751. select quadratic
  752. @item cub
  753. select cubic
  754. @item squ
  755. select square root
  756. @item cbr
  757. select cubic root
  758. @item par
  759. select parabola
  760. @item exp
  761. select exponential
  762. @item iqsin
  763. select inverted quarter of sine wave
  764. @item ihsin
  765. select inverted half of sine wave
  766. @item dese
  767. select double-exponential seat
  768. @item desi
  769. select double-exponential sigmoid
  770. @item losi
  771. select logistic sigmoid
  772. @item nofade
  773. no fade applied
  774. @end table
  775. @end table
  776. @subsection Examples
  777. @itemize
  778. @item
  779. Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
  780. @example
  781. afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
  782. @end example
  783. @item
  784. Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
  785. @example
  786. afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
  787. @end example
  788. @end itemize
  789. @section afftdn
  790. Denoise audio samples with FFT.
  791. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  792. @table @option
  793. @item nr
  794. Set the noise reduction in dB, allowed range is 0.01 to 97.
  795. Default value is 12 dB.
  796. @item nf
  797. Set the noise floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  798. Default value is -50 dB.
  799. @item nt
  800. Set the noise type.
  801. It accepts the following values:
  802. @table @option
  803. @item w
  804. Select white noise.
  805. @item v
  806. Select vinyl noise.
  807. @item s
  808. Select shellac noise.
  809. @item c
  810. Select custom noise, defined in @code{bn} option.
  811. Default value is white noise.
  812. @end table
  813. @item bn
  814. Set custom band noise for every one of 15 bands.
  815. Bands are separated by ' ' or '|'.
  816. @item rf
  817. Set the residual floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  818. Default value is -38 dB.
  819. @item tn
  820. Enable noise tracking. By default is disabled.
  821. With this enabled, noise floor is automatically adjusted.
  822. @item tr
  823. Enable residual tracking. By default is disabled.
  824. @item om
  825. Set the output mode.
  826. It accepts the following values:
  827. @table @option
  828. @item i
  829. Pass input unchanged.
  830. @item o
  831. Pass noise filtered out.
  832. @item n
  833. Pass only noise.
  834. Default value is @var{o}.
  835. @end table
  836. @end table
  837. @subsection Commands
  838. This filter supports the following commands:
  839. @table @option
  840. @item sample_noise, sn
  841. Start or stop measuring noise profile.
  842. Syntax for the command is : "start" or "stop" string.
  843. After measuring noise profile is stopped it will be
  844. automatically applied in filtering.
  845. @item noise_reduction, nr
  846. Change noise reduction. Argument is single float number.
  847. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_reduction}"
  848. @item noise_floor, nf
  849. Change noise floor. Argument is single float number.
  850. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_floor}"
  851. @item output_mode, om
  852. Change output mode operation.
  853. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  854. @end table
  855. @section afftfilt
  856. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
  857. @table @option
  858. @item real
  859. Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
  860. by '|'. Default is "re".
  861. If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  862. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  863. output channels.
  864. @item imag
  865. Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
  866. separated by '|'. Default is "im".
  867. Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
  868. constants and functions:
  869. @table @option
  870. @item sr
  871. sample rate
  872. @item b
  873. current frequency bin number
  874. @item nb
  875. number of available bins
  876. @item ch
  877. channel number of the current expression
  878. @item chs
  879. number of channels
  880. @item pts
  881. current frame pts
  882. @item re
  883. current real part of frequency bin of current channel
  884. @item im
  885. current imaginary part of frequency bin of current channel
  886. @item real(b, ch)
  887. Return the value of real part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  888. @item imag(b, ch)
  889. Return the value of imaginary part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  890. @end table
  891. @item win_size
  892. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 131072.
  893. Default is @code{4096}
  894. @item win_func
  895. Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
  896. @item overlap
  897. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  898. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
  899. @end table
  900. @subsection Examples
  901. @itemize
  902. @item
  903. Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
  904. @example
  905. afftfilt="'real=re * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))':imag='im * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))'"
  906. @end example
  907. @item
  908. Apply robotize effect:
  909. @example
  910. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*sin(0)':imag='hypot(re,im)*cos(0)':win_size=512:overlap=0.75"
  911. @end example
  912. @item
  913. Apply whisper effect:
  914. @example
  915. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*cos((random(0)*2-1)*2*3.14)':imag='hypot(re,im)*sin((random(1)*2-1)*2*3.14)':win_size=128:overlap=0.8"
  916. @end example
  917. @end itemize
  918. @anchor{afir}
  919. @section afir
  920. Apply an arbitrary Frequency Impulse Response filter.
  921. This filter is designed for applying long FIR filters,
  922. up to 60 seconds long.
  923. It can be used as component for digital crossover filters,
  924. room equalization, cross talk cancellation, wavefield synthesis,
  925. auralization, ambiophonics, ambisonics and spatialization.
  926. This filter uses the second stream as FIR coefficients.
  927. If the second stream holds a single channel, it will be used
  928. for all input channels in the first stream, otherwise
  929. the number of channels in the second stream must be same as
  930. the number of channels in the first stream.
  931. It accepts the following parameters:
  932. @table @option
  933. @item dry
  934. Set dry gain. This sets input gain.
  935. @item wet
  936. Set wet gain. This sets final output gain.
  937. @item length
  938. Set Impulse Response filter length. Default is 1, which means whole IR is processed.
  939. @item gtype
  940. Enable applying gain measured from power of IR.
  941. Set which approach to use for auto gain measurement.
  942. @table @option
  943. @item none
  944. Do not apply any gain.
  945. @item peak
  946. select peak gain, very conservative approach. This is default value.
  947. @item dc
  948. select DC gain, limited application.
  949. @item gn
  950. select gain to noise approach, this is most popular one.
  951. @end table
  952. @item irgain
  953. Set gain to be applied to IR coefficients before filtering.
  954. Allowed range is 0 to 1. This gain is applied after any gain applied with @var{gtype} option.
  955. @item irfmt
  956. Set format of IR stream. Can be @code{mono} or @code{input}.
  957. Default is @code{input}.
  958. @item maxir
  959. Set max allowed Impulse Response filter duration in seconds. Default is 30 seconds.
  960. Allowed range is 0.1 to 60 seconds.
  961. @item response
  962. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  963. By default it is disabled.
  964. @item channel
  965. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  966. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  967. @item size
  968. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  969. @item rate
  970. Set video stream frame rate. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  971. @item minp
  972. Set minimal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  973. Allowed range is from @var{8} to @var{32768}.
  974. Lower values decreases latency at cost of higher CPU usage.
  975. @item maxp
  976. Set maximal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  977. Allowed range is from @var{8} to @var{32768}.
  978. Lower values may increase CPU usage.
  979. @end table
  980. @subsection Examples
  981. @itemize
  982. @item
  983. Apply reverb to stream using mono IR file as second input, complete command using ffmpeg:
  984. @example
  985. ffmpeg -i input.wav -i middle_tunnel_1way_mono.wav -lavfi afir output.wav
  986. @end example
  987. @end itemize
  988. @anchor{aformat}
  989. @section aformat
  990. Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
  991. negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
  992. It accepts the following parameters:
  993. @table @option
  994. @item sample_fmts
  995. A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
  996. @item sample_rates
  997. A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
  998. @item channel_layouts
  999. A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
  1000. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1001. for the required syntax.
  1002. @end table
  1003. If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
  1004. Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
  1005. @example
  1006. aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
  1007. @end example
  1008. @section agate
  1009. A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
  1010. processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
  1011. Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
  1012. and dividing it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
  1013. floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
  1014. would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
  1015. time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
  1016. @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
  1017. before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
  1018. has to rise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
  1019. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  1020. @table @option
  1021. @item level_in
  1022. Set input level before filtering.
  1023. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  1024. @item mode
  1025. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  1026. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  1027. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  1028. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  1029. @item range
  1030. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  1031. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1032. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  1033. @item threshold
  1034. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  1035. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1036. @item ratio
  1037. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced.
  1038. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  1039. @item attack
  1040. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  1041. reduction stops.
  1042. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1043. @item release
  1044. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  1045. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  1046. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1047. @item makeup
  1048. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  1049. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  1050. @item knee
  1051. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  1052. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  1053. @item detection
  1054. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  1055. Default is @code{rms}. Can be @code{peak} or @code{rms}.
  1056. @item link
  1057. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  1058. the reduction.
  1059. Default is @code{average}. Can be @code{average} or @code{maximum}.
  1060. @end table
  1061. @section aiir
  1062. Apply an arbitrary Infinite Impulse Response filter.
  1063. It accepts the following parameters:
  1064. @table @option
  1065. @item z
  1066. Set numerator/zeros coefficients.
  1067. @item p
  1068. Set denominator/poles coefficients.
  1069. @item k
  1070. Set channels gains.
  1071. @item dry_gain
  1072. Set input gain.
  1073. @item wet_gain
  1074. Set output gain.
  1075. @item f
  1076. Set coefficients format.
  1077. @table @samp
  1078. @item tf
  1079. transfer function
  1080. @item zp
  1081. Z-plane zeros/poles, cartesian (default)
  1082. @item pr
  1083. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar radians
  1084. @item pd
  1085. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar degrees
  1086. @end table
  1087. @item r
  1088. Set kind of processing.
  1089. Can be @code{d} - direct or @code{s} - serial cascading. Default is @code{s}.
  1090. @item e
  1091. Set filtering precision.
  1092. @table @samp
  1093. @item dbl
  1094. double-precision floating-point (default)
  1095. @item flt
  1096. single-precision floating-point
  1097. @item i32
  1098. 32-bit integers
  1099. @item i16
  1100. 16-bit integers
  1101. @end table
  1102. @item mix
  1103. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1104. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1105. @item response
  1106. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  1107. By default it is disabled.
  1108. @item channel
  1109. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  1110. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1111. @item size
  1112. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1113. @end table
  1114. Coefficients in @code{tf} format are separated by spaces and are in ascending
  1115. order.
  1116. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are separated by spaces and order of coefficients
  1117. doesn't matter. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are complex numbers with @var{i}
  1118. imaginary unit.
  1119. Different coefficients and gains can be provided for every channel, in such case
  1120. use '|' to separate coefficients or gains. Last provided coefficients will be
  1121. used for all remaining channels.
  1122. @subsection Examples
  1123. @itemize
  1124. @item
  1125. Apply 2 pole elliptic notch at around 5000Hz for 48000 Hz sample rate:
  1126. @example
  1127. aiir=k=1:z=7.957584807809675810E-1 -2.575128568908332300 3.674839853930788710 -2.57512875289799137 7.957586296317130880E-1:p=1 -2.86950072432325953 3.63022088054647218 -2.28075678147272232 6.361362326477423500E-1:f=tf:r=d
  1128. @end example
  1129. @item
  1130. Same as above but in @code{zp} format:
  1131. @example
  1132. aiir=k=0.79575848078096756:z=0.80918701+0.58773007i 0.80918701-0.58773007i 0.80884700+0.58784055i 0.80884700-0.58784055i:p=0.63892345+0.59951235i 0.63892345-0.59951235i 0.79582691+0.44198673i 0.79582691-0.44198673i:f=zp:r=s
  1133. @end example
  1134. @end itemize
  1135. @section alimiter
  1136. The limiter prevents an input signal from rising over a desired threshold.
  1137. This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
  1138. It means that there is a small delay after the signal is processed. Keep in mind
  1139. that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
  1140. The filter accepts the following options:
  1141. @table @option
  1142. @item level_in
  1143. Set input gain. Default is 1.
  1144. @item level_out
  1145. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  1146. @item limit
  1147. Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
  1148. @item attack
  1149. The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
  1150. milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
  1151. @item release
  1152. Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
  1153. Default is 50 milliseconds.
  1154. @item asc
  1155. When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
  1156. average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
  1157. time.
  1158. @item asc_level
  1159. Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
  1160. in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
  1161. @item level
  1162. Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
  1163. This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
  1164. @end table
  1165. Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
  1166. with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
  1167. @section allpass
  1168. Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
  1169. @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
  1170. An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
  1171. without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
  1172. The filter accepts the following options:
  1173. @table @option
  1174. @item frequency, f
  1175. Set frequency in Hz.
  1176. @item width_type, t
  1177. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1178. @table @option
  1179. @item h
  1180. Hz
  1181. @item q
  1182. Q-Factor
  1183. @item o
  1184. octave
  1185. @item s
  1186. slope
  1187. @item k
  1188. kHz
  1189. @end table
  1190. @item width, w
  1191. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1192. @item mix, m
  1193. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1194. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1195. @item channels, c
  1196. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1197. @end table
  1198. @subsection Commands
  1199. This filter supports the following commands:
  1200. @table @option
  1201. @item frequency, f
  1202. Change allpass frequency.
  1203. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  1204. @item width_type, t
  1205. Change allpass width_type.
  1206. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  1207. @item width, w
  1208. Change allpass width.
  1209. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  1210. @item mix, m
  1211. Change allpass mix.
  1212. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  1213. @end table
  1214. @section aloop
  1215. Loop audio samples.
  1216. The filter accepts the following options:
  1217. @table @option
  1218. @item loop
  1219. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  1220. Default is 0.
  1221. @item size
  1222. Set maximal number of samples. Default is 0.
  1223. @item start
  1224. Set first sample of loop. Default is 0.
  1225. @end table
  1226. @anchor{amerge}
  1227. @section amerge
  1228. Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
  1229. The filter accepts the following options:
  1230. @table @option
  1231. @item inputs
  1232. Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
  1233. @end table
  1234. If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
  1235. the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
  1236. will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
  1237. disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
  1238. the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
  1239. the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
  1240. channels.
  1241. For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
  1242. is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
  1243. following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
  1244. first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
  1245. On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
  1246. in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
  1247. arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
  1248. All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
  1249. If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
  1250. shortest.
  1251. @subsection Examples
  1252. @itemize
  1253. @item
  1254. Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
  1255. @example
  1256. amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
  1257. @end example
  1258. @item
  1259. Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
  1260. @example
  1261. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
  1262. @end example
  1263. @end itemize
  1264. @section amix
  1265. Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
  1266. Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
  1267. and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
  1268. input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
  1269. inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
  1270. For example
  1271. @example
  1272. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
  1273. @end example
  1274. will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
  1275. first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
  1276. It accepts the following parameters:
  1277. @table @option
  1278. @item inputs
  1279. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  1280. @item duration
  1281. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  1282. @table @option
  1283. @item longest
  1284. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  1285. @item shortest
  1286. The duration of the shortest input.
  1287. @item first
  1288. The duration of the first input.
  1289. @end table
  1290. @item dropout_transition
  1291. The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
  1292. stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
  1293. @item weights
  1294. Specify weight of each input audio stream as sequence.
  1295. Each weight is separated by space. By default all inputs have same weight.
  1296. @end table
  1297. @section amultiply
  1298. Multiply first audio stream with second audio stream and store result
  1299. in output audio stream. Multiplication is done by multiplying each
  1300. sample from first stream with sample at same position from second stream.
  1301. With this element-wise multiplication one can create amplitude fades and
  1302. amplitude modulations.
  1303. @section anequalizer
  1304. High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
  1305. It accepts the following parameters:
  1306. @table @option
  1307. @item params
  1308. This option string is in format:
  1309. "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
  1310. Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
  1311. @table @option
  1312. @item chn
  1313. Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
  1314. If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
  1315. @item f
  1316. Set central frequency for band.
  1317. If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
  1318. @item w
  1319. Set band width in hertz.
  1320. @item g
  1321. Set band gain in dB.
  1322. @item t
  1323. Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
  1324. @table @samp
  1325. @item 0
  1326. Butterworth, this is default.
  1327. @item 1
  1328. Chebyshev type 1.
  1329. @item 2
  1330. Chebyshev type 2.
  1331. @end table
  1332. @end table
  1333. @item curves
  1334. With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
  1335. in video stream.
  1336. @item size
  1337. Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1338. @item mgain
  1339. Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1340. Setting this to a reasonable value makes it possible to display gain which is derived from
  1341. neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
  1342. when both are activated.
  1343. @item fscale
  1344. Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
  1345. Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
  1346. @item colors
  1347. Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
  1348. This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
  1349. Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
  1350. @end table
  1351. @subsection Examples
  1352. @itemize
  1353. @item
  1354. Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
  1355. for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
  1356. @example
  1357. anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
  1358. @end example
  1359. @end itemize
  1360. @subsection Commands
  1361. This filter supports the following commands:
  1362. @table @option
  1363. @item change
  1364. Alter existing filter parameters.
  1365. Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
  1366. @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
  1367. error is returned.
  1368. @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
  1369. @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
  1370. @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
  1371. Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
  1372. asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
  1373. @end table
  1374. @section anlmdn
  1375. Reduce broadband noise in audio samples using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  1376. Each sample is adjusted by looking for other samples with similar contexts. This
  1377. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  1378. @option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r} around the sample.
  1379. The filter accepts the following options:
  1380. @table @option
  1381. @item s
  1382. Set denoising strength. Allowed range is from 0.00001 to 10. Default value is 0.00001.
  1383. @item p
  1384. Set patch radius duration. Allowed range is from 1 to 100 milliseconds.
  1385. Default value is 2 milliseconds.
  1386. @item r
  1387. Set research radius duration. Allowed range is from 2 to 300 milliseconds.
  1388. Default value is 6 milliseconds.
  1389. @item o
  1390. Set the output mode.
  1391. It accepts the following values:
  1392. @table @option
  1393. @item i
  1394. Pass input unchanged.
  1395. @item o
  1396. Pass noise filtered out.
  1397. @item n
  1398. Pass only noise.
  1399. Default value is @var{o}.
  1400. @end table
  1401. @item m
  1402. Set smooth factor. Default value is @var{11}. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{15}.
  1403. @end table
  1404. @subsection Commands
  1405. This filter supports the following commands:
  1406. @table @option
  1407. @item s
  1408. Change denoise strength. Argument is single float number.
  1409. Syntax for the command is : "@var{s}"
  1410. @item o
  1411. Change output mode.
  1412. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  1413. @end table
  1414. @section anlms
  1415. Apply Normalized Least-Mean-Squares algorithm to the first audio stream using the second audio stream.
  1416. This adaptive filter is used to mimic a desired filter by finding the filter coefficients that
  1417. relate to producing the least mean square of the error signal (difference between the desired,
  1418. 2nd input audio stream and the actual signal, the 1st input audio stream).
  1419. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1420. @table @option
  1421. @item order
  1422. Set filter order.
  1423. @item mu
  1424. Set filter mu.
  1425. @item eps
  1426. Set the filter eps.
  1427. @item leakage
  1428. Set the filter leakage.
  1429. @item out_mode
  1430. It accepts the following values:
  1431. @table @option
  1432. @item i
  1433. Pass the 1st input.
  1434. @item d
  1435. Pass the 2nd input.
  1436. @item o
  1437. Pass filtered samples.
  1438. @item n
  1439. Pass difference between desired and filtered samples.
  1440. Default value is @var{o}.
  1441. @end table
  1442. @end table
  1443. @subsection Examples
  1444. @itemize
  1445. @item
  1446. One of many usages of this filter is noise reduction, input audio is filtered
  1447. with same samples that are delayed by fixed amount, one such example for stereo audio is:
  1448. @example
  1449. asplit[a][b],[a]adelay=32S|32S[a],[b][a]anlms=order=128:leakage=0.0005:mu=.5:out_mode=o
  1450. @end example
  1451. @end itemize
  1452. @subsection Commands
  1453. This filter supports the same commands as options, excluding option @code{order}.
  1454. @section anull
  1455. Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
  1456. @section apad
  1457. Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
  1458. This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
  1459. extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
  1460. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1461. @table @option
  1462. @item packet_size
  1463. Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
  1464. @item pad_len
  1465. Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
  1466. value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
  1467. exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
  1468. @item whole_len
  1469. Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
  1470. the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
  1471. the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
  1472. with @option{pad_len}.
  1473. @item pad_dur
  1474. Specify the duration of samples of silence to add. See
  1475. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1476. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value.
  1477. @item whole_dur
  1478. Specify the minimum total duration in the output audio stream. See
  1479. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1480. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value. If the value is longer than
  1481. the input audio length, silence is added to the end, until the value is reached.
  1482. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{pad_dur}
  1483. @end table
  1484. If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} nor @option{pad_dur}
  1485. nor @option{whole_dur} option is set, the filter will add silence to the end of
  1486. the input stream indefinitely.
  1487. @subsection Examples
  1488. @itemize
  1489. @item
  1490. Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
  1491. @example
  1492. apad=pad_len=1024
  1493. @end example
  1494. @item
  1495. Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
  1496. the input with silence if required:
  1497. @example
  1498. apad=whole_len=10000
  1499. @end example
  1500. @item
  1501. Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
  1502. video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
  1503. until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
  1504. option:
  1505. @example
  1506. ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
  1507. @end example
  1508. @end itemize
  1509. @section aphaser
  1510. Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
  1511. A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
  1512. The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
  1513. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  1514. @table @option
  1515. @item in_gain
  1516. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1517. @item out_gain
  1518. Set output gain. Default is 0.74
  1519. @item delay
  1520. Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
  1521. @item decay
  1522. Set decay. Default is 0.4.
  1523. @item speed
  1524. Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
  1525. @item type
  1526. Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
  1527. It accepts the following values:
  1528. @table @samp
  1529. @item triangular, t
  1530. @item sinusoidal, s
  1531. @end table
  1532. @end table
  1533. @section apulsator
  1534. Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
  1535. But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
  1536. of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
  1537. different waveforms and shifted phases.
  1538. This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
  1539. channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
  1540. The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
  1541. An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
  1542. in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
  1543. an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
  1544. phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
  1545. sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
  1546. the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
  1547. The filter accepts the following options:
  1548. @table @option
  1549. @item level_in
  1550. Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1551. @item level_out
  1552. Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1553. @item mode
  1554. Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
  1555. sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
  1556. @item amount
  1557. Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
  1558. @item offset_l
  1559. Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1560. @item offset_r
  1561. Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1562. @item width
  1563. Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
  1564. @item timing
  1565. Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
  1566. @item bpm
  1567. Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
  1568. is set to bpm.
  1569. @item ms
  1570. Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
  1571. is set to ms.
  1572. @item hz
  1573. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
  1574. if timing is set to hz.
  1575. @end table
  1576. @anchor{aresample}
  1577. @section aresample
  1578. Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
  1579. libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
  1580. automatically convert between its input and output.
  1581. This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
  1582. the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
  1583. timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
  1584. The filter accepts the syntax
  1585. [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
  1586. expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
  1587. @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
  1588. @ref{Resampler Options,,"Resampler Options" section in the
  1589. ffmpeg-resampler(1) manual,ffmpeg-resampler}
  1590. for the complete list of supported options.
  1591. @subsection Examples
  1592. @itemize
  1593. @item
  1594. Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
  1595. @example
  1596. aresample=44100
  1597. @end example
  1598. @item
  1599. Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
  1600. samples per second compensation:
  1601. @example
  1602. aresample=async=1000
  1603. @end example
  1604. @end itemize
  1605. @section areverse
  1606. Reverse an audio clip.
  1607. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  1608. is suggested.
  1609. @subsection Examples
  1610. @itemize
  1611. @item
  1612. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  1613. @example
  1614. atrim=end=5,areverse
  1615. @end example
  1616. @end itemize
  1617. @section arnndn
  1618. Reduce noise from speech using Recurrent Neural Networks.
  1619. This filter accepts the following options:
  1620. @table @option
  1621. @item model, m
  1622. Set train model file to load. This option is always required.
  1623. @end table
  1624. @section asetnsamples
  1625. Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
  1626. The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
  1627. the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
  1628. signals its end.
  1629. The filter accepts the following options:
  1630. @table @option
  1631. @item nb_out_samples, n
  1632. Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
  1633. intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
  1634. Default value is 1024.
  1635. @item pad, p
  1636. If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
  1637. that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
  1638. previous ones. Default value is 1.
  1639. @end table
  1640. For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
  1641. disable padding for the last frame, use:
  1642. @example
  1643. asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
  1644. @end example
  1645. @section asetrate
  1646. Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
  1647. This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
  1648. The filter accepts the following options:
  1649. @table @option
  1650. @item sample_rate, r
  1651. Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
  1652. @end table
  1653. @section ashowinfo
  1654. Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
  1655. The input audio is not modified.
  1656. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  1657. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  1658. The following values are shown in the output:
  1659. @table @option
  1660. @item n
  1661. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  1662. @item pts
  1663. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
  1664. depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
  1665. @item pts_time
  1666. The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
  1667. @item pos
  1668. position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
  1669. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
  1670. @item fmt
  1671. The sample format.
  1672. @item chlayout
  1673. The channel layout.
  1674. @item rate
  1675. The sample rate for the audio frame.
  1676. @item nb_samples
  1677. The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
  1678. @item checksum
  1679. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
  1680. audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
  1681. @item plane_checksums
  1682. A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
  1683. @end table
  1684. @section asoftclip
  1685. Apply audio soft clipping.
  1686. Soft clipping is a type of distortion effect where the amplitude of a signal is saturated
  1687. along a smooth curve, rather than the abrupt shape of hard-clipping.
  1688. This filter accepts the following options:
  1689. @table @option
  1690. @item type
  1691. Set type of soft-clipping.
  1692. It accepts the following values:
  1693. @table @option
  1694. @item tanh
  1695. @item atan
  1696. @item cubic
  1697. @item exp
  1698. @item alg
  1699. @item quintic
  1700. @item sin
  1701. @end table
  1702. @item param
  1703. Set additional parameter which controls sigmoid function.
  1704. @end table
  1705. @section asr
  1706. Automatic Speech Recognition
  1707. This filter uses PocketSphinx for speech recognition. To enable
  1708. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  1709. @code{--enable-pocketsphinx}.
  1710. It accepts the following options:
  1711. @table @option
  1712. @item rate
  1713. Set sampling rate of input audio. Defaults is @code{16000}.
  1714. This need to match speech models, otherwise one will get poor results.
  1715. @item hmm
  1716. Set dictionary containing acoustic model files.
  1717. @item dict
  1718. Set pronunciation dictionary.
  1719. @item lm
  1720. Set language model file.
  1721. @item lmctl
  1722. Set language model set.
  1723. @item lmname
  1724. Set which language model to use.
  1725. @item logfn
  1726. Set output for log messages.
  1727. @end table
  1728. The filter exports recognized speech as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.asr.text}.
  1729. @anchor{astats}
  1730. @section astats
  1731. Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
  1732. Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
  1733. where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
  1734. It accepts the following option:
  1735. @table @option
  1736. @item length
  1737. Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
  1738. Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 10]}.
  1739. @item metadata
  1740. Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
  1741. where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
  1742. disabled.
  1743. Available keys for each channel are:
  1744. DC_offset
  1745. Min_level
  1746. Max_level
  1747. Min_difference
  1748. Max_difference
  1749. Mean_difference
  1750. RMS_difference
  1751. Peak_level
  1752. RMS_peak
  1753. RMS_trough
  1754. Crest_factor
  1755. Flat_factor
  1756. Peak_count
  1757. Bit_depth
  1758. Dynamic_range
  1759. Zero_crossings
  1760. Zero_crossings_rate
  1761. Number_of_NaNs
  1762. Number_of_Infs
  1763. Number_of_denormals
  1764. and for Overall:
  1765. DC_offset
  1766. Min_level
  1767. Max_level
  1768. Min_difference
  1769. Max_difference
  1770. Mean_difference
  1771. RMS_difference
  1772. Peak_level
  1773. RMS_level
  1774. RMS_peak
  1775. RMS_trough
  1776. Flat_factor
  1777. Peak_count
  1778. Bit_depth
  1779. Number_of_samples
  1780. Number_of_NaNs
  1781. Number_of_Infs
  1782. Number_of_denormals
  1783. For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
  1784. this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
  1785. For description what each key means read below.
  1786. @item reset
  1787. Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
  1788. Default is disabled.
  1789. @item measure_perchannel
  1790. Select the entries which need to be measured per channel. The metadata keys can
  1791. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1792. @option{none} disables all per channel measurement.
  1793. @item measure_overall
  1794. Select the entries which need to be measured overall. The metadata keys can
  1795. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1796. @option{none} disables all overall measurement.
  1797. @end table
  1798. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  1799. @table @option
  1800. @item DC offset
  1801. Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
  1802. @item Min level
  1803. Minimal sample level.
  1804. @item Max level
  1805. Maximal sample level.
  1806. @item Min difference
  1807. Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1808. @item Max difference
  1809. Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1810. @item Mean difference
  1811. Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
  1812. The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
  1813. @item RMS difference
  1814. Root Mean Square difference between two consecutive samples.
  1815. @item Peak level dB
  1816. @item RMS level dB
  1817. Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
  1818. @item RMS peak dB
  1819. @item RMS trough dB
  1820. Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
  1821. @item Crest factor
  1822. Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
  1823. @item Flat factor
  1824. Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
  1825. (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
  1826. @item Peak count
  1827. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
  1828. @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
  1829. @item Bit depth
  1830. Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
  1831. @item Dynamic range
  1832. Measured dynamic range of audio in dB.
  1833. @item Zero crossings
  1834. Number of points where the waveform crosses the zero level axis.
  1835. @item Zero crossings rate
  1836. Rate of Zero crossings and number of audio samples.
  1837. @end table
  1838. @section atempo
  1839. Adjust audio tempo.
  1840. The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
  1841. specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
  1842. be in the [0.5, 100.0] range.
  1843. Note that tempo greater than 2 will skip some samples rather than
  1844. blend them in. If for any reason this is a concern it is always
  1845. possible to daisy-chain several instances of atempo to achieve the
  1846. desired product tempo.
  1847. @subsection Examples
  1848. @itemize
  1849. @item
  1850. Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
  1851. @example
  1852. atempo=0.8
  1853. @end example
  1854. @item
  1855. To speed up audio to 300% tempo:
  1856. @example
  1857. atempo=3
  1858. @end example
  1859. @item
  1860. To speed up audio to 300% tempo by daisy-chaining two atempo instances:
  1861. @example
  1862. atempo=sqrt(3),atempo=sqrt(3)
  1863. @end example
  1864. @end itemize
  1865. @subsection Commands
  1866. This filter supports the following commands:
  1867. @table @option
  1868. @item tempo
  1869. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  1870. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  1871. @end table
  1872. @section atrim
  1873. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  1874. It accepts the following parameters:
  1875. @table @option
  1876. @item start
  1877. Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
  1878. sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
  1879. @item end
  1880. Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
  1881. audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
  1882. the last sample in the output.
  1883. @item start_pts
  1884. Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
  1885. instead of seconds.
  1886. @item end_pts
  1887. Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
  1888. of seconds.
  1889. @item duration
  1890. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  1891. @item start_sample
  1892. The number of the first sample that should be output.
  1893. @item end_sample
  1894. The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
  1895. @end table
  1896. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  1897. duration specifications; see
  1898. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  1899. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  1900. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
  1901. samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
  1902. give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
  1903. zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
  1904. to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
  1905. atrim filter.
  1906. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  1907. keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  1908. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
  1909. filters.
  1910. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  1911. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  1912. Examples:
  1913. @itemize
  1914. @item
  1915. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  1916. @example
  1917. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
  1918. @end example
  1919. @item
  1920. Keep only the first 1000 samples:
  1921. @example
  1922. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
  1923. @end example
  1924. @end itemize
  1925. @section bandpass
  1926. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
  1927. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
  1928. The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
  1929. instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
  1930. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1931. The filter accepts the following options:
  1932. @table @option
  1933. @item frequency, f
  1934. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1935. @item csg
  1936. Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
  1937. @item width_type, t
  1938. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1939. @table @option
  1940. @item h
  1941. Hz
  1942. @item q
  1943. Q-Factor
  1944. @item o
  1945. octave
  1946. @item s
  1947. slope
  1948. @item k
  1949. kHz
  1950. @end table
  1951. @item width, w
  1952. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1953. @item mix, m
  1954. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1955. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1956. @item channels, c
  1957. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1958. @end table
  1959. @subsection Commands
  1960. This filter supports the following commands:
  1961. @table @option
  1962. @item frequency, f
  1963. Change bandpass frequency.
  1964. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  1965. @item width_type, t
  1966. Change bandpass width_type.
  1967. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  1968. @item width, w
  1969. Change bandpass width.
  1970. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  1971. @item mix, m
  1972. Change bandpass mix.
  1973. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  1974. @end table
  1975. @section bandreject
  1976. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
  1977. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
  1978. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1979. The filter accepts the following options:
  1980. @table @option
  1981. @item frequency, f
  1982. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1983. @item width_type, t
  1984. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1985. @table @option
  1986. @item h
  1987. Hz
  1988. @item q
  1989. Q-Factor
  1990. @item o
  1991. octave
  1992. @item s
  1993. slope
  1994. @item k
  1995. kHz
  1996. @end table
  1997. @item width, w
  1998. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1999. @item mix, m
  2000. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2001. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2002. @item channels, c
  2003. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2004. @end table
  2005. @subsection Commands
  2006. This filter supports the following commands:
  2007. @table @option
  2008. @item frequency, f
  2009. Change bandreject frequency.
  2010. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2011. @item width_type, t
  2012. Change bandreject width_type.
  2013. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2014. @item width, w
  2015. Change bandreject width.
  2016. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2017. @item mix, m
  2018. Change bandreject mix.
  2019. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2020. @end table
  2021. @section bass, lowshelf
  2022. Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  2023. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  2024. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  2025. The filter accepts the following options:
  2026. @table @option
  2027. @item gain, g
  2028. Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
  2029. (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
  2030. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2031. @item frequency, f
  2032. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  2033. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  2034. The default value is @code{100} Hz.
  2035. @item width_type, t
  2036. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2037. @table @option
  2038. @item h
  2039. Hz
  2040. @item q
  2041. Q-Factor
  2042. @item o
  2043. octave
  2044. @item s
  2045. slope
  2046. @item k
  2047. kHz
  2048. @end table
  2049. @item width, w
  2050. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  2051. @item mix, m
  2052. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2053. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2054. @item channels, c
  2055. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2056. @end table
  2057. @subsection Commands
  2058. This filter supports the following commands:
  2059. @table @option
  2060. @item frequency, f
  2061. Change bass frequency.
  2062. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2063. @item width_type, t
  2064. Change bass width_type.
  2065. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2066. @item width, w
  2067. Change bass width.
  2068. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2069. @item gain, g
  2070. Change bass gain.
  2071. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2072. @item mix, m
  2073. Change bass mix.
  2074. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2075. @end table
  2076. @section biquad
  2077. Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
  2078. Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
  2079. are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
  2080. and @var{channels}, @var{c} specify which channels to filter, by default all
  2081. available are filtered.
  2082. @subsection Commands
  2083. This filter supports the following commands:
  2084. @table @option
  2085. @item a0
  2086. @item a1
  2087. @item a2
  2088. @item b0
  2089. @item b1
  2090. @item b2
  2091. Change biquad parameter.
  2092. Syntax for the command is : "@var{value}"
  2093. @item mix, m
  2094. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2095. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2096. @end table
  2097. @section bs2b
  2098. Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
  2099. stereo audio records.
  2100. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2101. @code{--enable-libbs2b}.
  2102. It accepts the following parameters:
  2103. @table @option
  2104. @item profile
  2105. Pre-defined crossfeed level.
  2106. @table @option
  2107. @item default
  2108. Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
  2109. @item cmoy
  2110. Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
  2111. @item jmeier
  2112. Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
  2113. @end table
  2114. @item fcut
  2115. Cut frequency (in Hz).
  2116. @item feed
  2117. Feed level (in Hz).
  2118. @end table
  2119. @section channelmap
  2120. Remap input channels to new locations.
  2121. It accepts the following parameters:
  2122. @table @option
  2123. @item map
  2124. Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  2125. mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
  2126. @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
  2127. channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
  2128. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
  2129. channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
  2130. index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
  2131. @item channel_layout
  2132. The channel layout of the output stream.
  2133. @end table
  2134. If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
  2135. output channels, preserving indices.
  2136. @subsection Examples
  2137. @itemize
  2138. @item
  2139. For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
  2140. @example
  2141. ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
  2142. @end example
  2143. will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
  2144. the input.
  2145. @item
  2146. To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
  2147. @example
  2148. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
  2149. @end example
  2150. @end itemize
  2151. @section channelsplit
  2152. Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
  2153. It accepts the following parameters:
  2154. @table @option
  2155. @item channel_layout
  2156. The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
  2157. @item channels
  2158. A channel layout describing the channels to be extracted as separate output streams
  2159. or "all" to extract each input channel as a separate stream. The default is "all".
  2160. Choosing channels not present in channel layout in the input will result in an error.
  2161. @end table
  2162. @subsection Examples
  2163. @itemize
  2164. @item
  2165. For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
  2166. @example
  2167. ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
  2168. @end example
  2169. will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
  2170. the left channel and the other the right channel.
  2171. @item
  2172. Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
  2173. @example
  2174. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
  2175. 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
  2176. -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
  2177. front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
  2178. side_right.wav
  2179. @end example
  2180. @item
  2181. Extract only LFE from a 5.1 WAV file:
  2182. @example
  2183. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1:channels=LFE[LFE]'
  2184. -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav
  2185. @end example
  2186. @end itemize
  2187. @section chorus
  2188. Add a chorus effect to the audio.
  2189. Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
  2190. Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
  2191. constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
  2192. The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
  2193. the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
  2194. sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
  2195. off key.
  2196. It accepts the following parameters:
  2197. @table @option
  2198. @item in_gain
  2199. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  2200. @item out_gain
  2201. Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
  2202. @item delays
  2203. Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
  2204. @item decays
  2205. Set decays.
  2206. @item speeds
  2207. Set speeds.
  2208. @item depths
  2209. Set depths.
  2210. @end table
  2211. @subsection Examples
  2212. @itemize
  2213. @item
  2214. A single delay:
  2215. @example
  2216. chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
  2217. @end example
  2218. @item
  2219. Two delays:
  2220. @example
  2221. chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
  2222. @end example
  2223. @item
  2224. Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
  2225. @example
  2226. chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
  2227. @end example
  2228. @end itemize
  2229. @section compand
  2230. Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  2231. It accepts the following parameters:
  2232. @table @option
  2233. @item attacks
  2234. @item decays
  2235. A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
  2236. of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
  2237. increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
  2238. situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
  2239. shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
  2240. loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
  2241. a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
  2242. If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
  2243. set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
  2244. @item points
  2245. A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
  2246. maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
  2247. the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
  2248. @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
  2249. The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
  2250. does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
  2251. may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
  2252. function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20|1/0}.
  2253. @item soft-knee
  2254. Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
  2255. @item gain
  2256. Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
  2257. function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
  2258. It defaults to 0.
  2259. @item volume
  2260. Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
  2261. starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
  2262. example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
  2263. companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
  2264. quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
  2265. @item delay
  2266. Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
  2267. delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
  2268. approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
  2269. operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
  2270. @end table
  2271. @subsection Examples
  2272. @itemize
  2273. @item
  2274. Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
  2275. noisy environment:
  2276. @example
  2277. compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
  2278. @end example
  2279. Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
  2280. @example
  2281. compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
  2282. @end example
  2283. @item
  2284. A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
  2285. @example
  2286. compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
  2287. @end example
  2288. @item
  2289. Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
  2290. than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
  2291. @example
  2292. compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
  2293. @end example
  2294. @item
  2295. 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
  2296. @example
  2297. compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
  2298. @end example
  2299. @item
  2300. 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
  2301. @example
  2302. compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
  2303. @end example
  2304. @item
  2305. 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
  2306. @example
  2307. compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
  2308. @end example
  2309. @item
  2310. 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
  2311. @example
  2312. compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
  2313. @end example
  2314. @item
  2315. 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
  2316. @example
  2317. compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
  2318. @end example
  2319. @item
  2320. Compressor/Gate:
  2321. @example
  2322. compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
  2323. @end example
  2324. @item
  2325. Expander:
  2326. @example
  2327. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
  2328. @end example
  2329. @item
  2330. Hard limiter at -6dB:
  2331. @example
  2332. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
  2333. @end example
  2334. @item
  2335. Hard limiter at -12dB:
  2336. @example
  2337. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
  2338. @end example
  2339. @item
  2340. Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
  2341. @example
  2342. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
  2343. @end example
  2344. @item
  2345. Soft limiter:
  2346. @example
  2347. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
  2348. @end example
  2349. @end itemize
  2350. @section compensationdelay
  2351. Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
  2352. positions of microphones or speakers.
  2353. For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
  2354. different locations. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
  2355. normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
  2356. their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
  2357. these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that a distance of
  2358. ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone capture the signal in
  2359. antiphase to the other microphone. That makes the final mix sound moody.
  2360. This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
  2361. to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
  2362. The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
  2363. synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
  2364. Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
  2365. Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
  2366. The filter accepts the following parameters:
  2367. @table @option
  2368. @item mm
  2369. Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
  2370. Default is 0.
  2371. @item cm
  2372. Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
  2373. Default is 0.
  2374. @item m
  2375. Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
  2376. Default is 0.
  2377. @item dry
  2378. Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
  2379. Default is 0.
  2380. @item wet
  2381. Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
  2382. Default is 1.
  2383. @item temp
  2384. Set temperature in degrees Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
  2385. Default is 20.
  2386. @end table
  2387. @section crossfeed
  2388. Apply headphone crossfeed filter.
  2389. Crossfeed is the process of blending the left and right channels of stereo
  2390. audio recording.
  2391. It is mainly used to reduce extreme stereo separation of low frequencies.
  2392. The intent is to produce more speaker like sound to the listener.
  2393. The filter accepts the following options:
  2394. @table @option
  2395. @item strength
  2396. Set strength of crossfeed. Default is 0.2. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2397. This sets gain of low shelf filter for side part of stereo image.
  2398. Default is -6dB. Max allowed is -30db when strength is set to 1.
  2399. @item range
  2400. Set soundstage wideness. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2401. This sets cut off frequency of low shelf filter. Default is cut off near
  2402. 1550 Hz. With range set to 1 cut off frequency is set to 2100 Hz.
  2403. @item level_in
  2404. Set input gain. Default is 0.9.
  2405. @item level_out
  2406. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  2407. @end table
  2408. @section crystalizer
  2409. Simple algorithm to expand audio dynamic range.
  2410. The filter accepts the following options:
  2411. @table @option
  2412. @item i
  2413. Sets the intensity of effect (default: 2.0). Must be in range between 0.0
  2414. (unchanged sound) to 10.0 (maximum effect).
  2415. @item c
  2416. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2417. @end table
  2418. @section dcshift
  2419. Apply a DC shift to the audio.
  2420. This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
  2421. in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
  2422. headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
  2423. a signal has a DC offset.
  2424. @table @option
  2425. @item shift
  2426. Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
  2427. the audio.
  2428. @item limitergain
  2429. Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
  2430. used to prevent clipping.
  2431. @end table
  2432. @section deesser
  2433. Apply de-essing to the audio samples.
  2434. @table @option
  2435. @item i
  2436. Set intensity for triggering de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2437. Default is 0.
  2438. @item m
  2439. Set amount of ducking on treble part of sound. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2440. Default is 0.5.
  2441. @item f
  2442. How much of original frequency content to keep when de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2443. Default is 0.5.
  2444. @item s
  2445. Set the output mode.
  2446. It accepts the following values:
  2447. @table @option
  2448. @item i
  2449. Pass input unchanged.
  2450. @item o
  2451. Pass ess filtered out.
  2452. @item e
  2453. Pass only ess.
  2454. Default value is @var{o}.
  2455. @end table
  2456. @end table
  2457. @section drmeter
  2458. Measure audio dynamic range.
  2459. DR values of 14 and higher is found in very dynamic material. DR of 8 to 13
  2460. is found in transition material. And anything less that 8 have very poor dynamics
  2461. and is very compressed.
  2462. The filter accepts the following options:
  2463. @table @option
  2464. @item length
  2465. Set window length in seconds used to split audio into segments of equal length.
  2466. Default is 3 seconds.
  2467. @end table
  2468. @section dynaudnorm
  2469. Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
  2470. This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
  2471. to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
  2472. contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
  2473. Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
  2474. This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
  2475. while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
  2476. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
  2477. sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
  2478. same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
  2479. this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
  2480. of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
  2481. @table @option
  2482. @item framelen, f
  2483. Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
  2484. Default is 500 milliseconds.
  2485. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
  2486. referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
  2487. meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
  2488. peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
  2489. normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
  2490. Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
  2491. frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
  2492. Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
  2493. been found to give good results with most files.
  2494. Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
  2495. automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
  2496. @item gausssize, g
  2497. Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
  2498. number. Default is 31.
  2499. Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
  2500. @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
  2501. is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
  2502. simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
  2503. takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
  2504. the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
  2505. smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
  2506. adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
  2507. effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
  2508. In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2509. Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
  2510. contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2511. Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
  2512. @item peak, p
  2513. Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
  2514. level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
  2515. target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
  2516. makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
  2517. A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
  2518. magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
  2519. It is not recommended to go above this value.
  2520. @item maxgain, m
  2521. Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
  2522. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
  2523. factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
  2524. result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
  2525. the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
  2526. additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
  2527. (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
  2528. factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
  2529. factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
  2530. it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
  2531. with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
  2532. higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
  2533. not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
  2534. Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
  2535. gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
  2536. value.
  2537. @item targetrms, r
  2538. Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
  2539. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
  2540. This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
  2541. (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
  2542. be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
  2543. level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
  2544. Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
  2545. abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
  2546. determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
  2547. that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
  2548. just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
  2549. frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
  2550. established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
  2551. factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
  2552. Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
  2553. frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
  2554. @item coupling, n
  2555. Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
  2556. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
  2557. amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
  2558. the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
  2559. However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
  2560. channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
  2561. In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
  2562. the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
  2563. only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
  2564. harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
  2565. @item correctdc, c
  2566. Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
  2567. An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
  2568. In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
  2569. -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
  2570. audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
  2571. That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
  2572. single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
  2573. value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
  2574. 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
  2575. DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
  2576. Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
  2577. With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
  2578. the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
  2579. that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
  2580. are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
  2581. boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
  2582. between neighbouring frames.
  2583. @item altboundary, b
  2584. Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
  2585. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
  2586. around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
  2587. subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
  2588. beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
  2589. frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
  2590. file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
  2591. frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
  2592. question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
  2593. in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
  2594. to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
  2595. of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
  2596. "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
  2597. @item compress, s
  2598. Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
  2599. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
  2600. compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
  2601. full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
  2602. in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
  2603. normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
  2604. For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
  2605. (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
  2606. all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
  2607. to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
  2608. going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
  2609. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
  2610. value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
  2611. frame.
  2612. In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
  2613. Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
  2614. @end table
  2615. @section earwax
  2616. Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
  2617. This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
  2618. so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
  2619. inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
  2620. the listener (standard for speakers).
  2621. Ported from SoX.
  2622. @section equalizer
  2623. Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
  2624. filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
  2625. be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
  2626. filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
  2627. In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
  2628. be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
  2629. The filter accepts the following options:
  2630. @table @option
  2631. @item frequency, f
  2632. Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
  2633. @item width_type, t
  2634. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2635. @table @option
  2636. @item h
  2637. Hz
  2638. @item q
  2639. Q-Factor
  2640. @item o
  2641. octave
  2642. @item s
  2643. slope
  2644. @item k
  2645. kHz
  2646. @end table
  2647. @item width, w
  2648. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2649. @item gain, g
  2650. Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
  2651. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2652. @item mix, m
  2653. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2654. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2655. @item channels, c
  2656. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2657. @end table
  2658. @subsection Examples
  2659. @itemize
  2660. @item
  2661. Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
  2662. @example
  2663. equalizer=f=1000:t=h:width=200:g=-10
  2664. @end example
  2665. @item
  2666. Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
  2667. @example
  2668. equalizer=f=1000:t=q:w=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:t=q:w=2:g=-5
  2669. @end example
  2670. @end itemize
  2671. @subsection Commands
  2672. This filter supports the following commands:
  2673. @table @option
  2674. @item frequency, f
  2675. Change equalizer frequency.
  2676. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2677. @item width_type, t
  2678. Change equalizer width_type.
  2679. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2680. @item width, w
  2681. Change equalizer width.
  2682. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2683. @item gain, g
  2684. Change equalizer gain.
  2685. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2686. @item mix, m
  2687. Change equalizer mix.
  2688. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2689. @end table
  2690. @section extrastereo
  2691. Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
  2692. adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
  2693. The filter accepts the following options:
  2694. @table @option
  2695. @item m
  2696. Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
  2697. (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
  2698. -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
  2699. @item c
  2700. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2701. @end table
  2702. @section firequalizer
  2703. Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
  2704. The filter accepts the following option:
  2705. @table @option
  2706. @item gain
  2707. Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
  2708. @table @option
  2709. @item f
  2710. the evaluated frequency
  2711. @item sr
  2712. sample rate
  2713. @item ch
  2714. channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2715. @item chid
  2716. channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
  2717. multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2718. @item chs
  2719. number of channels
  2720. @item chlayout
  2721. channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
  2722. @end table
  2723. and functions:
  2724. @table @option
  2725. @item gain_interpolate(f)
  2726. interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
  2727. @item cubic_interpolate(f)
  2728. same as gain_interpolate, but smoother
  2729. @end table
  2730. This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
  2731. @item gain_entry
  2732. Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
  2733. contain functions:
  2734. @table @option
  2735. @item entry(f, g)
  2736. store gain entry at frequency f with value g
  2737. @end table
  2738. This option is also available as command.
  2739. @item delay
  2740. Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
  2741. Default is @code{0.01}.
  2742. @item accuracy
  2743. Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
  2744. Default is @code{5}.
  2745. @item wfunc
  2746. Set window function. Acceptable values are:
  2747. @table @option
  2748. @item rectangular
  2749. rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
  2750. @item hann
  2751. hann window (default)
  2752. @item hamming
  2753. hamming window
  2754. @item blackman
  2755. blackman window
  2756. @item nuttall3
  2757. 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2758. @item mnuttall3
  2759. minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
  2760. @item nuttall
  2761. 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2762. @item bnuttall
  2763. minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
  2764. @item bharris
  2765. blackman-harris window
  2766. @item tukey
  2767. tukey window
  2768. @end table
  2769. @item fixed
  2770. If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
  2771. filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
  2772. @item multi
  2773. Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
  2774. @item zero_phase
  2775. Enable zero phase mode by subtracting timestamp to compensate delay.
  2776. Default is disabled.
  2777. @item scale
  2778. Set scale used by gain. Acceptable values are:
  2779. @table @option
  2780. @item linlin
  2781. linear frequency, linear gain
  2782. @item linlog
  2783. linear frequency, logarithmic (in dB) gain (default)
  2784. @item loglin
  2785. logarithmic (in octave scale where 20 Hz is 0) frequency, linear gain
  2786. @item loglog
  2787. logarithmic frequency, logarithmic gain
  2788. @end table
  2789. @item dumpfile
  2790. Set file for dumping, suitable for gnuplot.
  2791. @item dumpscale
  2792. Set scale for dumpfile. Acceptable values are same with scale option.
  2793. Default is linlog.
  2794. @item fft2
  2795. Enable 2-channel convolution using complex FFT. This improves speed significantly.
  2796. Default is disabled.
  2797. @item min_phase
  2798. Enable minimum phase impulse response. Default is disabled.
  2799. @end table
  2800. @subsection Examples
  2801. @itemize
  2802. @item
  2803. lowpass at 1000 Hz:
  2804. @example
  2805. firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
  2806. @end example
  2807. @item
  2808. lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
  2809. @example
  2810. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
  2811. @end example
  2812. @item
  2813. custom equalization:
  2814. @example
  2815. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
  2816. @end example
  2817. @item
  2818. higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:
  2819. @example
  2820. firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on
  2821. @end example
  2822. @item
  2823. lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
  2824. @example
  2825. firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
  2826. :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
  2827. @end example
  2828. @end itemize
  2829. @section flanger
  2830. Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
  2831. The filter accepts the following options:
  2832. @table @option
  2833. @item delay
  2834. Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
  2835. @item depth
  2836. Set added sweep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
  2837. @item regen
  2838. Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
  2839. Default value is 0.
  2840. @item width
  2841. Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
  2842. Default value is 71.
  2843. @item speed
  2844. Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
  2845. @item shape
  2846. Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
  2847. Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
  2848. @item phase
  2849. Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
  2850. Default value is 25.
  2851. @item interp
  2852. Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
  2853. Default is @var{linear}.
  2854. @end table
  2855. @section haas
  2856. Apply Haas effect to audio.
  2857. Note that this makes most sense to apply on mono signals.
  2858. With this filter applied to mono signals it give some directionality and
  2859. stretches its stereo image.
  2860. The filter accepts the following options:
  2861. @table @option
  2862. @item level_in
  2863. Set input level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB
  2864. @item level_out
  2865. Set output level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB.
  2866. @item side_gain
  2867. Set gain applied to side part of signal. By default is @var{1}.
  2868. @item middle_source
  2869. Set kind of middle source. Can be one of the following:
  2870. @table @samp
  2871. @item left
  2872. Pick left channel.
  2873. @item right
  2874. Pick right channel.
  2875. @item mid
  2876. Pick middle part signal of stereo image.
  2877. @item side
  2878. Pick side part signal of stereo image.
  2879. @end table
  2880. @item middle_phase
  2881. Change middle phase. By default is disabled.
  2882. @item left_delay
  2883. Set left channel delay. By default is @var{2.05} milliseconds.
  2884. @item left_balance
  2885. Set left channel balance. By default is @var{-1}.
  2886. @item left_gain
  2887. Set left channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2888. @item left_phase
  2889. Change left phase. By default is disabled.
  2890. @item right_delay
  2891. Set right channel delay. By defaults is @var{2.12} milliseconds.
  2892. @item right_balance
  2893. Set right channel balance. By default is @var{1}.
  2894. @item right_gain
  2895. Set right channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2896. @item right_phase
  2897. Change right phase. By default is enabled.
  2898. @end table
  2899. @section hdcd
  2900. Decodes High Definition Compatible Digital (HDCD) data. A 16-bit PCM stream with
  2901. embedded HDCD codes is expanded into a 20-bit PCM stream.
  2902. The filter supports the Peak Extend and Low-level Gain Adjustment features
  2903. of HDCD, and detects the Transient Filter flag.
  2904. @example
  2905. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.flac -af hdcd OUT24.flac
  2906. @end example
  2907. When using the filter with wav, note the default encoding for wav is 16-bit,
  2908. so the resulting 20-bit stream will be truncated back to 16-bit. Use something
  2909. like @command{-acodec pcm_s24le} after the filter to get 24-bit PCM output.
  2910. @example
  2911. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd OUT16.wav
  2912. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd -c:a pcm_s24le OUT24.wav
  2913. @end example
  2914. The filter accepts the following options:
  2915. @table @option
  2916. @item disable_autoconvert
  2917. Disable any automatic format conversion or resampling in the filter graph.
  2918. @item process_stereo
  2919. Process the stereo channels together. If target_gain does not match between
  2920. channels, consider it invalid and use the last valid target_gain.
  2921. @item cdt_ms
  2922. Set the code detect timer period in ms.
  2923. @item force_pe
  2924. Always extend peaks above -3dBFS even if PE isn't signaled.
  2925. @item analyze_mode
  2926. Replace audio with a solid tone and adjust the amplitude to signal some
  2927. specific aspect of the decoding process. The output file can be loaded in
  2928. an audio editor alongside the original to aid analysis.
  2929. @code{analyze_mode=pe:force_pe=true} can be used to see all samples above the PE level.
  2930. Modes are:
  2931. @table @samp
  2932. @item 0, off
  2933. Disabled
  2934. @item 1, lle
  2935. Gain adjustment level at each sample
  2936. @item 2, pe
  2937. Samples where peak extend occurs
  2938. @item 3, cdt
  2939. Samples where the code detect timer is active
  2940. @item 4, tgm
  2941. Samples where the target gain does not match between channels
  2942. @end table
  2943. @end table
  2944. @section headphone
  2945. Apply head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  2946. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones.
  2947. The HRIRs are provided via additional streams, for each channel
  2948. one stereo input stream is needed.
  2949. The filter accepts the following options:
  2950. @table @option
  2951. @item map
  2952. Set mapping of input streams for convolution.
  2953. The argument is a '|'-separated list of channel names in order as they
  2954. are given as additional stream inputs for filter.
  2955. This also specify number of input streams. Number of input streams
  2956. must be not less than number of channels in first stream plus one.
  2957. @item gain
  2958. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  2959. @item type
  2960. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  2961. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  2962. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  2963. Default is @var{freq}.
  2964. @item lfe
  2965. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  2966. @item size
  2967. Set size of frame in number of samples which will be processed at once.
  2968. Default value is @var{1024}. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000.
  2969. @item hrir
  2970. Set format of hrir stream.
  2971. Default value is @var{stereo}. Alternative value is @var{multich}.
  2972. If value is set to @var{stereo}, number of additional streams should
  2973. be greater or equal to number of input channels in first input stream.
  2974. Also each additional stream should have stereo number of channels.
  2975. If value is set to @var{multich}, number of additional streams should
  2976. be exactly one. Also number of input channels of additional stream
  2977. should be equal or greater than twice number of channels of first input
  2978. stream.
  2979. @end table
  2980. @subsection Examples
  2981. @itemize
  2982. @item
  2983. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  2984. each amovie filter use stereo file with IR coefficients as input.
  2985. The files give coefficients for each position of virtual loudspeaker:
  2986. @example
  2987. ffmpeg -i input.wav
  2988. -filter_complex "amovie=azi_270_ele_0_DFC.wav[sr];amovie=azi_90_ele_0_DFC.wav[sl];amovie=azi_225_ele_0_DFC.wav[br];amovie=azi_135_ele_0_DFC.wav[bl];amovie=azi_0_ele_0_DFC.wav,asplit[fc][lfe];amovie=azi_35_ele_0_DFC.wav[fl];amovie=azi_325_ele_0_DFC.wav[fr];[0:a][fl][fr][fc][lfe][bl][br][sl][sr]headphone=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR"
  2989. output.wav
  2990. @end example
  2991. @item
  2992. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  2993. but now in @var{multich} @var{hrir} format.
  2994. @example
  2995. ffmpeg -i input.wav -filter_complex "amovie=minp.wav[hrirs];[0:a][hrirs]headphone=map=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR:hrir=multich"
  2996. output.wav
  2997. @end example
  2998. @end itemize
  2999. @section highpass
  3000. Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3001. The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
  3002. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3003. The filter accepts the following options:
  3004. @table @option
  3005. @item frequency, f
  3006. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
  3007. @item poles, p
  3008. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3009. @item width_type, t
  3010. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3011. @table @option
  3012. @item h
  3013. Hz
  3014. @item q
  3015. Q-Factor
  3016. @item o
  3017. octave
  3018. @item s
  3019. slope
  3020. @item k
  3021. kHz
  3022. @end table
  3023. @item width, w
  3024. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3025. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3026. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3027. @item mix, m
  3028. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3029. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3030. @item channels, c
  3031. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3032. @end table
  3033. @subsection Commands
  3034. This filter supports the following commands:
  3035. @table @option
  3036. @item frequency, f
  3037. Change highpass frequency.
  3038. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3039. @item width_type, t
  3040. Change highpass width_type.
  3041. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3042. @item width, w
  3043. Change highpass width.
  3044. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3045. @item mix, m
  3046. Change highpass mix.
  3047. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3048. @end table
  3049. @section join
  3050. Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
  3051. It accepts the following parameters:
  3052. @table @option
  3053. @item inputs
  3054. The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
  3055. @item channel_layout
  3056. The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
  3057. @item map
  3058. Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  3059. mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
  3060. form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
  3061. can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
  3062. index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
  3063. channel.
  3064. @end table
  3065. The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
  3066. explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
  3067. and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
  3068. Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
  3069. @example
  3070. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
  3071. @end example
  3072. Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
  3073. @example
  3074. ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
  3075. 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
  3076. out
  3077. @end example
  3078. @section ladspa
  3079. Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
  3080. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3081. @code{--enable-ladspa}.
  3082. @table @option
  3083. @item file, f
  3084. Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
  3085. variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
  3086. each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
  3087. @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
  3088. this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
  3089. @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
  3090. @item plugin, p
  3091. Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
  3092. one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
  3093. will list all available plugins within the specified library.
  3094. @item controls, c
  3095. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3096. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3097. threshold or gain).
  3098. Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
  3099. c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
  3100. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3101. Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
  3102. @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
  3103. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3104. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3105. their valid ranges are printed.
  3106. @item sample_rate, s
  3107. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3108. zero inputs.
  3109. @item nb_samples, n
  3110. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3111. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3112. @item duration, d
  3113. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3114. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3115. for the accepted syntax.
  3116. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3117. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3118. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3119. supposed to be generated forever.
  3120. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3121. @end table
  3122. @subsection Examples
  3123. @itemize
  3124. @item
  3125. List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
  3126. @example
  3127. ladspa=file=amp
  3128. @end example
  3129. @item
  3130. List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
  3131. plugin from @code{VCF} library:
  3132. @example
  3133. ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
  3134. @end example
  3135. @item
  3136. Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
  3137. plugin library:
  3138. @example
  3139. ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
  3140. @end example
  3141. @item
  3142. Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
  3143. (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
  3144. @example
  3145. ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
  3146. @end example
  3147. @item
  3148. Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
  3149. @example
  3150. ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
  3151. @end example
  3152. @item
  3153. Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
  3154. @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3155. @example
  3156. ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
  3157. @end example
  3158. @item
  3159. Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
  3160. @example
  3161. ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
  3162. @end example
  3163. @item
  3164. Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
  3165. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3166. @example
  3167. ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
  3168. @end example
  3169. @item
  3170. Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
  3171. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3172. @example
  3173. ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
  3174. @end example
  3175. @item
  3176. Reduce stereo image using @code{Narrower} from the @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite}
  3177. (CAPS) library:
  3178. @example
  3179. ladspa=caps:Narrower
  3180. @end example
  3181. @item
  3182. Another white noise, now using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3183. @example
  3184. ladspa=caps:White:.2
  3185. @end example
  3186. @item
  3187. Some fractal noise, using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3188. @example
  3189. ladspa=caps:Fractal:c=c1=1
  3190. @end example
  3191. @item
  3192. Dynamic volume normalization using @code{VLevel} plugin:
  3193. @example
  3194. ladspa=vlevel-ladspa:vlevel_mono
  3195. @end example
  3196. @end itemize
  3197. @subsection Commands
  3198. This filter supports the following commands:
  3199. @table @option
  3200. @item cN
  3201. Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
  3202. If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
  3203. @end table
  3204. @section loudnorm
  3205. EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.
  3206. Support for both single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.
  3207. This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and maximum true peak. To accurately detect true peaks,
  3208. the audio stream will be upsampled to 192 kHz unless the normalization mode is linear.
  3209. Use the @code{-ar} option or @code{aresample} filter to explicitly set an output sample rate.
  3210. The filter accepts the following options:
  3211. @table @option
  3212. @item I, i
  3213. Set integrated loudness target.
  3214. Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.
  3215. @item LRA, lra
  3216. Set loudness range target.
  3217. Range is 1.0 - 20.0. Default value is 7.0.
  3218. @item TP, tp
  3219. Set maximum true peak.
  3220. Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.
  3221. @item measured_I, measured_i
  3222. Measured IL of input file.
  3223. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3224. @item measured_LRA, measured_lra
  3225. Measured LRA of input file.
  3226. Range is 0.0 - 99.0.
  3227. @item measured_TP, measured_tp
  3228. Measured true peak of input file.
  3229. Range is -99.0 - +99.0.
  3230. @item measured_thresh
  3231. Measured threshold of input file.
  3232. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3233. @item offset
  3234. Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.
  3235. Range is -99.0 - +99.0. Default is +0.0.
  3236. @item linear
  3237. Normalize linearly if possible.
  3238. measured_I, measured_LRA, measured_TP, and measured_thresh must also
  3239. to be specified in order to use this mode.
  3240. Options are true or false. Default is true.
  3241. @item dual_mono
  3242. Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  3243. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  3244. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  3245. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  3246. Options are true or false. Default is false.
  3247. @item print_format
  3248. Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.
  3249. Default value is none.
  3250. @end table
  3251. @section lowpass
  3252. Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3253. The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
  3254. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3255. The filter accepts the following options:
  3256. @table @option
  3257. @item frequency, f
  3258. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
  3259. @item poles, p
  3260. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3261. @item width_type, t
  3262. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3263. @table @option
  3264. @item h
  3265. Hz
  3266. @item q
  3267. Q-Factor
  3268. @item o
  3269. octave
  3270. @item s
  3271. slope
  3272. @item k
  3273. kHz
  3274. @end table
  3275. @item width, w
  3276. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3277. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3278. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3279. @item mix, m
  3280. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3281. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3282. @item channels, c
  3283. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3284. @end table
  3285. @subsection Examples
  3286. @itemize
  3287. @item
  3288. Lowpass only LFE channel, it LFE is not present it does nothing:
  3289. @example
  3290. lowpass=c=LFE
  3291. @end example
  3292. @end itemize
  3293. @subsection Commands
  3294. This filter supports the following commands:
  3295. @table @option
  3296. @item frequency, f
  3297. Change lowpass frequency.
  3298. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3299. @item width_type, t
  3300. Change lowpass width_type.
  3301. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3302. @item width, w
  3303. Change lowpass width.
  3304. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3305. @item mix, m
  3306. Change lowpass mix.
  3307. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3308. @end table
  3309. @section lv2
  3310. Load a LV2 (LADSPA Version 2) plugin.
  3311. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3312. @code{--enable-lv2}.
  3313. @table @option
  3314. @item plugin, p
  3315. Specifies the plugin URI. You may need to escape ':'.
  3316. @item controls, c
  3317. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3318. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3319. threshold or gain).
  3320. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3321. their valid ranges are printed.
  3322. @item sample_rate, s
  3323. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3324. zero inputs.
  3325. @item nb_samples, n
  3326. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3327. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3328. @item duration, d
  3329. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3330. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3331. for the accepted syntax.
  3332. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3333. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3334. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3335. supposed to be generated forever.
  3336. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3337. @end table
  3338. @subsection Examples
  3339. @itemize
  3340. @item
  3341. Apply bass enhancer plugin from Calf:
  3342. @example
  3343. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/BassEnhancer:c=amount=2
  3344. @end example
  3345. @item
  3346. Apply vinyl plugin from Calf:
  3347. @example
  3348. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/Vinyl:c=drone=0.2|aging=0.5
  3349. @end example
  3350. @item
  3351. Apply bit crusher plugin from ArtyFX:
  3352. @example
  3353. lv2=p=http\\\\://www.openavproductions.com/artyfx#bitta:c=crush=0.3
  3354. @end example
  3355. @end itemize
  3356. @section mcompand
  3357. Multiband Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  3358. The input audio is divided into bands using 4th order Linkwitz-Riley IIRs.
  3359. This is akin to the crossover of a loudspeaker, and results in flat frequency
  3360. response when absent compander action.
  3361. It accepts the following parameters:
  3362. @table @option
  3363. @item args
  3364. This option syntax is:
  3365. attack,decay,[attack,decay..] soft-knee points crossover_frequency [delay [initial_volume [gain]]] | attack,decay ...
  3366. For explanation of each item refer to compand filter documentation.
  3367. @end table
  3368. @anchor{pan}
  3369. @section pan
  3370. Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
  3371. channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
  3372. This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
  3373. stream.
  3374. The filter accepts parameters of the form:
  3375. "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
  3376. @table @option
  3377. @item l
  3378. output channel layout or number of channels
  3379. @item outdef
  3380. output channel specification, of the form:
  3381. "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[(+-)[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
  3382. @item out_name
  3383. output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
  3384. number (c0, c1, etc.)
  3385. @item gain
  3386. multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
  3387. @item in_name
  3388. input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
  3389. named and numbered input channels
  3390. @end table
  3391. If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
  3392. that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
  3393. avoiding clipping noise.
  3394. @subsection Mixing examples
  3395. For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
  3396. factor for the left channel:
  3397. @example
  3398. pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
  3399. @end example
  3400. A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
  3401. 7-channels surround:
  3402. @example
  3403. pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
  3404. @end example
  3405. Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
  3406. that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
  3407. needs.
  3408. @subsection Remapping examples
  3409. The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
  3410. @itemize
  3411. @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
  3412. @item only one input per channel output,
  3413. @end itemize
  3414. If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
  3415. channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
  3416. remapping.
  3417. For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
  3418. dropping the extra channels:
  3419. @example
  3420. pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
  3421. @end example
  3422. Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
  3423. and keep the input channel layout:
  3424. @example
  3425. pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
  3426. @end example
  3427. If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
  3428. still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
  3429. @example
  3430. pan="stereo|c1=c1"
  3431. @end example
  3432. Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
  3433. front left and right:
  3434. @example
  3435. pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
  3436. @end example
  3437. @section replaygain
  3438. ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
  3439. outputs it unchanged.
  3440. At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
  3441. @section resample
  3442. Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
  3443. not meant to be used directly.
  3444. @section rubberband
  3445. Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
  3446. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3447. @code{--enable-librubberband}.
  3448. The filter accepts the following options:
  3449. @table @option
  3450. @item tempo
  3451. Set tempo scale factor.
  3452. @item pitch
  3453. Set pitch scale factor.
  3454. @item transients
  3455. Set transients detector.
  3456. Possible values are:
  3457. @table @var
  3458. @item crisp
  3459. @item mixed
  3460. @item smooth
  3461. @end table
  3462. @item detector
  3463. Set detector.
  3464. Possible values are:
  3465. @table @var
  3466. @item compound
  3467. @item percussive
  3468. @item soft
  3469. @end table
  3470. @item phase
  3471. Set phase.
  3472. Possible values are:
  3473. @table @var
  3474. @item laminar
  3475. @item independent
  3476. @end table
  3477. @item window
  3478. Set processing window size.
  3479. Possible values are:
  3480. @table @var
  3481. @item standard
  3482. @item short
  3483. @item long
  3484. @end table
  3485. @item smoothing
  3486. Set smoothing.
  3487. Possible values are:
  3488. @table @var
  3489. @item off
  3490. @item on
  3491. @end table
  3492. @item formant
  3493. Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
  3494. Possible values are:
  3495. @table @var
  3496. @item shifted
  3497. @item preserved
  3498. @end table
  3499. @item pitchq
  3500. Set pitch quality.
  3501. Possible values are:
  3502. @table @var
  3503. @item quality
  3504. @item speed
  3505. @item consistency
  3506. @end table
  3507. @item channels
  3508. Set channels.
  3509. Possible values are:
  3510. @table @var
  3511. @item apart
  3512. @item together
  3513. @end table
  3514. @end table
  3515. @subsection Commands
  3516. This filter supports the following commands:
  3517. @table @option
  3518. @item tempo
  3519. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  3520. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  3521. @item pitch
  3522. Change filter pitch scale factor.
  3523. Syntax for the command is : "@var{pitch}"
  3524. @end table
  3525. @section sidechaincompress
  3526. This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
  3527. detected signal using second input signal.
  3528. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3529. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3530. The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
  3531. processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
  3532. The filter accepts the following options:
  3533. @table @option
  3534. @item level_in
  3535. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3536. @item mode
  3537. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3538. Default is @code{downward}.
  3539. @item threshold
  3540. If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
  3541. reduction of first stream.
  3542. By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  3543. @item ratio
  3544. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  3545. raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  3546. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  3547. @item attack
  3548. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3549. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  3550. @item release
  3551. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  3552. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  3553. @item makeup
  3554. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  3555. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  3556. @item knee
  3557. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3558. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  3559. @item link
  3560. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
  3561. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
  3562. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  3563. @item detection
  3564. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  3565. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
  3566. @item level_sc
  3567. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3568. @item mix
  3569. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  3570. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3571. @end table
  3572. @subsection Examples
  3573. @itemize
  3574. @item
  3575. Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
  3576. depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
  3577. merged with 2nd input:
  3578. @example
  3579. ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
  3580. @end example
  3581. @end itemize
  3582. @section sidechaingate
  3583. A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
  3584. filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
  3585. Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
  3586. threshold.
  3587. For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
  3588. the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
  3589. appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
  3590. natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
  3591. guitar.
  3592. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3593. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3594. The filter accepts the following options:
  3595. @table @option
  3596. @item level_in
  3597. Set input level before filtering.
  3598. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3599. @item mode
  3600. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3601. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  3602. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  3603. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  3604. @item range
  3605. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  3606. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3607. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  3608. @item threshold
  3609. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  3610. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3611. @item ratio
  3612. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  3613. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  3614. @item attack
  3615. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3616. reduction stops.
  3617. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3618. @item release
  3619. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  3620. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  3621. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3622. @item makeup
  3623. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  3624. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  3625. @item knee
  3626. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3627. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  3628. @item detection
  3629. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  3630. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  3631. @item link
  3632. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  3633. the reduction.
  3634. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  3635. @item level_sc
  3636. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3637. @end table
  3638. @section silencedetect
  3639. Detect silence in an audio stream.
  3640. This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
  3641. or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
  3642. minimum detected noise duration.
  3643. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  3644. @code{lavfi.silence_start} or @code{lavfi.silence_start.X} metadata key
  3645. is set on the first frame whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection
  3646. duration and it contains the timestamp of the first frame of the silence.
  3647. The @code{lavfi.silence_duration} or @code{lavfi.silence_duration.X}
  3648. and @code{lavfi.silence_end} or @code{lavfi.silence_end.X} metadata
  3649. keys are set on the first frame after the silence. If @option{mono} is
  3650. enabled, and each channel is evaluated separately, the @code{.X}
  3651. suffixed keys are used, and @code{X} corresponds to the channel number.
  3652. The filter accepts the following options:
  3653. @table @option
  3654. @item noise, n
  3655. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  3656. specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
  3657. @item duration, d
  3658. Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds). See
  3659. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3660. for the accepted syntax.
  3661. @item mono, m
  3662. Process each channel separately, instead of combined. By default is disabled.
  3663. @end table
  3664. @subsection Examples
  3665. @itemize
  3666. @item
  3667. Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
  3668. @example
  3669. silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
  3670. @end example
  3671. @item
  3672. Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
  3673. tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
  3674. @example
  3675. ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
  3676. @end example
  3677. @end itemize
  3678. @section silenceremove
  3679. Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
  3680. The filter accepts the following options:
  3681. @table @option
  3682. @item start_periods
  3683. This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
  3684. the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
  3685. beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
  3686. finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
  3687. the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
  3688. values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
  3689. Default value is @code{0}.
  3690. @item start_duration
  3691. Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
  3692. trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
  3693. as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
  3694. @item start_threshold
  3695. This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
  3696. audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
  3697. you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
  3698. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3699. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3700. @item start_silence
  3701. Specify max duration of silence at beginning that will be kept after
  3702. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3703. as silence.
  3704. @item start_mode
  3705. Specify mode of detection of silence end in start of multi-channel audio.
  3706. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3707. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3708. stopped trimming of silence.
  3709. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3710. stopped trimming of silence.
  3711. @item stop_periods
  3712. Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
  3713. To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
  3714. that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
  3715. used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
  3716. @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
  3717. in the middle of the audio.
  3718. Default value is @code{0}.
  3719. @item stop_duration
  3720. Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
  3721. more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
  3722. the audio.
  3723. Default value is @code{0}.
  3724. @item stop_threshold
  3725. This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
  3726. the end of audio.
  3727. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3728. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3729. @item stop_silence
  3730. Specify max duration of silence at end that will be kept after
  3731. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3732. as silence.
  3733. @item stop_mode
  3734. Specify mode of detection of silence start in end of multi-channel audio.
  3735. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3736. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3737. stopped trimming of silence.
  3738. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3739. stopped trimming of silence.
  3740. @item detection
  3741. Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
  3742. and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
  3743. Default value is @code{rms}.
  3744. @item window
  3745. Set duration in number of seconds used to calculate size of window in number
  3746. of samples for detecting silence.
  3747. Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
  3748. @end table
  3749. @subsection Examples
  3750. @itemize
  3751. @item
  3752. The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
  3753. that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
  3754. pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
  3755. @example
  3756. silenceremove=start_periods=1:start_duration=5:start_threshold=0.02
  3757. @end example
  3758. @item
  3759. Trim all silence encountered from beginning to end where there is more than 1
  3760. second of silence in audio:
  3761. @example
  3762. silenceremove=stop_periods=-1:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB
  3763. @end example
  3764. @item
  3765. Trim all digital silence samples, using peak detection, from beginning to end
  3766. where there is more than 0 samples of digital silence in audio and digital
  3767. silence is detected in all channels at same positions in stream:
  3768. @example
  3769. silenceremove=window=0:detection=peak:stop_mode=all:start_mode=all:stop_periods=-1:stop_threshold=0
  3770. @end example
  3771. @end itemize
  3772. @section sofalizer
  3773. SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3774. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
  3775. formats up to 9 channels supported).
  3776. The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
  3777. SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
  3778. Austrian Academy of Sciences.
  3779. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3780. @code{--enable-libmysofa}.
  3781. The filter accepts the following options:
  3782. @table @option
  3783. @item sofa
  3784. Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
  3785. @item gain
  3786. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3787. @item rotation
  3788. Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3789. @item elevation
  3790. Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3791. @item radius
  3792. Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
  3793. HRTFs. Default is 1.
  3794. @item type
  3795. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3796. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3797. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3798. Default is @var{freq}.
  3799. @item speakers
  3800. Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is:
  3801. <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].
  3802. Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
  3803. azimuth and elevation in degrees.
  3804. Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.
  3805. For example to override front left and front right channel positions use:
  3806. 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
  3807. Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.
  3808. @item lfegain
  3809. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3810. @item framesize
  3811. Set custom frame size in number of samples. Default is 1024.
  3812. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000. Only used if option @samp{type}
  3813. is set to @var{freq}.
  3814. @item normalize
  3815. Should all IRs be normalized upon importing SOFA file.
  3816. By default is enabled.
  3817. @item interpolate
  3818. Should nearest IRs be interpolated with neighbor IRs if exact position
  3819. does not match. By default is disabled.
  3820. @item minphase
  3821. Minphase all IRs upon loading of SOFA file. By default is disabled.
  3822. @item anglestep
  3823. Set neighbor search angle step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3824. @item radstep
  3825. Set neighbor search radius step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3826. @end table
  3827. @subsection Examples
  3828. @itemize
  3829. @item
  3830. Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:
  3831. @example
  3832. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1
  3833. @end example
  3834. @item
  3835. Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:
  3836. @example
  3837. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5
  3838. @end example
  3839. @item
  3840. Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, back left and back right
  3841. and also with custom gain:
  3842. @example
  3843. "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|BL 135|BR 225:gain=28"
  3844. @end example
  3845. @end itemize
  3846. @section stereotools
  3847. This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
  3848. M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
  3849. or spreading the stereo image of master track.
  3850. The filter accepts the following options:
  3851. @table @option
  3852. @item level_in
  3853. Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3854. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3855. @item level_out
  3856. Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3857. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3858. @item balance_in
  3859. Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3860. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3861. @item balance_out
  3862. Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3863. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3864. @item softclip
  3865. Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
  3866. clipping. Disabled by default.
  3867. @item mutel
  3868. Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3869. @item muter
  3870. Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3871. @item phasel
  3872. Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3873. @item phaser
  3874. Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3875. @item mode
  3876. Set stereo mode. Available values are:
  3877. @table @samp
  3878. @item lr>lr
  3879. Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
  3880. @item lr>ms
  3881. Left/Right to Mid/Side.
  3882. @item ms>lr
  3883. Mid/Side to Left/Right.
  3884. @item lr>ll
  3885. Left/Right to Left/Left.
  3886. @item lr>rr
  3887. Left/Right to Right/Right.
  3888. @item lr>l+r
  3889. Left/Right to Left + Right.
  3890. @item lr>rl
  3891. Left/Right to Right/Left.
  3892. @item ms>ll
  3893. Mid/Side to Left/Left.
  3894. @item ms>rr
  3895. Mid/Side to Right/Right.
  3896. @end table
  3897. @item slev
  3898. Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
  3899. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3900. @item sbal
  3901. Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
  3902. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3903. @item mlev
  3904. Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
  3905. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3906. @item mpan
  3907. Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3908. @item base
  3909. Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
  3910. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3911. @item delay
  3912. Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
  3913. vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
  3914. @item sclevel
  3915. Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  3916. @item phase
  3917. Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
  3918. @item bmode_in, bmode_out
  3919. Set balance mode for balance_in/balance_out option.
  3920. Can be one of the following:
  3921. @table @samp
  3922. @item balance
  3923. Classic balance mode. Attenuate one channel at time.
  3924. Gain is raised up to 1.
  3925. @item amplitude
  3926. Similar as classic mode above but gain is raised up to 2.
  3927. @item power
  3928. Equal power distribution, from -6dB to +6dB range.
  3929. @end table
  3930. @end table
  3931. @subsection Examples
  3932. @itemize
  3933. @item
  3934. Apply karaoke like effect:
  3935. @example
  3936. stereotools=mlev=0.015625
  3937. @end example
  3938. @item
  3939. Convert M/S signal to L/R:
  3940. @example
  3941. "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"
  3942. @end example
  3943. @end itemize
  3944. @section stereowiden
  3945. This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
  3946. channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
  3947. thereby widening the stereo effect.
  3948. The filter accepts the following options:
  3949. @table @option
  3950. @item delay
  3951. Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
  3952. Default is 20 milliseconds.
  3953. @item feedback
  3954. Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
  3955. effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
  3956. effect. Default is 0.3.
  3957. @item crossfeed
  3958. Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
  3959. the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
  3960. channels. Default is 0.3.
  3961. @item drymix
  3962. Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
  3963. @end table
  3964. @section superequalizer
  3965. Apply 18 band equalizer.
  3966. The filter accepts the following options:
  3967. @table @option
  3968. @item 1b
  3969. Set 65Hz band gain.
  3970. @item 2b
  3971. Set 92Hz band gain.
  3972. @item 3b
  3973. Set 131Hz band gain.
  3974. @item 4b
  3975. Set 185Hz band gain.
  3976. @item 5b
  3977. Set 262Hz band gain.
  3978. @item 6b
  3979. Set 370Hz band gain.
  3980. @item 7b
  3981. Set 523Hz band gain.
  3982. @item 8b
  3983. Set 740Hz band gain.
  3984. @item 9b
  3985. Set 1047Hz band gain.
  3986. @item 10b
  3987. Set 1480Hz band gain.
  3988. @item 11b
  3989. Set 2093Hz band gain.
  3990. @item 12b
  3991. Set 2960Hz band gain.
  3992. @item 13b
  3993. Set 4186Hz band gain.
  3994. @item 14b
  3995. Set 5920Hz band gain.
  3996. @item 15b
  3997. Set 8372Hz band gain.
  3998. @item 16b
  3999. Set 11840Hz band gain.
  4000. @item 17b
  4001. Set 16744Hz band gain.
  4002. @item 18b
  4003. Set 20000Hz band gain.
  4004. @end table
  4005. @section surround
  4006. Apply audio surround upmix filter.
  4007. This filter allows to produce multichannel output from audio stream.
  4008. The filter accepts the following options:
  4009. @table @option
  4010. @item chl_out
  4011. Set output channel layout. By default, this is @var{5.1}.
  4012. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4013. for the required syntax.
  4014. @item chl_in
  4015. Set input channel layout. By default, this is @var{stereo}.
  4016. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4017. for the required syntax.
  4018. @item level_in
  4019. Set input volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4020. @item level_out
  4021. Set output volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4022. @item lfe
  4023. Enable LFE channel output if output channel layout has it. By default, this is enabled.
  4024. @item lfe_low
  4025. Set LFE low cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{128} Hz.
  4026. @item lfe_high
  4027. Set LFE high cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{256} Hz.
  4028. @item lfe_mode
  4029. Set LFE mode, can be @var{add} or @var{sub}. Default is @var{add}.
  4030. In @var{add} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output.
  4031. In @var{sub} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output but
  4032. also all non-LFE output channels are subtracted with output LFE channel.
  4033. @item angle
  4034. Set angle of stereo surround transform, Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{360}.
  4035. Default is @var{90}.
  4036. @item fc_in
  4037. Set front center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4038. @item fc_out
  4039. Set front center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4040. @item fl_in
  4041. Set front left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4042. @item fl_out
  4043. Set front left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4044. @item fr_in
  4045. Set front right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4046. @item fr_out
  4047. Set front right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4048. @item sl_in
  4049. Set side left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4050. @item sl_out
  4051. Set side left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4052. @item sr_in
  4053. Set side right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4054. @item sr_out
  4055. Set side right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4056. @item bl_in
  4057. Set back left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4058. @item bl_out
  4059. Set back left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4060. @item br_in
  4061. Set back right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4062. @item br_out
  4063. Set back right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4064. @item bc_in
  4065. Set back center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4066. @item bc_out
  4067. Set back center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4068. @item lfe_in
  4069. Set LFE input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4070. @item lfe_out
  4071. Set LFE output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4072. @item allx
  4073. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for all channels.
  4074. @item ally
  4075. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for all channels.
  4076. @item fcx, flx, frx, blx, brx, slx, srx, bcx
  4077. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for each channel.
  4078. @item fcy, fly, fry, bly, bry, sly, sry, bcy
  4079. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for each channel.
  4080. @item win_size
  4081. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  4082. @item win_func
  4083. Set window function.
  4084. It accepts the following values:
  4085. @table @samp
  4086. @item rect
  4087. @item bartlett
  4088. @item hann, hanning
  4089. @item hamming
  4090. @item blackman
  4091. @item welch
  4092. @item flattop
  4093. @item bharris
  4094. @item bnuttall
  4095. @item bhann
  4096. @item sine
  4097. @item nuttall
  4098. @item lanczos
  4099. @item gauss
  4100. @item tukey
  4101. @item dolph
  4102. @item cauchy
  4103. @item parzen
  4104. @item poisson
  4105. @item bohman
  4106. @end table
  4107. Default is @code{hann}.
  4108. @item overlap
  4109. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  4110. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.5}.
  4111. @end table
  4112. @section treble, highshelf
  4113. Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  4114. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  4115. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  4116. The filter accepts the following options:
  4117. @table @option
  4118. @item gain, g
  4119. Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
  4120. Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
  4121. to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  4122. @item frequency, f
  4123. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  4124. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  4125. The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
  4126. @item width_type, t
  4127. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  4128. @table @option
  4129. @item h
  4130. Hz
  4131. @item q
  4132. Q-Factor
  4133. @item o
  4134. octave
  4135. @item s
  4136. slope
  4137. @item k
  4138. kHz
  4139. @end table
  4140. @item width, w
  4141. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  4142. @item mix, m
  4143. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  4144. Range is between 0 and 1.
  4145. @item channels, c
  4146. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  4147. @end table
  4148. @subsection Commands
  4149. This filter supports the following commands:
  4150. @table @option
  4151. @item frequency, f
  4152. Change treble frequency.
  4153. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  4154. @item width_type, t
  4155. Change treble width_type.
  4156. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  4157. @item width, w
  4158. Change treble width.
  4159. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  4160. @item gain, g
  4161. Change treble gain.
  4162. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  4163. @item mix, m
  4164. Change treble mix.
  4165. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  4166. @end table
  4167. @section tremolo
  4168. Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
  4169. The filter accepts the following options:
  4170. @table @option
  4171. @item f
  4172. Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
  4173. (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
  4174. This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
  4175. a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
  4176. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4177. @item d
  4178. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4179. Default value is 0.5.
  4180. @end table
  4181. @section vibrato
  4182. Sinusoidal phase modulation.
  4183. The filter accepts the following options:
  4184. @table @option
  4185. @item f
  4186. Modulation frequency in Hertz.
  4187. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4188. @item d
  4189. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4190. Default value is 0.5.
  4191. @end table
  4192. @section volume
  4193. Adjust the input audio volume.
  4194. It accepts the following parameters:
  4195. @table @option
  4196. @item volume
  4197. Set audio volume expression.
  4198. Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
  4199. The output audio volume is given by the relation:
  4200. @example
  4201. @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
  4202. @end example
  4203. The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
  4204. @item precision
  4205. This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
  4206. It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
  4207. precision of the volume scaling.
  4208. @table @option
  4209. @item fixed
  4210. 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
  4211. @item float
  4212. 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
  4213. @item double
  4214. 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
  4215. @end table
  4216. @item replaygain
  4217. Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
  4218. @table @option
  4219. @item drop
  4220. Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
  4221. @item ignore
  4222. Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
  4223. @item track
  4224. Prefer the track gain, if present.
  4225. @item album
  4226. Prefer the album gain, if present.
  4227. @end table
  4228. @item replaygain_preamp
  4229. Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
  4230. Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
  4231. @item eval
  4232. Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
  4233. It accepts the following values:
  4234. @table @samp
  4235. @item once
  4236. only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
  4237. when the @samp{volume} command is sent
  4238. @item frame
  4239. evaluate expression for each incoming frame
  4240. @end table
  4241. Default value is @samp{once}.
  4242. @end table
  4243. The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
  4244. @table @option
  4245. @item n
  4246. frame number (starting at zero)
  4247. @item nb_channels
  4248. number of channels
  4249. @item nb_consumed_samples
  4250. number of samples consumed by the filter
  4251. @item nb_samples
  4252. number of samples in the current frame
  4253. @item pos
  4254. original frame position in the file
  4255. @item pts
  4256. frame PTS
  4257. @item sample_rate
  4258. sample rate
  4259. @item startpts
  4260. PTS at start of stream
  4261. @item startt
  4262. time at start of stream
  4263. @item t
  4264. frame time
  4265. @item tb
  4266. timestamp timebase
  4267. @item volume
  4268. last set volume value
  4269. @end table
  4270. Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
  4271. @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
  4272. variables will evaluate to NAN.
  4273. @subsection Commands
  4274. This filter supports the following commands:
  4275. @table @option
  4276. @item volume
  4277. Modify the volume expression.
  4278. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4279. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4280. value.
  4281. @item replaygain_noclip
  4282. Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
  4283. Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
  4284. @end table
  4285. @subsection Examples
  4286. @itemize
  4287. @item
  4288. Halve the input audio volume:
  4289. @example
  4290. volume=volume=0.5
  4291. volume=volume=1/2
  4292. volume=volume=-6.0206dB
  4293. @end example
  4294. In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
  4295. omitted, for example like in:
  4296. @example
  4297. volume=0.5
  4298. @end example
  4299. @item
  4300. Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
  4301. @example
  4302. volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
  4303. @end example
  4304. @item
  4305. Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
  4306. @example
  4307. volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
  4308. @end example
  4309. @end itemize
  4310. @section volumedetect
  4311. Detect the volume of the input video.
  4312. The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
  4313. the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
  4314. In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
  4315. volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
  4316. registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
  4317. the samples).
  4318. All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
  4319. @subsection Examples
  4320. Here is an excerpt of the output:
  4321. @example
  4322. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
  4323. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
  4324. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
  4325. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
  4326. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
  4327. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
  4328. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
  4329. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
  4330. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
  4331. @end example
  4332. It means that:
  4333. @itemize
  4334. @item
  4335. The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
  4336. @item
  4337. The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
  4338. @item
  4339. There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
  4340. @end itemize
  4341. In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
  4342. raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
  4343. @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
  4344. @chapter Audio Sources
  4345. @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
  4346. Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
  4347. @section abuffer
  4348. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  4349. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  4350. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
  4351. It accepts the following parameters:
  4352. @table @option
  4353. @item time_base
  4354. The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
  4355. either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
  4356. @item sample_rate
  4357. The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
  4358. @item sample_fmt
  4359. The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
  4360. Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
  4361. the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
  4362. @item channel_layout
  4363. The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
  4364. Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
  4365. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
  4366. from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
  4367. @item channels
  4368. The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
  4369. If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
  4370. must be consistent.
  4371. @end table
  4372. @subsection Examples
  4373. @example
  4374. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
  4375. @end example
  4376. will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
  4377. Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
  4378. 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
  4379. equivalent to:
  4380. @example
  4381. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
  4382. @end example
  4383. @section aevalsrc
  4384. Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
  4385. This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
  4386. channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
  4387. audio signal.
  4388. This source accepts the following options:
  4389. @table @option
  4390. @item exprs
  4391. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
  4392. @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
  4393. depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
  4394. specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
  4395. @item channel_layout, c
  4396. Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
  4397. must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
  4398. @item duration, d
  4399. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  4400. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4401. for the accepted syntax.
  4402. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
  4403. duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
  4404. complete frame.
  4405. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  4406. supposed to be generated forever.
  4407. @item nb_samples, n
  4408. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
  4409. default to 1024.
  4410. @item sample_rate, s
  4411. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
  4412. @end table
  4413. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
  4414. @table @option
  4415. @item n
  4416. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  4417. @item t
  4418. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
  4419. @item s
  4420. sample rate
  4421. @end table
  4422. @subsection Examples
  4423. @itemize
  4424. @item
  4425. Generate silence:
  4426. @example
  4427. aevalsrc=0
  4428. @end example
  4429. @item
  4430. Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
  4431. 8000 Hz:
  4432. @example
  4433. aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
  4434. @end example
  4435. @item
  4436. Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
  4437. Center + Back Center) explicitly:
  4438. @example
  4439. aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
  4440. @end example
  4441. @item
  4442. Generate white noise:
  4443. @example
  4444. aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
  4445. @end example
  4446. @item
  4447. Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
  4448. @example
  4449. aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
  4450. @end example
  4451. @item
  4452. Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
  4453. @example
  4454. aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
  4455. @end example
  4456. @end itemize
  4457. @section anullsrc
  4458. The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
  4459. as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
  4460. the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
  4461. synth filter).
  4462. This source accepts the following options:
  4463. @table @option
  4464. @item channel_layout, cl
  4465. Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
  4466. representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
  4467. is "stereo".
  4468. Check the channel_layout_map definition in
  4469. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
  4470. channel layout values.
  4471. @item sample_rate, r
  4472. Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
  4473. @item nb_samples, n
  4474. Set the number of samples per requested frames.
  4475. @end table
  4476. @subsection Examples
  4477. @itemize
  4478. @item
  4479. Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
  4480. @example
  4481. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
  4482. @end example
  4483. @item
  4484. Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
  4485. @example
  4486. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
  4487. @end example
  4488. @end itemize
  4489. All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
  4490. @section flite
  4491. Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
  4492. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  4493. @code{--enable-libflite}.
  4494. Note that versions of the flite library prior to 2.0 are not thread-safe.
  4495. The filter accepts the following options:
  4496. @table @option
  4497. @item list_voices
  4498. If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
  4499. immediately. Default value is 0.
  4500. @item nb_samples, n
  4501. Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
  4502. @item textfile
  4503. Set the filename containing the text to speak.
  4504. @item text
  4505. Set the text to speak.
  4506. @item voice, v
  4507. Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
  4508. @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
  4509. @end table
  4510. @subsection Examples
  4511. @itemize
  4512. @item
  4513. Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
  4514. standard flite voice:
  4515. @example
  4516. flite=textfile=speech.txt
  4517. @end example
  4518. @item
  4519. Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
  4520. @example
  4521. flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4522. @end example
  4523. @item
  4524. Input text to ffmpeg:
  4525. @example
  4526. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4527. @end example
  4528. @item
  4529. Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
  4530. the @code{lavfi} device:
  4531. @example
  4532. ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
  4533. @end example
  4534. @end itemize
  4535. For more information about libflite, check:
  4536. @url{http://www.festvox.org/flite/}
  4537. @section anoisesrc
  4538. Generate a noise audio signal.
  4539. The filter accepts the following options:
  4540. @table @option
  4541. @item sample_rate, r
  4542. Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
  4543. @item amplitude, a
  4544. Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
  4545. is 1.0.
  4546. @item duration, d
  4547. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
  4548. results in noise with an infinite length.
  4549. @item color, colour, c
  4550. Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, brown,
  4551. blue and violet. Default color is white.
  4552. @item seed, s
  4553. Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
  4554. @item nb_samples, n
  4555. Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
  4556. @end table
  4557. @subsection Examples
  4558. @itemize
  4559. @item
  4560. Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
  4561. @example
  4562. anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
  4563. @end example
  4564. @end itemize
  4565. @section hilbert
  4566. Generate odd-tap Hilbert transform FIR coefficients.
  4567. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for phase-shifting
  4568. the signal by 90 degrees.
  4569. This is used in many matrix coding schemes and for analytic signal generation.
  4570. The process is often written as a multiplication by i (or j), the imaginary unit.
  4571. The filter accepts the following options:
  4572. @table @option
  4573. @item sample_rate, s
  4574. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4575. @item taps, t
  4576. Set length of FIR filter, default is 22051.
  4577. @item nb_samples, n
  4578. Set number of samples per each frame.
  4579. @item win_func, w
  4580. Set window function to be used when generating FIR coefficients.
  4581. @end table
  4582. @section sinc
  4583. Generate a sinc kaiser-windowed low-pass, high-pass, band-pass, or band-reject FIR coefficients.
  4584. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4585. The filter accepts the following options:
  4586. @table @option
  4587. @item sample_rate, r
  4588. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4589. @item nb_samples, n
  4590. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4591. @item hp
  4592. Set high-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4593. @item lp
  4594. Set low-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4595. If high-pass frequency is lower than low-pass frequency and low-pass frequency
  4596. is higher than 0 then filter will create band-pass filter coefficients,
  4597. otherwise band-reject filter coefficients.
  4598. @item phase
  4599. Set filter phase response. Default is 50. Allowed range is from 0 to 100.
  4600. @item beta
  4601. Set Kaiser window beta.
  4602. @item att
  4603. Set stop-band attenuation. Default is 120dB, allowed range is from 40 to 180 dB.
  4604. @item round
  4605. Enable rounding, by default is disabled.
  4606. @item hptaps
  4607. Set number of taps for high-pass filter.
  4608. @item lptaps
  4609. Set number of taps for low-pass filter.
  4610. @end table
  4611. @section sine
  4612. Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
  4613. The audio signal is bit-exact.
  4614. The filter accepts the following options:
  4615. @table @option
  4616. @item frequency, f
  4617. Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
  4618. @item beep_factor, b
  4619. Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
  4620. the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
  4621. @item sample_rate, r
  4622. Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
  4623. @item duration, d
  4624. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
  4625. @item samples_per_frame
  4626. Set the number of samples per output frame.
  4627. The expression can contain the following constants:
  4628. @table @option
  4629. @item n
  4630. The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
  4631. @item pts
  4632. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
  4633. expressed in @var{TB} units.
  4634. @item t
  4635. The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
  4636. @item TB
  4637. The timebase of the output audio frames.
  4638. @end table
  4639. Default is @code{1024}.
  4640. @end table
  4641. @subsection Examples
  4642. @itemize
  4643. @item
  4644. Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
  4645. @example
  4646. sine
  4647. @end example
  4648. @item
  4649. Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
  4650. @example
  4651. sine=220:4:d=5
  4652. sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
  4653. sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
  4654. @end example
  4655. @item
  4656. Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
  4657. pattern:
  4658. @example
  4659. sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
  4660. @end example
  4661. @end itemize
  4662. @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
  4663. @chapter Audio Sinks
  4664. @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
  4665. Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
  4666. @section abuffersink
  4667. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
  4668. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  4669. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  4670. or the options system.
  4671. It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
  4672. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  4673. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  4674. @section anullsink
  4675. Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
  4676. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  4677. tools.
  4678. @c man end AUDIO SINKS
  4679. @chapter Video Filters
  4680. @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
  4681. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  4682. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  4683. The configure output will show the video filters included in your
  4684. build.
  4685. Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
  4686. @section addroi
  4687. Mark a region of interest in a video frame.
  4688. The frame data is passed through unchanged, but metadata is attached
  4689. to the frame indicating regions of interest which can affect the
  4690. behaviour of later encoding. Multiple regions can be marked by
  4691. applying the filter multiple times.
  4692. @table @option
  4693. @item x
  4694. Region distance in pixels from the left edge of the frame.
  4695. @item y
  4696. Region distance in pixels from the top edge of the frame.
  4697. @item w
  4698. Region width in pixels.
  4699. @item h
  4700. Region height in pixels.
  4701. The parameters @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are expressions,
  4702. and may contain the following variables:
  4703. @table @option
  4704. @item iw
  4705. Width of the input frame.
  4706. @item ih
  4707. Height of the input frame.
  4708. @end table
  4709. @item qoffset
  4710. Quantisation offset to apply within the region.
  4711. This must be a real value in the range -1 to +1. A value of zero
  4712. indicates no quality change. A negative value asks for better quality
  4713. (less quantisation), while a positive value asks for worse quality
  4714. (greater quantisation).
  4715. The range is calibrated so that the extreme values indicate the
  4716. largest possible offset - if the rest of the frame is encoded with the
  4717. worst possible quality, an offset of -1 indicates that this region
  4718. should be encoded with the best possible quality anyway. Intermediate
  4719. values are then interpolated in some codec-dependent way.
  4720. For example, in 10-bit H.264 the quantisation parameter varies between
  4721. -12 and 51. A typical qoffset value of -1/10 therefore indicates that
  4722. this region should be encoded with a QP around one-tenth of the full
  4723. range better than the rest of the frame. So, if most of the frame
  4724. were to be encoded with a QP of around 30, this region would get a QP
  4725. of around 24 (an offset of approximately -1/10 * (51 - -12) = -6.3).
  4726. An extreme value of -1 would indicate that this region should be
  4727. encoded with the best possible quality regardless of the treatment of
  4728. the rest of the frame - that is, should be encoded at a QP of -12.
  4729. @item clear
  4730. If set to true, remove any existing regions of interest marked on the
  4731. frame before adding the new one.
  4732. @end table
  4733. @subsection Examples
  4734. @itemize
  4735. @item
  4736. Mark the centre quarter of the frame as interesting.
  4737. @example
  4738. addroi=iw/4:ih/4:iw/2:ih/2:-1/10
  4739. @end example
  4740. @item
  4741. Mark the 100-pixel-wide region on the left edge of the frame as very
  4742. uninteresting (to be encoded at much lower quality than the rest of
  4743. the frame).
  4744. @example
  4745. addroi=0:0:100:ih:+1/5
  4746. @end example
  4747. @end itemize
  4748. @section alphaextract
  4749. Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
  4750. is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
  4751. @section alphamerge
  4752. Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
  4753. grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
  4754. @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
  4755. sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
  4756. channel.
  4757. For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
  4758. and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
  4759. @example
  4760. movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
  4761. @end example
  4762. Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
  4763. sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
  4764. input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
  4765. pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
  4766. overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
  4767. @section amplify
  4768. Amplify differences between current pixel and pixels of adjacent frames in
  4769. same pixel location.
  4770. This filter accepts the following options:
  4771. @table @option
  4772. @item radius
  4773. Set frame radius. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 63.
  4774. For example radius of 3 will instruct filter to calculate average of 7 frames.
  4775. @item factor
  4776. Set factor to amplify difference. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4777. @item threshold
  4778. Set threshold for difference amplification. Any difference greater or equal to
  4779. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 10.
  4780. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4781. @item tolerance
  4782. Set tolerance for difference amplification. Any difference lower to
  4783. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 0.
  4784. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4785. @item low
  4786. Set lower limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4787. This option controls maximum possible value that will decrease source pixel value.
  4788. @item high
  4789. Set high limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4790. This option controls maximum possible value that will increase source pixel value.
  4791. @item planes
  4792. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  4793. @end table
  4794. @subsection Commands
  4795. This filter supports the following @ref{commands} that corresponds to option of same name:
  4796. @table @option
  4797. @item factor
  4798. @item threshold
  4799. @item tolerance
  4800. @item low
  4801. @item high
  4802. @item planes
  4803. @end table
  4804. @section ass
  4805. Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
  4806. and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
  4807. Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
  4808. This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
  4809. the @ref{subtitles} filter:
  4810. @table @option
  4811. @item shaping
  4812. Set the shaping engine
  4813. Available values are:
  4814. @table @samp
  4815. @item auto
  4816. The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
  4817. @item simple
  4818. Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
  4819. @item complex
  4820. Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
  4821. @end table
  4822. The default is @code{auto}.
  4823. @end table
  4824. @section atadenoise
  4825. Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
  4826. The filter accepts the following options:
  4827. @table @option
  4828. @item 0a
  4829. Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
  4830. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4831. @item 0b
  4832. Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
  4833. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4834. @item 1a
  4835. Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4836. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4837. @item 1b
  4838. Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4839. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4840. @item 2a
  4841. Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4842. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4843. @item 2b
  4844. Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4845. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4846. Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
  4847. threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
  4848. @item s
  4849. Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 9. Must be odd
  4850. number in range [5, 129].
  4851. @item p
  4852. Set what planes of frame filter will use for averaging. Default is all.
  4853. @item a
  4854. Set what variant of algorithm filter will use for averaging. Default is @code{p} parallel.
  4855. Alternatively can be set to @code{s} serial.
  4856. Parallel can be faster then serial, while other way around is never true.
  4857. Parallel will abort early on first change being greater then thresholds, while serial
  4858. will continue processing other side of frames if they are equal or bellow thresholds.
  4859. @end table
  4860. @subsection Commands
  4861. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options except option @code{s}.
  4862. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4863. @section avgblur
  4864. Apply average blur filter.
  4865. The filter accepts the following options:
  4866. @table @option
  4867. @item sizeX
  4868. Set horizontal radius size.
  4869. @item planes
  4870. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  4871. @item sizeY
  4872. Set vertical radius size, if zero it will be same as @code{sizeX}.
  4873. Default is @code{0}.
  4874. @end table
  4875. @subsection Commands
  4876. This filter supports same commands as options.
  4877. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4878. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4879. value.
  4880. @section bbox
  4881. Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
  4882. luminance plane.
  4883. This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
  4884. luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
  4885. The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
  4886. log.
  4887. The filter accepts the following option:
  4888. @table @option
  4889. @item min_val
  4890. Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
  4891. @end table
  4892. @section bilateral
  4893. Apply bilateral filter, spatial smoothing while preserving edges.
  4894. The filter accepts the following options:
  4895. @table @option
  4896. @item sigmaS
  4897. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate spatial weight.
  4898. Allowed range is 0 to 10. Default is 0.1.
  4899. @item sigmaR
  4900. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate range weight.
  4901. Allowed range is 0 to 1. Default is 0.1.
  4902. @item planes
  4903. Set planes to filter. Default is first only.
  4904. @end table
  4905. @section bitplanenoise
  4906. Show and measure bit plane noise.
  4907. The filter accepts the following options:
  4908. @table @option
  4909. @item bitplane
  4910. Set which plane to analyze. Default is @code{1}.
  4911. @item filter
  4912. Filter out noisy pixels from @code{bitplane} set above.
  4913. Default is disabled.
  4914. @end table
  4915. @section blackdetect
  4916. Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
  4917. useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
  4918. recordings. Output lines contains the time for the start, end and
  4919. duration of the detected black interval expressed in seconds.
  4920. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  4921. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  4922. The filter accepts the following options:
  4923. @table @option
  4924. @item black_min_duration, d
  4925. Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
  4926. be a non-negative floating point number.
  4927. Default value is 2.0.
  4928. @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
  4929. Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
  4930. Express the minimum value for the ratio:
  4931. @example
  4932. @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
  4933. @end example
  4934. for which a picture is considered black.
  4935. Default value is 0.98.
  4936. @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
  4937. Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
  4938. The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
  4939. pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
  4940. the following equation:
  4941. @example
  4942. @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
  4943. @end example
  4944. @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
  4945. the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
  4946. formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
  4947. Default value is 0.10.
  4948. @end table
  4949. The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
  4950. value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
  4951. @example
  4952. blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
  4953. @end example
  4954. @section blackframe
  4955. Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
  4956. detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
  4957. the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
  4958. the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
  4959. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  4960. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  4961. This filter exports frame metadata @code{lavfi.blackframe.pblack}.
  4962. The value represents the percentage of pixels in the picture that
  4963. are below the threshold value.
  4964. It accepts the following parameters:
  4965. @table @option
  4966. @item amount
  4967. The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
  4968. @code{98}.
  4969. @item threshold, thresh
  4970. The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
  4971. @code{32}.
  4972. @end table
  4973. @section blend, tblend
  4974. Blend two video frames into each other.
  4975. The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  4976. stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
  4977. "bottom" layer. By default, the output terminates when the longest input terminates.
  4978. The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
  4979. from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
  4980. the new frame on top of the old frame.
  4981. A description of the accepted options follows.
  4982. @table @option
  4983. @item c0_mode
  4984. @item c1_mode
  4985. @item c2_mode
  4986. @item c3_mode
  4987. @item all_mode
  4988. Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  4989. of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
  4990. Available values for component modes are:
  4991. @table @samp
  4992. @item addition
  4993. @item grainmerge
  4994. @item and
  4995. @item average
  4996. @item burn
  4997. @item darken
  4998. @item difference
  4999. @item grainextract
  5000. @item divide
  5001. @item dodge
  5002. @item freeze
  5003. @item exclusion
  5004. @item extremity
  5005. @item glow
  5006. @item hardlight
  5007. @item hardmix
  5008. @item heat
  5009. @item lighten
  5010. @item linearlight
  5011. @item multiply
  5012. @item multiply128
  5013. @item negation
  5014. @item normal
  5015. @item or
  5016. @item overlay
  5017. @item phoenix
  5018. @item pinlight
  5019. @item reflect
  5020. @item screen
  5021. @item softlight
  5022. @item subtract
  5023. @item vividlight
  5024. @item xor
  5025. @end table
  5026. @item c0_opacity
  5027. @item c1_opacity
  5028. @item c2_opacity
  5029. @item c3_opacity
  5030. @item all_opacity
  5031. Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5032. of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
  5033. @item c0_expr
  5034. @item c1_expr
  5035. @item c2_expr
  5036. @item c3_expr
  5037. @item all_expr
  5038. Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5039. of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
  5040. The expressions can use the following variables:
  5041. @table @option
  5042. @item N
  5043. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  5044. @item X
  5045. @item Y
  5046. the coordinates of the current sample
  5047. @item W
  5048. @item H
  5049. the width and height of currently filtered plane
  5050. @item SW
  5051. @item SH
  5052. Width and height scale for the plane being filtered. It is the
  5053. ratio between the dimensions of the current plane to the luma plane,
  5054. e.g. for a @code{yuv420p} frame, the values are @code{1,1} for
  5055. the luma plane and @code{0.5,0.5} for the chroma planes.
  5056. @item T
  5057. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  5058. @item TOP, A
  5059. Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
  5060. @item BOTTOM, B
  5061. Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
  5062. @end table
  5063. @end table
  5064. The @code{blend} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  5065. @subsection Examples
  5066. @itemize
  5067. @item
  5068. Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
  5069. @example
  5070. blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
  5071. @end example
  5072. @item
  5073. Apply linear horizontal transition from top layer to bottom layer:
  5074. @example
  5075. blend=all_expr='A*(X/W)+B*(1-X/W)'
  5076. @end example
  5077. @item
  5078. Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
  5079. @example
  5080. blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
  5081. @end example
  5082. @item
  5083. Apply uncover left effect:
  5084. @example
  5085. blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
  5086. @end example
  5087. @item
  5088. Apply uncover down effect:
  5089. @example
  5090. blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
  5091. @end example
  5092. @item
  5093. Apply uncover up-left effect:
  5094. @example
  5095. blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
  5096. @end example
  5097. @item
  5098. Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
  5099. @example
  5100. blend=all_expr='if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)'
  5101. @end example
  5102. @item
  5103. Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
  5104. @example
  5105. tblend=all_mode=grainextract
  5106. @end example
  5107. @end itemize
  5108. @section bm3d
  5109. Denoise frames using Block-Matching 3D algorithm.
  5110. The filter accepts the following options.
  5111. @table @option
  5112. @item sigma
  5113. Set denoising strength. Default value is 1.
  5114. Allowed range is from 0 to 999.9.
  5115. The denoising algorithm is very sensitive to sigma, so adjust it
  5116. according to the source.
  5117. @item block
  5118. Set local patch size. This sets dimensions in 2D.
  5119. @item bstep
  5120. Set sliding step for processing blocks. Default value is 4.
  5121. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  5122. Smaller values allows processing more reference blocks and is slower.
  5123. @item group
  5124. Set maximal number of similar blocks for 3rd dimension. Default value is 1.
  5125. When set to 1, no block matching is done. Larger values allows more blocks
  5126. in single group.
  5127. Allowed range is from 1 to 256.
  5128. @item range
  5129. Set radius for search block matching. Default is 9.
  5130. Allowed range is from 1 to INT32_MAX.
  5131. @item mstep
  5132. Set step between two search locations for block matching. Default is 1.
  5133. Allowed range is from 1 to 64. Smaller is slower.
  5134. @item thmse
  5135. Set threshold of mean square error for block matching. Valid range is 0 to
  5136. INT32_MAX.
  5137. @item hdthr
  5138. Set thresholding parameter for hard thresholding in 3D transformed domain.
  5139. Larger values results in stronger hard-thresholding filtering in frequency
  5140. domain.
  5141. @item estim
  5142. Set filtering estimation mode. Can be @code{basic} or @code{final}.
  5143. Default is @code{basic}.
  5144. @item ref
  5145. If enabled, filter will use 2nd stream for block matching.
  5146. Default is disabled for @code{basic} value of @var{estim} option,
  5147. and always enabled if value of @var{estim} is @code{final}.
  5148. @item planes
  5149. Set planes to filter. Default is all available except alpha.
  5150. @end table
  5151. @subsection Examples
  5152. @itemize
  5153. @item
  5154. Basic filtering with bm3d:
  5155. @example
  5156. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic
  5157. @end example
  5158. @item
  5159. Same as above, but filtering only luma:
  5160. @example
  5161. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic:planes=1
  5162. @end example
  5163. @item
  5164. Same as above, but with both estimation modes:
  5165. @example
  5166. split[a][b],[a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5167. @end example
  5168. @item
  5169. Same as above, but prefilter with @ref{nlmeans} filter instead:
  5170. @example
  5171. split[a][b],[a]nlmeans=s=3:r=7:p=3[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5172. @end example
  5173. @end itemize
  5174. @section boxblur
  5175. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  5176. It accepts the following parameters:
  5177. @table @option
  5178. @item luma_radius, lr
  5179. @item luma_power, lp
  5180. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5181. @item chroma_power, cp
  5182. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5183. @item alpha_power, ap
  5184. @end table
  5185. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5186. @table @option
  5187. @item luma_radius, lr
  5188. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5189. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5190. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  5191. corresponding input plane.
  5192. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  5193. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  5194. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  5195. planes.
  5196. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  5197. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  5198. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  5199. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  5200. @table @option
  5201. @item w
  5202. @item h
  5203. The input width and height in pixels.
  5204. @item cw
  5205. @item ch
  5206. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  5207. @item hsub
  5208. @item vsub
  5209. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  5210. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5211. @end table
  5212. @item luma_power, lp
  5213. @item chroma_power, cp
  5214. @item alpha_power, ap
  5215. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  5216. corresponding plane.
  5217. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  5218. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  5219. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  5220. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  5221. @end table
  5222. @subsection Examples
  5223. @itemize
  5224. @item
  5225. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
  5226. set to 2:
  5227. @example
  5228. boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
  5229. boxblur=2:1
  5230. @end example
  5231. @item
  5232. Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
  5233. @example
  5234. boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
  5235. @end example
  5236. @item
  5237. Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
  5238. @example
  5239. boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
  5240. @end example
  5241. @end itemize
  5242. @section bwdif
  5243. Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
  5244. Deinterlacing Filter").
  5245. Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
  5246. interpolation algorithms.
  5247. It accepts the following parameters:
  5248. @table @option
  5249. @item mode
  5250. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  5251. @table @option
  5252. @item 0, send_frame
  5253. Output one frame for each frame.
  5254. @item 1, send_field
  5255. Output one frame for each field.
  5256. @end table
  5257. The default value is @code{send_field}.
  5258. @item parity
  5259. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  5260. of the following values:
  5261. @table @option
  5262. @item 0, tff
  5263. Assume the top field is first.
  5264. @item 1, bff
  5265. Assume the bottom field is first.
  5266. @item -1, auto
  5267. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  5268. @end table
  5269. The default value is @code{auto}.
  5270. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  5271. top field first will be assumed.
  5272. @item deint
  5273. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  5274. values:
  5275. @table @option
  5276. @item 0, all
  5277. Deinterlace all frames.
  5278. @item 1, interlaced
  5279. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  5280. @end table
  5281. The default value is @code{all}.
  5282. @end table
  5283. @section chromahold
  5284. Remove all color information for all colors except for certain one.
  5285. The filter accepts the following options:
  5286. @table @option
  5287. @item color
  5288. The color which will not be replaced with neutral chroma.
  5289. @item similarity
  5290. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5291. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5292. @item blend
  5293. Blend percentage.
  5294. 0.0 makes pixels either fully gray, or not gray at all.
  5295. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5296. @item yuv
  5297. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5298. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5299. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5300. @end table
  5301. @section chromakey
  5302. YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
  5303. The filter accepts the following options:
  5304. @table @option
  5305. @item color
  5306. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5307. @item similarity
  5308. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5309. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5310. @item blend
  5311. Blend percentage.
  5312. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5313. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5314. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5315. @item yuv
  5316. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5317. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5318. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5319. @end table
  5320. @subsection Examples
  5321. @itemize
  5322. @item
  5323. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5324. @example
  5325. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
  5326. @end example
  5327. @item
  5328. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
  5329. @example
  5330. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
  5331. @end example
  5332. @end itemize
  5333. @section chromashift
  5334. Shift chroma pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  5335. The filter accepts the following options:
  5336. @table @option
  5337. @item cbh
  5338. Set amount to shift chroma-blue horizontally.
  5339. @item cbv
  5340. Set amount to shift chroma-blue vertically.
  5341. @item crh
  5342. Set amount to shift chroma-red horizontally.
  5343. @item crv
  5344. Set amount to shift chroma-red vertically.
  5345. @item edge
  5346. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  5347. @end table
  5348. @section ciescope
  5349. Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.
  5350. The filter accepts the following options:
  5351. @table @option
  5352. @item system
  5353. Set color system.
  5354. @table @samp
  5355. @item ntsc, 470m
  5356. @item ebu, 470bg
  5357. @item smpte
  5358. @item 240m
  5359. @item apple
  5360. @item widergb
  5361. @item cie1931
  5362. @item rec709, hdtv
  5363. @item uhdtv, rec2020
  5364. @item dcip3
  5365. @end table
  5366. @item cie
  5367. Set CIE system.
  5368. @table @samp
  5369. @item xyy
  5370. @item ucs
  5371. @item luv
  5372. @end table
  5373. @item gamuts
  5374. Set what gamuts to draw.
  5375. See @code{system} option for available values.
  5376. @item size, s
  5377. Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.
  5378. @item intensity, i
  5379. Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.
  5380. @item contrast
  5381. Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.
  5382. @item corrgamma
  5383. Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.
  5384. @item showwhite
  5385. Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.
  5386. @item gamma
  5387. Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.
  5388. @end table
  5389. @section codecview
  5390. Visualize information exported by some codecs.
  5391. Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
  5392. means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
  5393. @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
  5394. The filter accepts the following option:
  5395. @table @option
  5396. @item mv
  5397. Set motion vectors to visualize.
  5398. Available flags for @var{mv} are:
  5399. @table @samp
  5400. @item pf
  5401. forward predicted MVs of P-frames
  5402. @item bf
  5403. forward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5404. @item bb
  5405. backward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5406. @end table
  5407. @item qp
  5408. Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.
  5409. @item mv_type, mvt
  5410. Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by @var{frame_type} option.
  5411. Available flags for @var{mv_type} are:
  5412. @table @samp
  5413. @item fp
  5414. forward predicted MVs
  5415. @item bp
  5416. backward predicted MVs
  5417. @end table
  5418. @item frame_type, ft
  5419. Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.
  5420. Available flags for @var{frame_type} are:
  5421. @table @samp
  5422. @item if
  5423. intra-coded frames (I-frames)
  5424. @item pf
  5425. predicted frames (P-frames)
  5426. @item bf
  5427. bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)
  5428. @end table
  5429. @end table
  5430. @subsection Examples
  5431. @itemize
  5432. @item
  5433. Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5434. @example
  5435. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp
  5436. @end example
  5437. @item
  5438. Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5439. @example
  5440. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
  5441. @end example
  5442. @end itemize
  5443. @section colorbalance
  5444. Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
  5445. The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
  5446. regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
  5447. A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
  5448. value towards the complementary color.
  5449. The filter accepts the following options:
  5450. @table @option
  5451. @item rs
  5452. @item gs
  5453. @item bs
  5454. Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
  5455. @item rm
  5456. @item gm
  5457. @item bm
  5458. Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
  5459. @item rh
  5460. @item gh
  5461. @item bh
  5462. Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
  5463. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5464. @item pl
  5465. Preserve lightness when changing color balance. Default is disabled.
  5466. @end table
  5467. @subsection Examples
  5468. @itemize
  5469. @item
  5470. Add red color cast to shadows:
  5471. @example
  5472. colorbalance=rs=.3
  5473. @end example
  5474. @end itemize
  5475. @subsection Commands
  5476. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5477. @section colorchannelmixer
  5478. Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
  5479. This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
  5480. the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
  5481. modify is red, the output value will be:
  5482. @example
  5483. @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
  5484. @end example
  5485. The filter accepts the following options:
  5486. @table @option
  5487. @item rr
  5488. @item rg
  5489. @item rb
  5490. @item ra
  5491. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
  5492. Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
  5493. @item gr
  5494. @item gg
  5495. @item gb
  5496. @item ga
  5497. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
  5498. Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
  5499. @item br
  5500. @item bg
  5501. @item bb
  5502. @item ba
  5503. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
  5504. Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
  5505. @item ar
  5506. @item ag
  5507. @item ab
  5508. @item aa
  5509. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
  5510. Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
  5511. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
  5512. @end table
  5513. @subsection Examples
  5514. @itemize
  5515. @item
  5516. Convert source to grayscale:
  5517. @example
  5518. colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
  5519. @end example
  5520. @item
  5521. Simulate sepia tones:
  5522. @example
  5523. colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
  5524. @end example
  5525. @end itemize
  5526. @subsection Commands
  5527. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5528. @section colorkey
  5529. RGB colorspace color keying.
  5530. The filter accepts the following options:
  5531. @table @option
  5532. @item color
  5533. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5534. @item similarity
  5535. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5536. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5537. @item blend
  5538. Blend percentage.
  5539. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5540. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5541. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5542. @end table
  5543. @subsection Examples
  5544. @itemize
  5545. @item
  5546. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5547. @example
  5548. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
  5549. @end example
  5550. @item
  5551. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
  5552. @example
  5553. ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
  5554. @end example
  5555. @end itemize
  5556. @section colorhold
  5557. Remove all color information for all RGB colors except for certain one.
  5558. The filter accepts the following options:
  5559. @table @option
  5560. @item color
  5561. The color which will not be replaced with neutral gray.
  5562. @item similarity
  5563. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5564. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5565. @item blend
  5566. Blend percentage. 0.0 makes pixels fully gray.
  5567. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5568. @end table
  5569. @section colorlevels
  5570. Adjust video input frames using levels.
  5571. The filter accepts the following options:
  5572. @table @option
  5573. @item rimin
  5574. @item gimin
  5575. @item bimin
  5576. @item aimin
  5577. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
  5578. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5579. @item rimax
  5580. @item gimax
  5581. @item bimax
  5582. @item aimax
  5583. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
  5584. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5585. Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
  5586. (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
  5587. @item romin
  5588. @item gomin
  5589. @item bomin
  5590. @item aomin
  5591. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
  5592. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5593. @item romax
  5594. @item gomax
  5595. @item bomax
  5596. @item aomax
  5597. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
  5598. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5599. Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
  5600. @end table
  5601. @subsection Examples
  5602. @itemize
  5603. @item
  5604. Make video output darker:
  5605. @example
  5606. colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
  5607. @end example
  5608. @item
  5609. Increase contrast:
  5610. @example
  5611. colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
  5612. @end example
  5613. @item
  5614. Make video output lighter:
  5615. @example
  5616. colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
  5617. @end example
  5618. @item
  5619. Increase brightness:
  5620. @example
  5621. colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
  5622. @end example
  5623. @end itemize
  5624. @section colormatrix
  5625. Convert color matrix.
  5626. The filter accepts the following options:
  5627. @table @option
  5628. @item src
  5629. @item dst
  5630. Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
  5631. specified.
  5632. The accepted values are:
  5633. @table @samp
  5634. @item bt709
  5635. BT.709
  5636. @item fcc
  5637. FCC
  5638. @item bt601
  5639. BT.601
  5640. @item bt470
  5641. BT.470
  5642. @item bt470bg
  5643. BT.470BG
  5644. @item smpte170m
  5645. SMPTE-170M
  5646. @item smpte240m
  5647. SMPTE-240M
  5648. @item bt2020
  5649. BT.2020
  5650. @end table
  5651. @end table
  5652. For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5653. @example
  5654. colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
  5655. @end example
  5656. @section colorspace
  5657. Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.
  5658. Input video needs to have an even size.
  5659. The filter accepts the following options:
  5660. @table @option
  5661. @anchor{all}
  5662. @item all
  5663. Specify all color properties at once.
  5664. The accepted values are:
  5665. @table @samp
  5666. @item bt470m
  5667. BT.470M
  5668. @item bt470bg
  5669. BT.470BG
  5670. @item bt601-6-525
  5671. BT.601-6 525
  5672. @item bt601-6-625
  5673. BT.601-6 625
  5674. @item bt709
  5675. BT.709
  5676. @item smpte170m
  5677. SMPTE-170M
  5678. @item smpte240m
  5679. SMPTE-240M
  5680. @item bt2020
  5681. BT.2020
  5682. @end table
  5683. @anchor{space}
  5684. @item space
  5685. Specify output colorspace.
  5686. The accepted values are:
  5687. @table @samp
  5688. @item bt709
  5689. BT.709
  5690. @item fcc
  5691. FCC
  5692. @item bt470bg
  5693. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5694. @item smpte170m
  5695. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5696. @item smpte240m
  5697. SMPTE-240M
  5698. @item ycgco
  5699. YCgCo
  5700. @item bt2020ncl
  5701. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  5702. @end table
  5703. @anchor{trc}
  5704. @item trc
  5705. Specify output transfer characteristics.
  5706. The accepted values are:
  5707. @table @samp
  5708. @item bt709
  5709. BT.709
  5710. @item bt470m
  5711. BT.470M
  5712. @item bt470bg
  5713. BT.470BG
  5714. @item gamma22
  5715. Constant gamma of 2.2
  5716. @item gamma28
  5717. Constant gamma of 2.8
  5718. @item smpte170m
  5719. SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525
  5720. @item smpte240m
  5721. SMPTE-240M
  5722. @item srgb
  5723. SRGB
  5724. @item iec61966-2-1
  5725. iec61966-2-1
  5726. @item iec61966-2-4
  5727. iec61966-2-4
  5728. @item xvycc
  5729. xvycc
  5730. @item bt2020-10
  5731. BT.2020 for 10-bits content
  5732. @item bt2020-12
  5733. BT.2020 for 12-bits content
  5734. @end table
  5735. @anchor{primaries}
  5736. @item primaries
  5737. Specify output color primaries.
  5738. The accepted values are:
  5739. @table @samp
  5740. @item bt709
  5741. BT.709
  5742. @item bt470m
  5743. BT.470M
  5744. @item bt470bg
  5745. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5746. @item smpte170m
  5747. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5748. @item smpte240m
  5749. SMPTE-240M
  5750. @item film
  5751. film
  5752. @item smpte431
  5753. SMPTE-431
  5754. @item smpte432
  5755. SMPTE-432
  5756. @item bt2020
  5757. BT.2020
  5758. @item jedec-p22
  5759. JEDEC P22 phosphors
  5760. @end table
  5761. @anchor{range}
  5762. @item range
  5763. Specify output color range.
  5764. The accepted values are:
  5765. @table @samp
  5766. @item tv
  5767. TV (restricted) range
  5768. @item mpeg
  5769. MPEG (restricted) range
  5770. @item pc
  5771. PC (full) range
  5772. @item jpeg
  5773. JPEG (full) range
  5774. @end table
  5775. @item format
  5776. Specify output color format.
  5777. The accepted values are:
  5778. @table @samp
  5779. @item yuv420p
  5780. YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits
  5781. @item yuv420p10
  5782. YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits
  5783. @item yuv420p12
  5784. YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits
  5785. @item yuv422p
  5786. YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits
  5787. @item yuv422p10
  5788. YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits
  5789. @item yuv422p12
  5790. YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits
  5791. @item yuv444p
  5792. YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits
  5793. @item yuv444p10
  5794. YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits
  5795. @item yuv444p12
  5796. YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits
  5797. @end table
  5798. @item fast
  5799. Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take
  5800. significantly less CPU, but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output
  5801. compatible with that produced by the colormatrix filter, use fast=1.
  5802. @item dither
  5803. Specify dithering mode.
  5804. The accepted values are:
  5805. @table @samp
  5806. @item none
  5807. No dithering
  5808. @item fsb
  5809. Floyd-Steinberg dithering
  5810. @end table
  5811. @item wpadapt
  5812. Whitepoint adaptation mode.
  5813. The accepted values are:
  5814. @table @samp
  5815. @item bradford
  5816. Bradford whitepoint adaptation
  5817. @item vonkries
  5818. von Kries whitepoint adaptation
  5819. @item identity
  5820. identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)
  5821. @end table
  5822. @item iall
  5823. Override all input properties at once. Same accepted values as @ref{all}.
  5824. @item ispace
  5825. Override input colorspace. Same accepted values as @ref{space}.
  5826. @item iprimaries
  5827. Override input color primaries. Same accepted values as @ref{primaries}.
  5828. @item itrc
  5829. Override input transfer characteristics. Same accepted values as @ref{trc}.
  5830. @item irange
  5831. Override input color range. Same accepted values as @ref{range}.
  5832. @end table
  5833. The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color
  5834. primaries to the specified user values. The output value, if not specified,
  5835. is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If that property is
  5836. also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and
  5837. format default to the same value as the input color range and format. The
  5838. input transfer characteristics, color space, color primaries and color range
  5839. should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the filter will
  5840. log an error and no conversion will take place.
  5841. For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5842. @example
  5843. colorspace=smpte240m
  5844. @end example
  5845. @section convolution
  5846. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 or horizontal/vertical up to 49 elements.
  5847. The filter accepts the following options:
  5848. @table @option
  5849. @item 0m
  5850. @item 1m
  5851. @item 2m
  5852. @item 3m
  5853. Set matrix for each plane.
  5854. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed integers in @var{square} mode,
  5855. and from 1 to 49 odd number of signed integers in @var{row} mode.
  5856. @item 0rdiv
  5857. @item 1rdiv
  5858. @item 2rdiv
  5859. @item 3rdiv
  5860. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  5861. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  5862. @item 0bias
  5863. @item 1bias
  5864. @item 2bias
  5865. @item 3bias
  5866. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  5867. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
  5868. @item 0mode
  5869. @item 1mode
  5870. @item 2mode
  5871. @item 3mode
  5872. Set matrix mode for each plane. Can be @var{square}, @var{row} or @var{column}.
  5873. Default is @var{square}.
  5874. @end table
  5875. @subsection Examples
  5876. @itemize
  5877. @item
  5878. Apply sharpen:
  5879. @example
  5880. convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
  5881. @end example
  5882. @item
  5883. Apply blur:
  5884. @example
  5885. convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
  5886. @end example
  5887. @item
  5888. Apply edge enhance:
  5889. @example
  5890. convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
  5891. @end example
  5892. @item
  5893. Apply edge detect:
  5894. @example
  5895. convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
  5896. @end example
  5897. @item
  5898. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  5899. @example
  5900. convolution="1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0"
  5901. @end example
  5902. @item
  5903. Apply emboss:
  5904. @example
  5905. convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
  5906. @end example
  5907. @end itemize
  5908. @section convolve
  5909. Apply 2D convolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  5910. as impulse.
  5911. The filter accepts the following options:
  5912. @table @option
  5913. @item planes
  5914. Set which planes to process.
  5915. @item impulse
  5916. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  5917. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  5918. @end table
  5919. The @code{convolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  5920. @section copy
  5921. Copy the input video source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  5922. testing purposes.
  5923. @anchor{coreimage}
  5924. @section coreimage
  5925. Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  5926. Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is
  5927. processed by video hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations
  5928. exist which means there is no guarantee for hardware processing. It depends on
  5929. the respective OSX.
  5930. There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a
  5931. large variety of options. The filter has to be referenced by its name along
  5932. with its options.
  5933. The coreimage filter accepts the following options:
  5934. @table @option
  5935. @item list_filters
  5936. List all available filters and generators along with all their respective
  5937. options as well as possible minimum and maximum values along with the default
  5938. values.
  5939. @example
  5940. list_filters=true
  5941. @end example
  5942. @item filter
  5943. Specify all filters by their respective name and options.
  5944. Use @var{list_filters} to determine all valid filter names and options.
  5945. Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically clamped
  5946. to their respective value range. Vector and color options have to be specified
  5947. by a list of space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.
  5948. A special option name @code{default} is available to use default options for a
  5949. filter.
  5950. It is required to specify either @code{default} or at least one of the filter options.
  5951. All omitted options are used with their default values.
  5952. The syntax of the filter string is as follows:
  5953. @example
  5954. filter=<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...][#<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...]][#...]
  5955. @end example
  5956. @item output_rect
  5957. Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the
  5958. input image. It is given by a list of space separated float values:
  5959. @example
  5960. output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height
  5961. @end example
  5962. If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.
  5963. The output rectangle is automatically cropped at the borders of the input
  5964. image. Negative values are valid for each component.
  5965. @example
  5966. output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100
  5967. @end example
  5968. @end table
  5969. Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST
  5970. transfers allowing for fast processing of complex filter chains.
  5971. Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one (filters) input
  5972. image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet
  5973. usable as intended.
  5974. Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the
  5975. respective filter kernel. The padding is automatically removed to ensure the
  5976. filter output has the same size as the input image.
  5977. For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the
  5978. previous output image of the filter chain or the input image of the whole
  5979. filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the pixel information of
  5980. this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is
  5981. blended onto this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the
  5982. output image.
  5983. The @ref{coreimagesrc} video source can be used for generating input images
  5984. which are directly fed into the filter chain. By using it, providing input
  5985. images by another video source or an input video is not required.
  5986. @subsection Examples
  5987. @itemize
  5988. @item
  5989. List all filters available:
  5990. @example
  5991. coreimage=list_filters=true
  5992. @end example
  5993. @item
  5994. Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:
  5995. @example
  5996. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default
  5997. @end example
  5998. @item
  5999. Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with
  6000. its center at 100x100 and a radius of 50 pixels:
  6001. @example
  6002. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default#CIVignetteEffect@@inputCenter=100\ 100@@inputRadius=50
  6003. @end example
  6004. @item
  6005. Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  6006. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  6007. @example
  6008. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  6009. @end example
  6010. @end itemize
  6011. @section cover_rect
  6012. Cover a rectangular object
  6013. It accepts the following options:
  6014. @table @option
  6015. @item cover
  6016. Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
  6017. @item mode
  6018. Set covering mode.
  6019. It accepts the following values:
  6020. @table @samp
  6021. @item cover
  6022. cover it by the supplied image
  6023. @item blur
  6024. cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
  6025. @end table
  6026. Default value is @var{blur}.
  6027. @end table
  6028. @subsection Examples
  6029. @itemize
  6030. @item
  6031. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  6032. @example
  6033. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  6034. @end example
  6035. @end itemize
  6036. @section crop
  6037. Crop the input video to given dimensions.
  6038. It accepts the following parameters:
  6039. @table @option
  6040. @item w, out_w
  6041. The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
  6042. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6043. configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
  6044. @item h, out_h
  6045. The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
  6046. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6047. configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
  6048. @item x
  6049. The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
  6050. video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
  6051. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6052. @item y
  6053. The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
  6054. It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
  6055. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6056. @item keep_aspect
  6057. If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
  6058. to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
  6059. ratio. It defaults to 0.
  6060. @item exact
  6061. Enable exact cropping. If enabled, subsampled videos will be cropped at exact
  6062. width/height/x/y as specified and will not be rounded to nearest smaller value.
  6063. It defaults to 0.
  6064. @end table
  6065. The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
  6066. expressions containing the following constants:
  6067. @table @option
  6068. @item x
  6069. @item y
  6070. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  6071. each new frame.
  6072. @item in_w
  6073. @item in_h
  6074. The input width and height.
  6075. @item iw
  6076. @item ih
  6077. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  6078. @item out_w
  6079. @item out_h
  6080. The output (cropped) width and height.
  6081. @item ow
  6082. @item oh
  6083. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6084. @item a
  6085. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  6086. @item sar
  6087. input sample aspect ratio
  6088. @item dar
  6089. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  6090. @item hsub
  6091. @item vsub
  6092. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6093. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6094. @item n
  6095. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  6096. @item pos
  6097. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  6098. @item t
  6099. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  6100. @end table
  6101. The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
  6102. and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
  6103. cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
  6104. evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6105. The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
  6106. position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
  6107. are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
  6108. is approximated to the nearest valid value.
  6109. The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
  6110. for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
  6111. @subsection Examples
  6112. @itemize
  6113. @item
  6114. Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
  6115. @example
  6116. crop=100:100:12:34
  6117. @end example
  6118. Using named options, the example above becomes:
  6119. @example
  6120. crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
  6121. @end example
  6122. @item
  6123. Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
  6124. @example
  6125. crop=100:100
  6126. @end example
  6127. @item
  6128. Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
  6129. @example
  6130. crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
  6131. @end example
  6132. @item
  6133. Crop the input video central square:
  6134. @example
  6135. crop=out_w=in_h
  6136. crop=in_h
  6137. @end example
  6138. @item
  6139. Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
  6140. 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
  6141. corner of the input image.
  6142. @example
  6143. crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
  6144. @end example
  6145. @item
  6146. Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
  6147. the top and bottom borders
  6148. @example
  6149. crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
  6150. @end example
  6151. @item
  6152. Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
  6153. @example
  6154. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
  6155. @end example
  6156. @item
  6157. Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
  6158. @example
  6159. crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
  6160. @end example
  6161. @item
  6162. Apply trembling effect:
  6163. @example
  6164. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
  6165. @end example
  6166. @item
  6167. Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
  6168. @example
  6169. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
  6170. @end example
  6171. @item
  6172. Set x depending on the value of y:
  6173. @example
  6174. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
  6175. @end example
  6176. @end itemize
  6177. @subsection Commands
  6178. This filter supports the following commands:
  6179. @table @option
  6180. @item w, out_w
  6181. @item h, out_h
  6182. @item x
  6183. @item y
  6184. Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
  6185. in the input video.
  6186. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6187. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6188. value.
  6189. @end table
  6190. @section cropdetect
  6191. Auto-detect the crop size.
  6192. It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
  6193. recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
  6194. correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
  6195. It accepts the following parameters:
  6196. @table @option
  6197. @item limit
  6198. Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
  6199. from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity
  6200. value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
  6201. You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
  6202. on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
  6203. @item round
  6204. The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
  6205. 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
  6206. get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
  6207. encoding to most video codecs.
  6208. @item reset_count, reset
  6209. Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
  6210. reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
  6211. detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
  6212. This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
  6213. indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
  6214. playback.
  6215. @end table
  6216. @anchor{cue}
  6217. @section cue
  6218. Delay video filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. The filter first
  6219. passes on @option{preroll} amount of frames, then it buffers at most
  6220. @option{buffer} amount of frames and waits for the cue. After reaching the cue
  6221. it forwards the buffered frames and also any subsequent frames coming in its
  6222. input.
  6223. The filter can be used synchronize the output of multiple ffmpeg processes for
  6224. realtime output devices like decklink. By putting the delay in the filtering
  6225. chain and pre-buffering frames the process can pass on data to output almost
  6226. immediately after the target wallclock timestamp is reached.
  6227. Perfect frame accuracy cannot be guaranteed, but the result is good enough for
  6228. some use cases.
  6229. @table @option
  6230. @item cue
  6231. The cue timestamp expressed in a UNIX timestamp in microseconds. Default is 0.
  6232. @item preroll
  6233. The duration of content to pass on as preroll expressed in seconds. Default is 0.
  6234. @item buffer
  6235. The maximum duration of content to buffer before waiting for the cue expressed
  6236. in seconds. Default is 0.
  6237. @end table
  6238. @anchor{curves}
  6239. @section curves
  6240. Apply color adjustments using curves.
  6241. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
  6242. component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
  6243. tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
  6244. values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
  6245. the output frame.
  6246. By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
  6247. @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
  6248. "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
  6249. The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
  6250. curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
  6251. smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
  6252. strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
  6253. be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
  6254. the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
  6255. The filter accepts the following options:
  6256. @table @option
  6257. @item preset
  6258. Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
  6259. to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
  6260. options takes priority on the preset values.
  6261. Available presets are:
  6262. @table @samp
  6263. @item none
  6264. @item color_negative
  6265. @item cross_process
  6266. @item darker
  6267. @item increase_contrast
  6268. @item lighter
  6269. @item linear_contrast
  6270. @item medium_contrast
  6271. @item negative
  6272. @item strong_contrast
  6273. @item vintage
  6274. @end table
  6275. Default is @code{none}.
  6276. @item master, m
  6277. Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
  6278. is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
  6279. @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
  6280. post-processing LUT.
  6281. @item red, r
  6282. Set the key points for the red component.
  6283. @item green, g
  6284. Set the key points for the green component.
  6285. @item blue, b
  6286. Set the key points for the blue component.
  6287. @item all
  6288. Set the key points for all components (not including master).
  6289. Can be used in addition to the other key points component
  6290. options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
  6291. @option{all} setting.
  6292. @item psfile
  6293. Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
  6294. @item plot
  6295. Save Gnuplot script of the curves in specified file.
  6296. @end table
  6297. To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
  6298. defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
  6299. @subsection Examples
  6300. @itemize
  6301. @item
  6302. Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
  6303. @example
  6304. curves=blue='0/0 0.5/0.58 1/1'
  6305. @end example
  6306. @item
  6307. Vintage effect:
  6308. @example
  6309. curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0/0 0.50/0.48 1/1':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
  6310. @end example
  6311. Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
  6312. @table @var
  6313. @item red
  6314. @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
  6315. @item green
  6316. @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
  6317. @item blue
  6318. @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
  6319. @end table
  6320. @item
  6321. The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
  6322. @example
  6323. curves=preset=vintage
  6324. @end example
  6325. @item
  6326. Or simply:
  6327. @example
  6328. curves=vintage
  6329. @end example
  6330. @item
  6331. Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
  6332. @example
  6333. curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0/0 0.45/0.53 1/1'
  6334. @end example
  6335. @item
  6336. Check out the curves of the @code{cross_process} profile using @command{ffmpeg}
  6337. and @command{gnuplot}:
  6338. @example
  6339. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color -vf curves=cross_process:plot=/tmp/curves.plt -frames:v 1 -f null -
  6340. gnuplot -p /tmp/curves.plt
  6341. @end example
  6342. @end itemize
  6343. @section datascope
  6344. Video data analysis filter.
  6345. This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.
  6346. The filter accepts the following options:
  6347. @table @option
  6348. @item size, s
  6349. Set output video size.
  6350. @item x
  6351. Set x offset from where to pick pixels.
  6352. @item y
  6353. Set y offset from where to pick pixels.
  6354. @item mode
  6355. Set scope mode, can be one of the following:
  6356. @table @samp
  6357. @item mono
  6358. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.
  6359. @item color
  6360. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black
  6361. background.
  6362. @item color2
  6363. Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video,
  6364. the text color is picked in such way so its always visible.
  6365. @end table
  6366. @item axis
  6367. Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.
  6368. @item opacity
  6369. Set background opacity.
  6370. @end table
  6371. @section dctdnoiz
  6372. Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
  6373. This filter is not designed for real time.
  6374. The filter accepts the following options:
  6375. @table @option
  6376. @item sigma, s
  6377. Set the noise sigma constant.
  6378. This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
  6379. coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
  6380. If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
  6381. Default is @code{0}.
  6382. @item overlap
  6383. Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
  6384. may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
  6385. risk of various artefacts.
  6386. If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
  6387. height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
  6388. Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
  6389. @item expr, e
  6390. Set the coefficient factor expression.
  6391. For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
  6392. multiplier value for the coefficient.
  6393. If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
  6394. The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
  6395. variable.
  6396. @item n
  6397. Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
  6398. @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
  6399. The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
  6400. @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
  6401. on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
  6402. better de-noising.
  6403. @end table
  6404. @subsection Examples
  6405. Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
  6406. @example
  6407. dctdnoiz=4.5
  6408. @end example
  6409. The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
  6410. @example
  6411. dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
  6412. @end example
  6413. Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
  6414. @example
  6415. dctdnoiz=15:n=4
  6416. @end example
  6417. @section deband
  6418. Remove banding artifacts from input video.
  6419. It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
  6420. The filter accepts the following options:
  6421. @table @option
  6422. @item 1thr
  6423. @item 2thr
  6424. @item 3thr
  6425. @item 4thr
  6426. Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
  6427. Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
  6428. If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
  6429. it will be considered as banded.
  6430. @item range, r
  6431. Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
  6432. in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
  6433. will be used.
  6434. The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
  6435. @item direction, d
  6436. Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
  6437. random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
  6438. absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
  6439. will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
  6440. column.
  6441. @item blur, b
  6442. If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
  6443. surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
  6444. compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
  6445. if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
  6446. @item coupling, c
  6447. If enabled, current pixel is changed if and only if all pixel components are banded,
  6448. e.g. banding detection threshold is triggered for all color components.
  6449. The default is disabled.
  6450. @end table
  6451. @section deblock
  6452. Remove blocking artifacts from input video.
  6453. The filter accepts the following options:
  6454. @table @option
  6455. @item filter
  6456. Set filter type, can be @var{weak} or @var{strong}. Default is @var{strong}.
  6457. This controls what kind of deblocking is applied.
  6458. @item block
  6459. Set size of block, allowed range is from 4 to 512. Default is @var{8}.
  6460. @item alpha
  6461. @item beta
  6462. @item gamma
  6463. @item delta
  6464. Set blocking detection thresholds. Allowed range is 0 to 1.
  6465. Defaults are: @var{0.098} for @var{alpha} and @var{0.05} for the rest.
  6466. Using higher threshold gives more deblocking strength.
  6467. Setting @var{alpha} controls threshold detection at exact edge of block.
  6468. Remaining options controls threshold detection near the edge. Each one for
  6469. below/above or left/right. Setting any of those to @var{0} disables
  6470. deblocking.
  6471. @item planes
  6472. Set planes to filter. Default is to filter all available planes.
  6473. @end table
  6474. @subsection Examples
  6475. @itemize
  6476. @item
  6477. Deblock using weak filter and block size of 4 pixels.
  6478. @example
  6479. deblock=filter=weak:block=4
  6480. @end example
  6481. @item
  6482. Deblock using strong filter, block size of 4 pixels and custom thresholds for
  6483. deblocking more edges.
  6484. @example
  6485. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05
  6486. @end example
  6487. @item
  6488. Similar as above, but filter only first plane.
  6489. @example
  6490. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=1
  6491. @end example
  6492. @item
  6493. Similar as above, but filter only second and third plane.
  6494. @example
  6495. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=6
  6496. @end example
  6497. @end itemize
  6498. @anchor{decimate}
  6499. @section decimate
  6500. Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
  6501. The filter accepts the following options:
  6502. @table @option
  6503. @item cycle
  6504. Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
  6505. @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
  6506. Default is @code{5}.
  6507. @item dupthresh
  6508. Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
  6509. is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
  6510. is @code{1.1}
  6511. @item scthresh
  6512. Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
  6513. @item blockx
  6514. @item blocky
  6515. Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
  6516. Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
  6517. small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
  6518. @item ppsrc
  6519. Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
  6520. stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
  6521. the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
  6522. @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
  6523. stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
  6524. @code{0}.
  6525. @item chroma
  6526. Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
  6527. @code{1}.
  6528. @end table
  6529. @section deconvolve
  6530. Apply 2D deconvolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6531. as impulse.
  6532. The filter accepts the following options:
  6533. @table @option
  6534. @item planes
  6535. Set which planes to process.
  6536. @item impulse
  6537. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6538. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6539. @item noise
  6540. Set noise when doing divisions. Default is @var{0.0000001}. Useful when width
  6541. and height are not same and not power of 2 or if stream prior to convolving
  6542. had noise.
  6543. @end table
  6544. The @code{deconvolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6545. @section dedot
  6546. Reduce cross-luminance (dot-crawl) and cross-color (rainbows) from video.
  6547. It accepts the following options:
  6548. @table @option
  6549. @item m
  6550. Set mode of operation. Can be combination of @var{dotcrawl} for cross-luminance reduction and/or
  6551. @var{rainbows} for cross-color reduction.
  6552. @item lt
  6553. Set spatial luma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6554. @item tl
  6555. Set tolerance for temporal luma. Higher values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6556. @item tc
  6557. Set tolerance for chroma temporal variation. Higher values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6558. @item ct
  6559. Set temporal chroma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6560. @end table
  6561. @section deflate
  6562. Apply deflate effect to the video.
  6563. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  6564. only values lower than the pixel.
  6565. It accepts the following options:
  6566. @table @option
  6567. @item threshold0
  6568. @item threshold1
  6569. @item threshold2
  6570. @item threshold3
  6571. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6572. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6573. @end table
  6574. @section deflicker
  6575. Remove temporal frame luminance variations.
  6576. It accepts the following options:
  6577. @table @option
  6578. @item size, s
  6579. Set moving-average filter size in frames. Default is 5. Allowed range is 2 - 129.
  6580. @item mode, m
  6581. Set averaging mode to smooth temporal luminance variations.
  6582. Available values are:
  6583. @table @samp
  6584. @item am
  6585. Arithmetic mean
  6586. @item gm
  6587. Geometric mean
  6588. @item hm
  6589. Harmonic mean
  6590. @item qm
  6591. Quadratic mean
  6592. @item cm
  6593. Cubic mean
  6594. @item pm
  6595. Power mean
  6596. @item median
  6597. Median
  6598. @end table
  6599. @item bypass
  6600. Do not actually modify frame. Useful when one only wants metadata.
  6601. @end table
  6602. @section dejudder
  6603. Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
  6604. Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
  6605. source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
  6606. will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
  6607. container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
  6608. rate video.
  6609. The option available in this filter is:
  6610. @table @option
  6611. @item cycle
  6612. Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
  6613. Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
  6614. @table @samp
  6615. @item 4
  6616. If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
  6617. @item 5
  6618. If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
  6619. @item 20
  6620. If a mixture of the two.
  6621. @end table
  6622. The default is @samp{4}.
  6623. @end table
  6624. @section delogo
  6625. Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
  6626. pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
  6627. (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
  6628. It accepts the following parameters:
  6629. @table @option
  6630. @item x
  6631. @item y
  6632. Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
  6633. specified.
  6634. @item w
  6635. @item h
  6636. Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
  6637. specified.
  6638. @item band, t
  6639. Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
  6640. @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
  6641. deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
  6642. is not recommended.
  6643. @item show
  6644. When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
  6645. finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
  6646. The default value is 0.
  6647. The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
  6648. replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
  6649. immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
  6650. compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
  6651. @end table
  6652. @subsection Examples
  6653. @itemize
  6654. @item
  6655. Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
  6656. and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
  6657. @example
  6658. delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
  6659. @end example
  6660. @end itemize
  6661. @section derain
  6662. Remove the rain in the input image/video by applying the derain methods based on
  6663. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  6664. @itemize
  6665. @item
  6666. Recurrent Squeeze-and-Excitation Context Aggregation Net (RESCAN).
  6667. See @url{http://openaccess.thecvf.com/content_ECCV_2018/papers/Xia_Li_Recurrent_Squeeze-and-Excitation_Context_ECCV_2018_paper.pdf}.
  6668. @end itemize
  6669. Training as well as model generation scripts are provided in
  6670. the repository at @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/derain_filter.git}.
  6671. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  6672. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  6673. The filter accepts the following options:
  6674. @table @option
  6675. @item filter_type
  6676. Specify which filter to use. This option accepts the following values:
  6677. @table @samp
  6678. @item derain
  6679. Derain filter. To conduct derain filter, you need to use a derain model.
  6680. @item dehaze
  6681. Dehaze filter. To conduct dehaze filter, you need to use a dehaze model.
  6682. @end table
  6683. Default value is @samp{derain}.
  6684. @item dnn_backend
  6685. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  6686. the following values:
  6687. @table @samp
  6688. @item native
  6689. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  6690. @item tensorflow
  6691. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  6692. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  6693. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  6694. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  6695. @end table
  6696. Default value is @samp{native}.
  6697. @item model
  6698. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  6699. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  6700. backend can load files for only its format.
  6701. @end table
  6702. @section deshake
  6703. Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
  6704. filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
  6705. tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
  6706. The filter accepts the following options:
  6707. @table @option
  6708. @item x
  6709. @item y
  6710. @item w
  6711. @item h
  6712. Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
  6713. vectors.
  6714. If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
  6715. rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
  6716. and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
  6717. filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
  6718. box.
  6719. This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
  6720. might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
  6721. If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
  6722. then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
  6723. without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
  6724. Default - search the whole frame.
  6725. @item rx
  6726. @item ry
  6727. Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
  6728. range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
  6729. @item edge
  6730. Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
  6731. frame. Available values are:
  6732. @table @samp
  6733. @item blank, 0
  6734. Fill zeroes at blank locations
  6735. @item original, 1
  6736. Original image at blank locations
  6737. @item clamp, 2
  6738. Extruded edge value at blank locations
  6739. @item mirror, 3
  6740. Mirrored edge at blank locations
  6741. @end table
  6742. Default value is @samp{mirror}.
  6743. @item blocksize
  6744. Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
  6745. default 8.
  6746. @item contrast
  6747. Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
  6748. the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
  6749. pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
  6750. @item search
  6751. Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
  6752. @table @samp
  6753. @item exhaustive, 0
  6754. Set exhaustive search
  6755. @item less, 1
  6756. Set less exhaustive search.
  6757. @end table
  6758. Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
  6759. @item filename
  6760. If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
  6761. specified file.
  6762. @end table
  6763. @section despill
  6764. Remove unwanted contamination of foreground colors, caused by reflected color of
  6765. greenscreen or bluescreen.
  6766. This filter accepts the following options:
  6767. @table @option
  6768. @item type
  6769. Set what type of despill to use.
  6770. @item mix
  6771. Set how spillmap will be generated.
  6772. @item expand
  6773. Set how much to get rid of still remaining spill.
  6774. @item red
  6775. Controls amount of red in spill area.
  6776. @item green
  6777. Controls amount of green in spill area.
  6778. Should be -1 for greenscreen.
  6779. @item blue
  6780. Controls amount of blue in spill area.
  6781. Should be -1 for bluescreen.
  6782. @item brightness
  6783. Controls brightness of spill area, preserving colors.
  6784. @item alpha
  6785. Modify alpha from generated spillmap.
  6786. @end table
  6787. @section detelecine
  6788. Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
  6789. pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
  6790. to the telecine filter.
  6791. This filter accepts the following options:
  6792. @table @option
  6793. @item first_field
  6794. @table @samp
  6795. @item top, t
  6796. top field first
  6797. @item bottom, b
  6798. bottom field first
  6799. The default value is @code{top}.
  6800. @end table
  6801. @item pattern
  6802. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  6803. The default value is @code{23}.
  6804. @item start_frame
  6805. A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
  6806. pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
  6807. @end table
  6808. @section dilation
  6809. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  6810. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  6811. It accepts the following options:
  6812. @table @option
  6813. @item threshold0
  6814. @item threshold1
  6815. @item threshold2
  6816. @item threshold3
  6817. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6818. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6819. @item coordinates
  6820. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  6821. pixels are used.
  6822. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  6823. 1 2 3
  6824. 4 5
  6825. 6 7 8
  6826. @end table
  6827. @section displace
  6828. Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
  6829. It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
  6830. source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
  6831. The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
  6832. x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
  6833. along the y-axis.
  6834. If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
  6835. displacement map will be used.
  6836. Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
  6837. A description of the accepted options follows.
  6838. @table @option
  6839. @item edge
  6840. Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
  6841. Available values are:
  6842. @table @samp
  6843. @item blank
  6844. Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
  6845. @item smear
  6846. Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
  6847. @item wrap
  6848. Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
  6849. @item mirror
  6850. Out of range pixels will be replaced with mirrored pixels.
  6851. @end table
  6852. Default is @samp{smear}.
  6853. @end table
  6854. @subsection Examples
  6855. @itemize
  6856. @item
  6857. Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  6858. @example
  6859. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
  6860. @end example
  6861. @item
  6862. Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  6863. @example
  6864. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
  6865. @end example
  6866. @end itemize
  6867. @section dnn_processing
  6868. Do image processing with deep neural networks. Currently only AVFrame with RGB24
  6869. and BGR24 are supported, more formats will be added later.
  6870. The filter accepts the following options:
  6871. @table @option
  6872. @item dnn_backend
  6873. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  6874. the following values:
  6875. @table @samp
  6876. @item native
  6877. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  6878. @item tensorflow
  6879. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  6880. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  6881. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  6882. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  6883. @end table
  6884. Default value is @samp{native}.
  6885. @item model
  6886. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  6887. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  6888. backend can load files for only its format.
  6889. Native model file (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model file (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  6890. @item input
  6891. Set the input name of the dnn network.
  6892. @item output
  6893. Set the output name of the dnn network.
  6894. @item fmt
  6895. Set the pixel format for the Frame. Allowed values are @code{AV_PIX_FMT_RGB24}, and @code{AV_PIX_FMT_BGR24}.
  6896. Default value is @code{AV_PIX_FMT_RGB24}.
  6897. @end table
  6898. @section drawbox
  6899. Draw a colored box on the input image.
  6900. It accepts the following parameters:
  6901. @table @option
  6902. @item x
  6903. @item y
  6904. The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
  6905. @item width, w
  6906. @item height, h
  6907. The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
  6908. the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
  6909. @item color, c
  6910. Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
  6911. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  6912. value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
  6913. video with inverted luma.
  6914. @item thickness, t
  6915. The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge.
  6916. A value of @code{fill} will create a filled box. Default value is @code{3}.
  6917. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  6918. @item replace
  6919. Applicable if the input has alpha. With value @code{1}, the pixels of the painted box
  6920. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  6921. Default is @code{0}, which composites the box onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  6922. @end table
  6923. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  6924. following constants:
  6925. @table @option
  6926. @item dar
  6927. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  6928. @item hsub
  6929. @item vsub
  6930. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6931. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6932. @item in_h, ih
  6933. @item in_w, iw
  6934. The input width and height.
  6935. @item sar
  6936. The input sample aspect ratio.
  6937. @item x
  6938. @item y
  6939. The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
  6940. @item w
  6941. @item h
  6942. The width and height of the drawn box.
  6943. @item t
  6944. The thickness of the drawn box.
  6945. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  6946. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  6947. @end table
  6948. @subsection Examples
  6949. @itemize
  6950. @item
  6951. Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
  6952. @example
  6953. drawbox
  6954. @end example
  6955. @item
  6956. Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  6957. @example
  6958. drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
  6959. @end example
  6960. The previous example can be specified as:
  6961. @example
  6962. drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
  6963. @end example
  6964. @item
  6965. Fill the box with pink color:
  6966. @example
  6967. drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=fill
  6968. @end example
  6969. @item
  6970. Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
  6971. @example
  6972. drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
  6973. @end example
  6974. @end itemize
  6975. @subsection Commands
  6976. This filter supports same commands as options.
  6977. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6978. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6979. value.
  6980. @anchor{drawgraph}
  6981. @section drawgraph
  6982. Draw a graph using input video metadata.
  6983. It accepts the following parameters:
  6984. @table @option
  6985. @item m1
  6986. Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  6987. @item fg1
  6988. Set 1st foreground color expression.
  6989. @item m2
  6990. Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  6991. @item fg2
  6992. Set 2nd foreground color expression.
  6993. @item m3
  6994. Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  6995. @item fg3
  6996. Set 3rd foreground color expression.
  6997. @item m4
  6998. Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  6999. @item fg4
  7000. Set 4th foreground color expression.
  7001. @item min
  7002. Set minimal value of metadata value.
  7003. @item max
  7004. Set maximal value of metadata value.
  7005. @item bg
  7006. Set graph background color. Default is white.
  7007. @item mode
  7008. Set graph mode.
  7009. Available values for mode is:
  7010. @table @samp
  7011. @item bar
  7012. @item dot
  7013. @item line
  7014. @end table
  7015. Default is @code{line}.
  7016. @item slide
  7017. Set slide mode.
  7018. Available values for slide is:
  7019. @table @samp
  7020. @item frame
  7021. Draw new frame when right border is reached.
  7022. @item replace
  7023. Replace old columns with new ones.
  7024. @item scroll
  7025. Scroll from right to left.
  7026. @item rscroll
  7027. Scroll from left to right.
  7028. @item picture
  7029. Draw single picture.
  7030. @end table
  7031. Default is @code{frame}.
  7032. @item size
  7033. Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  7034. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7035. The default value is @code{900x256}.
  7036. The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
  7037. @table @option
  7038. @item MIN
  7039. Minimal value of metadata value.
  7040. @item MAX
  7041. Maximal value of metadata value.
  7042. @item VAL
  7043. Current metadata key value.
  7044. @end table
  7045. The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
  7046. @end table
  7047. Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
  7048. @example
  7049. signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
  7050. @end example
  7051. Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
  7052. @example
  7053. ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
  7054. @end example
  7055. @section drawgrid
  7056. Draw a grid on the input image.
  7057. It accepts the following parameters:
  7058. @table @option
  7059. @item x
  7060. @item y
  7061. The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
  7062. @item width, w
  7063. @item height, h
  7064. The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
  7065. input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
  7066. framed. Default to 0.
  7067. @item color, c
  7068. Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
  7069. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7070. value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
  7071. video with inverted luma.
  7072. @item thickness, t
  7073. The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
  7074. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7075. @item replace
  7076. Applicable if the input has alpha. With @code{1} the pixels of the painted grid
  7077. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7078. Default is @code{0}, which composites the grid onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7079. @end table
  7080. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7081. following constants:
  7082. @table @option
  7083. @item dar
  7084. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7085. @item hsub
  7086. @item vsub
  7087. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7088. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7089. @item in_h, ih
  7090. @item in_w, iw
  7091. The input grid cell width and height.
  7092. @item sar
  7093. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7094. @item x
  7095. @item y
  7096. The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
  7097. @item w
  7098. @item h
  7099. The width and height of the drawn cell.
  7100. @item t
  7101. The thickness of the drawn cell.
  7102. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7103. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7104. @end table
  7105. @subsection Examples
  7106. @itemize
  7107. @item
  7108. Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7109. @example
  7110. drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
  7111. @end example
  7112. @item
  7113. Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
  7114. @example
  7115. drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
  7116. @end example
  7117. @end itemize
  7118. @subsection Commands
  7119. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7120. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7121. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7122. value.
  7123. @anchor{drawtext}
  7124. @section drawtext
  7125. Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
  7126. libfreetype library.
  7127. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7128. @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
  7129. To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
  7130. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
  7131. To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7132. @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
  7133. @subsection Syntax
  7134. It accepts the following parameters:
  7135. @table @option
  7136. @item box
  7137. Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
  7138. The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
  7139. The default value of @var{box} is 0.
  7140. @item boxborderw
  7141. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
  7142. The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
  7143. @item boxcolor
  7144. The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
  7145. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7146. The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
  7147. @item line_spacing
  7148. Set the line spacing in pixels of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{box}.
  7149. The default value of @var{line_spacing} is 0.
  7150. @item borderw
  7151. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
  7152. The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
  7153. @item bordercolor
  7154. Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
  7155. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7156. The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
  7157. @item expansion
  7158. Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
  7159. @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
  7160. @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
  7161. below for details.
  7162. @item basetime
  7163. Set a start time for the count. Value is in microseconds. Only applied
  7164. in the deprecated strftime expansion mode. To emulate in normal expansion
  7165. mode use the @code{pts} function, supplying the start time (in seconds)
  7166. as the second argument.
  7167. @item fix_bounds
  7168. If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
  7169. @item fontcolor
  7170. The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
  7171. the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7172. The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
  7173. @item fontcolor_expr
  7174. String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
  7175. @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
  7176. processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
  7177. @item font
  7178. The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
  7179. @item fontfile
  7180. The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
  7181. This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
  7182. @item alpha
  7183. Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
  7184. be a number between 0.0 and 1.0.
  7185. The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} as well.
  7186. The default value is 1.
  7187. Please see @var{fontcolor_expr}.
  7188. @item fontsize
  7189. The font size to be used for drawing text.
  7190. The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
  7191. @item text_shaping
  7192. If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
  7193. right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
  7194. Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
  7195. By default 1 (if supported).
  7196. @item ft_load_flags
  7197. The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
  7198. The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
  7199. a combination of the following values:
  7200. @table @var
  7201. @item default
  7202. @item no_scale
  7203. @item no_hinting
  7204. @item render
  7205. @item no_bitmap
  7206. @item vertical_layout
  7207. @item force_autohint
  7208. @item crop_bitmap
  7209. @item pedantic
  7210. @item ignore_global_advance_width
  7211. @item no_recurse
  7212. @item ignore_transform
  7213. @item monochrome
  7214. @item linear_design
  7215. @item no_autohint
  7216. @end table
  7217. Default value is "default".
  7218. For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
  7219. libfreetype flags.
  7220. @item shadowcolor
  7221. The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
  7222. syntax of this option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  7223. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7224. The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
  7225. @item shadowx
  7226. @item shadowy
  7227. The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
  7228. position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
  7229. values. The default value for both is "0".
  7230. @item start_number
  7231. The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
  7232. is "0".
  7233. @item tabsize
  7234. The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
  7235. Default value is 4.
  7236. @item timecode
  7237. Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
  7238. format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
  7239. option must be specified.
  7240. @item timecode_rate, rate, r
  7241. Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only). Value will be rounded to nearest
  7242. integer. Minimum value is "1".
  7243. Drop-frame timecode is supported for frame rates 30 & 60.
  7244. @item tc24hmax
  7245. If set to 1, the output of the timecode option will wrap around at 24 hours.
  7246. Default is 0 (disabled).
  7247. @item text
  7248. The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
  7249. encoded characters.
  7250. This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
  7251. @var{textfile}.
  7252. @item textfile
  7253. A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
  7254. of UTF-8 encoded characters.
  7255. This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
  7256. parameter @var{text}.
  7257. If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
  7258. @item reload
  7259. If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
  7260. Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
  7261. @item x
  7262. @item y
  7263. The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
  7264. within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
  7265. output image.
  7266. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
  7267. See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
  7268. @end table
  7269. The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
  7270. following constants and functions:
  7271. @table @option
  7272. @item dar
  7273. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  7274. @item hsub
  7275. @item vsub
  7276. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7277. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7278. @item line_h, lh
  7279. the height of each text line
  7280. @item main_h, h, H
  7281. the input height
  7282. @item main_w, w, W
  7283. the input width
  7284. @item max_glyph_a, ascent
  7285. the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
  7286. coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
  7287. glyphs.
  7288. It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
  7289. upwards.
  7290. @item max_glyph_d, descent
  7291. the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
  7292. used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
  7293. This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
  7294. upwards.
  7295. @item max_glyph_h
  7296. maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
  7297. contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
  7298. @var{descent}.
  7299. @item max_glyph_w
  7300. maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
  7301. contained in the rendered text
  7302. @item n
  7303. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  7304. @item rand(min, max)
  7305. return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
  7306. @item sar
  7307. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7308. @item t
  7309. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7310. @item text_h, th
  7311. the height of the rendered text
  7312. @item text_w, tw
  7313. the width of the rendered text
  7314. @item x
  7315. @item y
  7316. the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
  7317. These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
  7318. to each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
  7319. @item pict_type
  7320. A one character description of the current frame's picture type.
  7321. @item pkt_pos
  7322. The current packet's position in the input file or stream
  7323. (in bytes, from the start of the input). A value of -1 indicates
  7324. this info is not available.
  7325. @item pkt_duration
  7326. The current packet's duration, in seconds.
  7327. @item pkt_size
  7328. The current packet's size (in bytes).
  7329. @end table
  7330. @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
  7331. @subsection Text expansion
  7332. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
  7333. the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
  7334. expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
  7335. feature is deprecated.
  7336. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
  7337. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
  7338. the following expansion mechanism is used.
  7339. The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
  7340. the second character.
  7341. Sequences of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
  7342. braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
  7343. If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
  7344. they should be escaped.
  7345. Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
  7346. @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
  7347. argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
  7348. that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
  7349. problems.
  7350. The following functions are available:
  7351. @table @command
  7352. @item expr, e
  7353. The expression evaluation result.
  7354. It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
  7355. which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
  7356. @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
  7357. example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
  7358. the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
  7359. value.
  7360. @item expr_int_format, eif
  7361. Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
  7362. The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
  7363. The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
  7364. @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
  7365. @code{printf} function.
  7366. The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
  7367. It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
  7368. @item gmtime
  7369. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
  7370. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7371. @item localtime
  7372. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
  7373. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7374. @item metadata
  7375. Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.
  7376. The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.
  7377. The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the
  7378. metadata key is not found or empty.
  7379. Available metadata can be identified by inspecting entries
  7380. starting with TAG included within each frame section
  7381. printed by running @code{ffprobe -show_frames}.
  7382. String metadata generated in filters leading to
  7383. the drawtext filter are also available.
  7384. @item n, frame_num
  7385. The frame number, starting from 0.
  7386. @item pict_type
  7387. A one character description of the current picture type.
  7388. @item pts
  7389. The timestamp of the current frame.
  7390. It can take up to three arguments.
  7391. The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
  7392. for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
  7393. for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
  7394. @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
  7395. @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
  7396. local time zone time.
  7397. The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
  7398. If the format is set to @code{hms}, a third argument @code{24HH} may be
  7399. supplied to present the hour part of the formatted timestamp in 24h format
  7400. (00-23).
  7401. If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
  7402. a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
  7403. By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
  7404. @end table
  7405. @subsection Commands
  7406. This filter supports altering parameters via commands:
  7407. @table @option
  7408. @item reinit
  7409. Alter existing filter parameters.
  7410. Syntax for the argument is the same as for filter invocation, e.g.
  7411. @example
  7412. fontsize=56:fontcolor=green:text='Hello World'
  7413. @end example
  7414. Full filter invocation with sendcmd would look like this:
  7415. @example
  7416. sendcmd=c='56.0 drawtext reinit fontsize=56\:fontcolor=green\:text=Hello\\ World'
  7417. @end example
  7418. @end table
  7419. If the entire argument can't be parsed or applied as valid values then the filter will
  7420. continue with its existing parameters.
  7421. @subsection Examples
  7422. @itemize
  7423. @item
  7424. Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
  7425. optional parameters.
  7426. @example
  7427. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
  7428. @end example
  7429. @item
  7430. Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
  7431. and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
  7432. yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
  7433. opacity of 20%.
  7434. @example
  7435. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
  7436. x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
  7437. @end example
  7438. Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
  7439. within the parameter list.
  7440. @item
  7441. Show the text at the center of the video frame:
  7442. @example
  7443. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
  7444. @end example
  7445. @item
  7446. Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:
  7447. @example
  7448. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"
  7449. @end example
  7450. @item
  7451. Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
  7452. frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
  7453. with no newlines.
  7454. @example
  7455. drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
  7456. @end example
  7457. @item
  7458. Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
  7459. @example
  7460. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
  7461. @end example
  7462. @item
  7463. Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
  7464. The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
  7465. @example
  7466. drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
  7467. @end example
  7468. @item
  7469. Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
  7470. @example
  7471. drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
  7472. @end example
  7473. @item
  7474. Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
  7475. @example
  7476. drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
  7477. @end example
  7478. @item
  7479. Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
  7480. @example
  7481. drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
  7482. @end example
  7483. @item
  7484. Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
  7485. @example
  7486. #!/bin/sh
  7487. DS=1.0 # display start
  7488. DE=10.0 # display end
  7489. FID=1.5 # fade in duration
  7490. FOD=5 # fade out duration
  7491. ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
  7492. @end example
  7493. @item
  7494. Horizontally align multiple separate texts. Note that @option{max_glyph_a}
  7495. and the @option{fontsize} value are included in the @option{y} offset.
  7496. @example
  7497. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=DOG:fontsize=24:x=10:y=20+24-max_glyph_a,
  7498. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=cow:fontsize=24:x=80:y=20+24-max_glyph_a
  7499. @end example
  7500. @end itemize
  7501. For more information about libfreetype, check:
  7502. @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
  7503. For more information about fontconfig, check:
  7504. @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
  7505. For more information about libfribidi, check:
  7506. @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
  7507. @section edgedetect
  7508. Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
  7509. The filter accepts the following options:
  7510. @table @option
  7511. @item low
  7512. @item high
  7513. Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
  7514. algorithm.
  7515. The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
  7516. connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
  7517. by the low threshold.
  7518. @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
  7519. [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
  7520. Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
  7521. is @code{50/255}.
  7522. @item mode
  7523. Define the drawing mode.
  7524. @table @samp
  7525. @item wires
  7526. Draw white/gray wires on black background.
  7527. @item colormix
  7528. Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
  7529. @item canny
  7530. Apply Canny edge detector on all selected planes.
  7531. @end table
  7532. Default value is @var{wires}.
  7533. @item planes
  7534. Select planes for filtering. By default all available planes are filtered.
  7535. @end table
  7536. @subsection Examples
  7537. @itemize
  7538. @item
  7539. Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
  7540. @example
  7541. edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
  7542. @end example
  7543. @item
  7544. Painting effect without thresholding:
  7545. @example
  7546. edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
  7547. @end example
  7548. @end itemize
  7549. @section elbg
  7550. Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
  7551. For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
  7552. the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
  7553. of distinct output colors.
  7554. This filter accepts the following options.
  7555. @table @option
  7556. @item codebook_length, l
  7557. Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
  7558. represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
  7559. @item nb_steps, n
  7560. Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
  7561. mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
  7562. computation time. Default value is 1.
  7563. @item seed, s
  7564. Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
  7565. UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
  7566. will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
  7567. @item pal8
  7568. Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
  7569. length greater than 256.
  7570. @end table
  7571. @section entropy
  7572. Measure graylevel entropy in histogram of color channels of video frames.
  7573. It accepts the following parameters:
  7574. @table @option
  7575. @item mode
  7576. Can be either @var{normal} or @var{diff}. Default is @var{normal}.
  7577. @var{diff} mode measures entropy of histogram delta values, absolute differences
  7578. between neighbour histogram values.
  7579. @end table
  7580. @section eq
  7581. Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
  7582. The filter accepts the following options:
  7583. @table @option
  7584. @item contrast
  7585. Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
  7586. @code{-1000.0} to @code{1000.0}. The default value is "1".
  7587. @item brightness
  7588. Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
  7589. range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
  7590. @item saturation
  7591. Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
  7592. range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
  7593. @item gamma
  7594. Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
  7595. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7596. @item gamma_r
  7597. Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
  7598. range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7599. @item gamma_g
  7600. Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
  7601. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7602. @item gamma_b
  7603. Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
  7604. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7605. @item gamma_weight
  7606. Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
  7607. of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
  7608. getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
  7609. in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
  7610. gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
  7611. full strength. Default is "1".
  7612. @item eval
  7613. Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
  7614. gamma expressions are evaluated.
  7615. It accepts the following values:
  7616. @table @samp
  7617. @item init
  7618. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  7619. when a command is processed
  7620. @item frame
  7621. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  7622. @end table
  7623. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7624. @end table
  7625. The expressions accept the following parameters:
  7626. @table @option
  7627. @item n
  7628. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  7629. @item pos
  7630. byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
  7631. unspecified
  7632. @item r
  7633. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  7634. @item t
  7635. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7636. @end table
  7637. @subsection Commands
  7638. The filter supports the following commands:
  7639. @table @option
  7640. @item contrast
  7641. Set the contrast expression.
  7642. @item brightness
  7643. Set the brightness expression.
  7644. @item saturation
  7645. Set the saturation expression.
  7646. @item gamma
  7647. Set the gamma expression.
  7648. @item gamma_r
  7649. Set the gamma_r expression.
  7650. @item gamma_g
  7651. Set gamma_g expression.
  7652. @item gamma_b
  7653. Set gamma_b expression.
  7654. @item gamma_weight
  7655. Set gamma_weight expression.
  7656. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7657. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7658. value.
  7659. @end table
  7660. @section erosion
  7661. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  7662. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  7663. It accepts the following options:
  7664. @table @option
  7665. @item threshold0
  7666. @item threshold1
  7667. @item threshold2
  7668. @item threshold3
  7669. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  7670. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  7671. @item coordinates
  7672. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  7673. pixels are used.
  7674. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  7675. 1 2 3
  7676. 4 5
  7677. 6 7 8
  7678. @end table
  7679. @section extractplanes
  7680. Extract color channel components from input video stream into
  7681. separate grayscale video streams.
  7682. The filter accepts the following option:
  7683. @table @option
  7684. @item planes
  7685. Set plane(s) to extract.
  7686. Available values for planes are:
  7687. @table @samp
  7688. @item y
  7689. @item u
  7690. @item v
  7691. @item a
  7692. @item r
  7693. @item g
  7694. @item b
  7695. @end table
  7696. Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
  7697. That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
  7698. with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
  7699. @end table
  7700. @subsection Examples
  7701. @itemize
  7702. @item
  7703. Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
  7704. into 3 grayscale outputs:
  7705. @example
  7706. ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
  7707. @end example
  7708. @end itemize
  7709. @section fade
  7710. Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
  7711. It accepts the following parameters:
  7712. @table @option
  7713. @item type, t
  7714. The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
  7715. effect.
  7716. Default is @code{in}.
  7717. @item start_frame, s
  7718. Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
  7719. effect at. Default is 0.
  7720. @item nb_frames, n
  7721. The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
  7722. fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
  7723. At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
  7724. selected @option{color}.
  7725. Default is 25.
  7726. @item alpha
  7727. If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
  7728. Default value is 0.
  7729. @item start_time, st
  7730. Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
  7731. effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
  7732. whichever comes last. Default is 0.
  7733. @item duration, d
  7734. The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
  7735. fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
  7736. at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
  7737. selected @option{color}.
  7738. If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
  7739. (nb_frames is used by default).
  7740. @item color, c
  7741. Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
  7742. @end table
  7743. @subsection Examples
  7744. @itemize
  7745. @item
  7746. Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
  7747. @example
  7748. fade=in:0:30
  7749. @end example
  7750. The command above is equivalent to:
  7751. @example
  7752. fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
  7753. @end example
  7754. @item
  7755. Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
  7756. @example
  7757. fade=out:155:45
  7758. fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
  7759. @end example
  7760. @item
  7761. Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
  7762. @example
  7763. fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
  7764. @end example
  7765. @item
  7766. Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
  7767. @example
  7768. fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
  7769. @end example
  7770. @item
  7771. Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
  7772. @example
  7773. fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
  7774. @end example
  7775. @item
  7776. Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
  7777. @example
  7778. fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
  7779. @end example
  7780. @end itemize
  7781. @section fftdnoiz
  7782. Denoise frames using 3D FFT (frequency domain filtering).
  7783. The filter accepts the following options:
  7784. @table @option
  7785. @item sigma
  7786. Set the noise sigma constant. This sets denoising strength.
  7787. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 30.
  7788. Using very high sigma with low overlap may give blocking artifacts.
  7789. @item amount
  7790. Set amount of denoising. By default all detected noise is reduced.
  7791. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  7792. @item block
  7793. Set size of block, Default is 4, can be 3, 4, 5 or 6.
  7794. Actual size of block in pixels is 2 to power of @var{block}, so by default
  7795. block size in pixels is 2^4 which is 16.
  7796. @item overlap
  7797. Set block overlap. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0.2 to 0.8.
  7798. @item prev
  7799. Set number of previous frames to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7800. @item next
  7801. Set number of next frames to to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7802. @item planes
  7803. Set planes which will be filtered, by default are all available filtered
  7804. except alpha.
  7805. @end table
  7806. @section fftfilt
  7807. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
  7808. @table @option
  7809. @item dc_Y
  7810. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
  7811. accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
  7812. value is set to @code{0}.
  7813. @item dc_U
  7814. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
  7815. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  7816. default value is set to @code{0}.
  7817. @item dc_V
  7818. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
  7819. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  7820. default value is set to @code{0}.
  7821. @item weight_Y
  7822. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
  7823. @item weight_U
  7824. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
  7825. @item weight_V
  7826. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
  7827. @item eval
  7828. Set when the expressions are evaluated.
  7829. It accepts the following values:
  7830. @table @samp
  7831. @item init
  7832. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization.
  7833. @item frame
  7834. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  7835. @end table
  7836. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7837. The filter accepts the following variables:
  7838. @item X
  7839. @item Y
  7840. The coordinates of the current sample.
  7841. @item W
  7842. @item H
  7843. The width and height of the image.
  7844. @item N
  7845. The number of input frame, starting from 0.
  7846. @end table
  7847. @subsection Examples
  7848. @itemize
  7849. @item
  7850. High-pass:
  7851. @example
  7852. fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  7853. @end example
  7854. @item
  7855. Low-pass:
  7856. @example
  7857. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
  7858. @end example
  7859. @item
  7860. Sharpen:
  7861. @example
  7862. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  7863. @end example
  7864. @item
  7865. Blur:
  7866. @example
  7867. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
  7868. @end example
  7869. @end itemize
  7870. @section field
  7871. Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
  7872. arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
  7873. non-interlaced.
  7874. The filter accepts the following options:
  7875. @table @option
  7876. @item type
  7877. Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
  7878. @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
  7879. @code{bottom}).
  7880. @end table
  7881. @section fieldhint
  7882. Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
  7883. supplied as numbers by the hint file.
  7884. @table @option
  7885. @item hint
  7886. Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
  7887. There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
  7888. numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
  7889. Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
  7890. is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
  7891. for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
  7892. field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
  7893. If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
  7894. else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
  7895. it will be marked same as input frame.
  7896. If optionally followed by @code{t} output frame will use only top field, or in
  7897. case of @code{b} it will use only bottom field.
  7898. If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
  7899. @item mode
  7900. Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
  7901. @end table
  7902. Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
  7903. @example
  7904. 0,0 - # first frame
  7905. 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
  7906. 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
  7907. 1,0 -
  7908. 0,0 -
  7909. 0,0 -
  7910. 1,0 -
  7911. 1,0 -
  7912. 1,0 -
  7913. 0,0 -
  7914. 0,0 -
  7915. 1,0 -
  7916. 1,0 -
  7917. 1,0 -
  7918. 0,0 -
  7919. @end example
  7920. @section fieldmatch
  7921. Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
  7922. progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
  7923. frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
  7924. followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
  7925. The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
  7926. the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
  7927. If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
  7928. @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
  7929. But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
  7930. de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
  7931. In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
  7932. optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
  7933. enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
  7934. this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
  7935. help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
  7936. (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
  7937. or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
  7938. Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
  7939. and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
  7940. which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
  7941. close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
  7942. The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
  7943. If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
  7944. framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
  7945. stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
  7946. The filter accepts the following options:
  7947. @table @option
  7948. @item order
  7949. Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
  7950. @table @samp
  7951. @item auto
  7952. Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
  7953. @item bff
  7954. Assume bottom field first.
  7955. @item tff
  7956. Assume top field first.
  7957. @end table
  7958. Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
  7959. stream.
  7960. Default value is @var{auto}.
  7961. @item mode
  7962. Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
  7963. sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
  7964. possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
  7965. outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
  7966. hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
  7967. but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
  7968. all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
  7969. jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
  7970. with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
  7971. More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
  7972. Available values are:
  7973. @table @samp
  7974. @item pc
  7975. 2-way matching (p/c)
  7976. @item pc_n
  7977. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
  7978. @item pc_u
  7979. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
  7980. @item pc_n_ub
  7981. 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
  7982. still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
  7983. @item pcn
  7984. 3-way matching (p/c/n)
  7985. @item pcn_ub
  7986. 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
  7987. detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
  7988. @end table
  7989. The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
  7990. mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
  7991. @var{top}).
  7992. In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
  7993. the slowest.
  7994. Default value is @var{pc_n}.
  7995. @item ppsrc
  7996. Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
  7997. input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
  7998. introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
  7999. VFM/TFM.
  8000. Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
  8001. @item field
  8002. Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
  8003. @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
  8004. certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
  8005. large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
  8006. @table @samp
  8007. @item auto
  8008. Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
  8009. @item bottom
  8010. Match from the bottom field.
  8011. @item top
  8012. Match from the top field.
  8013. @end table
  8014. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8015. @item mchroma
  8016. Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
  8017. cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
  8018. only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
  8019. artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
  8020. the cost of some accuracy.
  8021. Default value is @code{1}.
  8022. @item y0
  8023. @item y1
  8024. These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
  8025. @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
  8026. band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
  8027. interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
  8028. @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
  8029. @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
  8030. @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
  8031. @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
  8032. @item scthresh
  8033. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
  8034. the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
  8035. detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
  8036. @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
  8037. Default value is @code{12.0}.
  8038. @item combmatch
  8039. When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
  8040. account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
  8041. final match. Available values are:
  8042. @table @samp
  8043. @item none
  8044. No final matching based on combed scores.
  8045. @item sc
  8046. Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
  8047. @item full
  8048. Use combed scores all the time.
  8049. @end table
  8050. Default is @var{sc}.
  8051. @item combdbg
  8052. Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
  8053. print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8054. Available values are:
  8055. @table @samp
  8056. @item none
  8057. No forced calculation.
  8058. @item pcn
  8059. Force p/c/n calculations.
  8060. @item pcnub
  8061. Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
  8062. @end table
  8063. Default value is @var{none}.
  8064. @item cthresh
  8065. This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
  8066. essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
  8067. Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
  8068. can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
  8069. @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
  8070. be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
  8071. range is @code{[8, 12]}.
  8072. Default value is @code{9}.
  8073. @item chroma
  8074. Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
  8075. disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
  8076. causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
  8077. using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
  8078. where there is chroma only combing in the source.
  8079. Default value is @code{0}.
  8080. @item blockx
  8081. @item blocky
  8082. Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
  8083. frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
  8084. @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
  8085. declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
  8086. Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
  8087. to 512.
  8088. Default value is @code{16}.
  8089. @item combpel
  8090. The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
  8091. @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
  8092. combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
  8093. setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
  8094. window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
  8095. frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
  8096. which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
  8097. as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8098. Default value is @code{80}.
  8099. @end table
  8100. @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
  8101. @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
  8102. @subsubsection p/c/n
  8103. We assume the following telecined stream:
  8104. @example
  8105. Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
  8106. Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
  8107. @end example
  8108. The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
  8109. first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
  8110. When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
  8111. (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
  8112. @example
  8113. Input stream:
  8114. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8115. B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
  8116. Matches: c c n n c
  8117. Output stream:
  8118. T 1 2 3 4 4
  8119. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8120. @end example
  8121. As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
  8122. To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
  8123. after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
  8124. The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
  8125. looks like this:
  8126. @example
  8127. Input stream:
  8128. T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
  8129. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8130. Matches: c c p p c
  8131. Output stream:
  8132. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8133. B 1 2 2 3 4
  8134. @end example
  8135. In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
  8136. basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
  8137. @itemize
  8138. @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
  8139. @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
  8140. @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
  8141. @end itemize
  8142. @subsubsection u/b
  8143. The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
  8144. from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
  8145. currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
  8146. 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
  8147. With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
  8148. @example
  8149. Match: c p n b u
  8150. x x x x x
  8151. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8152. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8153. x x x x x
  8154. Output frames:
  8155. 2 1 2 2 2
  8156. 2 2 2 1 3
  8157. @end example
  8158. With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
  8159. @example
  8160. Match: c p n b u
  8161. x x x x x
  8162. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8163. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8164. x x x x x
  8165. Output frames:
  8166. 2 2 2 1 2
  8167. 2 1 3 2 2
  8168. @end example
  8169. @subsection Examples
  8170. Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
  8171. @example
  8172. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
  8173. @end example
  8174. Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
  8175. @example
  8176. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
  8177. @end example
  8178. @section fieldorder
  8179. Transform the field order of the input video.
  8180. It accepts the following parameters:
  8181. @table @option
  8182. @item order
  8183. The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
  8184. for bottom field first.
  8185. @end table
  8186. The default value is @samp{tff}.
  8187. The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
  8188. by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
  8189. This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
  8190. If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
  8191. flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
  8192. not alter the incoming video.
  8193. It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
  8194. which is bottom field first.
  8195. For example:
  8196. @example
  8197. ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
  8198. @end example
  8199. @section fifo, afifo
  8200. Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
  8201. It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
  8202. framework.
  8203. It does not take parameters.
  8204. @section fillborders
  8205. Fill borders of the input video, without changing video stream dimensions.
  8206. Sometimes video can have garbage at the four edges and you may not want to
  8207. crop video input to keep size multiple of some number.
  8208. This filter accepts the following options:
  8209. @table @option
  8210. @item left
  8211. Number of pixels to fill from left border.
  8212. @item right
  8213. Number of pixels to fill from right border.
  8214. @item top
  8215. Number of pixels to fill from top border.
  8216. @item bottom
  8217. Number of pixels to fill from bottom border.
  8218. @item mode
  8219. Set fill mode.
  8220. It accepts the following values:
  8221. @table @samp
  8222. @item smear
  8223. fill pixels using outermost pixels
  8224. @item mirror
  8225. fill pixels using mirroring
  8226. @item fixed
  8227. fill pixels with constant value
  8228. @end table
  8229. Default is @var{smear}.
  8230. @item color
  8231. Set color for pixels in fixed mode. Default is @var{black}.
  8232. @end table
  8233. @section find_rect
  8234. Find a rectangular object
  8235. It accepts the following options:
  8236. @table @option
  8237. @item object
  8238. Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
  8239. @item threshold
  8240. Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
  8241. @item mipmaps
  8242. Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
  8243. @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
  8244. Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
  8245. @end table
  8246. @subsection Examples
  8247. @itemize
  8248. @item
  8249. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8250. @example
  8251. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  8252. @end example
  8253. @end itemize
  8254. @section floodfill
  8255. Flood area with values of same pixel components with another values.
  8256. It accepts the following options:
  8257. @table @option
  8258. @item x
  8259. Set pixel x coordinate.
  8260. @item y
  8261. Set pixel y coordinate.
  8262. @item s0
  8263. Set source #0 component value.
  8264. @item s1
  8265. Set source #1 component value.
  8266. @item s2
  8267. Set source #2 component value.
  8268. @item s3
  8269. Set source #3 component value.
  8270. @item d0
  8271. Set destination #0 component value.
  8272. @item d1
  8273. Set destination #1 component value.
  8274. @item d2
  8275. Set destination #2 component value.
  8276. @item d3
  8277. Set destination #3 component value.
  8278. @end table
  8279. @anchor{format}
  8280. @section format
  8281. Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
  8282. Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
  8283. the next filter.
  8284. It accepts the following parameters:
  8285. @table @option
  8286. @item pix_fmts
  8287. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  8288. "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  8289. @end table
  8290. @subsection Examples
  8291. @itemize
  8292. @item
  8293. Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
  8294. @example
  8295. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
  8296. @end example
  8297. Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
  8298. @example
  8299. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  8300. @end example
  8301. @end itemize
  8302. @anchor{fps}
  8303. @section fps
  8304. Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
  8305. frames as necessary.
  8306. It accepts the following parameters:
  8307. @table @option
  8308. @item fps
  8309. The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
  8310. @item start_time
  8311. Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
  8312. padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
  8313. about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
  8314. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
  8315. the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
  8316. frames with a negative PTS.
  8317. @item round
  8318. Timestamp (PTS) rounding method.
  8319. Possible values are:
  8320. @table @option
  8321. @item zero
  8322. round towards 0
  8323. @item inf
  8324. round away from 0
  8325. @item down
  8326. round towards -infinity
  8327. @item up
  8328. round towards +infinity
  8329. @item near
  8330. round to nearest
  8331. @end table
  8332. The default is @code{near}.
  8333. @item eof_action
  8334. Action performed when reading the last frame.
  8335. Possible values are:
  8336. @table @option
  8337. @item round
  8338. Use same timestamp rounding method as used for other frames.
  8339. @item pass
  8340. Pass through last frame if input duration has not been reached yet.
  8341. @end table
  8342. The default is @code{round}.
  8343. @end table
  8344. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8345. @var{fps}[:@var{start_time}[:@var{round}]].
  8346. See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
  8347. @subsection Examples
  8348. @itemize
  8349. @item
  8350. A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
  8351. @example
  8352. fps=fps=25
  8353. @end example
  8354. @item
  8355. Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
  8356. @example
  8357. fps=fps=film:round=near
  8358. @end example
  8359. @end itemize
  8360. @section framepack
  8361. Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
  8362. metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
  8363. framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
  8364. that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
  8365. @ref{fps} filters.
  8366. It accepts the following parameters:
  8367. @table @option
  8368. @item format
  8369. The desired packing format. Supported values are:
  8370. @table @option
  8371. @item sbs
  8372. The views are next to each other (default).
  8373. @item tab
  8374. The views are on top of each other.
  8375. @item lines
  8376. The views are packed by line.
  8377. @item columns
  8378. The views are packed by column.
  8379. @item frameseq
  8380. The views are temporally interleaved.
  8381. @end table
  8382. @end table
  8383. Some examples:
  8384. @example
  8385. # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
  8386. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
  8387. # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
  8388. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
  8389. @end example
  8390. @section framerate
  8391. Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
  8392. frames.
  8393. This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
  8394. you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
  8395. to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
  8396. A description of the accepted options follows.
  8397. @table @option
  8398. @item fps
  8399. Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
  8400. as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
  8401. @item interp_start
  8402. Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8403. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8404. the default is @code{15}.
  8405. @item interp_end
  8406. Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8407. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8408. the default is @code{240}.
  8409. @item scene
  8410. Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
  8411. 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  8412. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  8413. value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
  8414. The default is @code{8.2}.
  8415. @item flags
  8416. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  8417. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  8418. @table @option
  8419. @item scene_change_detect, scd
  8420. Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
  8421. This flag is enabled by default.
  8422. @end table
  8423. @end table
  8424. @section framestep
  8425. Select one frame every N-th frame.
  8426. This filter accepts the following option:
  8427. @table @option
  8428. @item step
  8429. Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
  8430. Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
  8431. @end table
  8432. @section freezedetect
  8433. Detect frozen video.
  8434. This filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects that the
  8435. input video has no significant change in content during a specified duration.
  8436. Video freeze detection calculates the mean average absolute difference of all
  8437. the components of video frames and compares it to a noise floor.
  8438. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  8439. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_start} metadata key is set on the first frame
  8440. whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection duration and it contains the
  8441. timestamp of the first frame of the freeze. The
  8442. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_duration} and
  8443. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_end} metadata keys are set on the first frame
  8444. after the freeze.
  8445. The filter accepts the following options:
  8446. @table @option
  8447. @item noise, n
  8448. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  8449. specified value) or as a difference ratio between 0 and 1. Default is -60dB, or
  8450. 0.001.
  8451. @item duration, d
  8452. Set freeze duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  8453. @end table
  8454. @anchor{frei0r}
  8455. @section frei0r
  8456. Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
  8457. To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
  8458. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  8459. It accepts the following parameters:
  8460. @table @option
  8461. @item filter_name
  8462. The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
  8463. @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
  8464. directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREI0R_PATH}.
  8465. Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
  8466. @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
  8467. @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
  8468. @item filter_params
  8469. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
  8470. @end table
  8471. A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
  8472. "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
  8473. @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
  8474. numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or a color description as specified in the
  8475. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils},
  8476. a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
  8477. @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
  8478. The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
  8479. effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
  8480. @subsection Examples
  8481. @itemize
  8482. @item
  8483. Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
  8484. @example
  8485. frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
  8486. @end example
  8487. @item
  8488. Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
  8489. @example
  8490. frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
  8491. frei0r=colordistance:violet
  8492. frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
  8493. @end example
  8494. @item
  8495. Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
  8496. positions:
  8497. @example
  8498. frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
  8499. @end example
  8500. @end itemize
  8501. For more information, see
  8502. @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
  8503. @section fspp
  8504. Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
  8505. It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
  8506. processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
  8507. This allows for much higher speed.
  8508. The filter accepts the following options:
  8509. @table @option
  8510. @item quality
  8511. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  8512. an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
  8513. @item qp
  8514. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
  8515. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
  8516. @item strength
  8517. Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
  8518. more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
  8519. but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
  8520. @item use_bframe_qp
  8521. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  8522. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  8523. @code{0} (not enabled).
  8524. @end table
  8525. @section gblur
  8526. Apply Gaussian blur filter.
  8527. The filter accepts the following options:
  8528. @table @option
  8529. @item sigma
  8530. Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is @code{0.5}.
  8531. @item steps
  8532. Set number of steps for Gaussian approximation. Default is @code{1}.
  8533. @item planes
  8534. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  8535. @item sigmaV
  8536. Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as @code{sigma}.
  8537. Default is @code{-1}.
  8538. @end table
  8539. @subsection Commands
  8540. This filter supports same commands as options.
  8541. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8542. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8543. value.
  8544. @section geq
  8545. Apply generic equation to each pixel.
  8546. The filter accepts the following options:
  8547. @table @option
  8548. @item lum_expr, lum
  8549. Set the luminance expression.
  8550. @item cb_expr, cb
  8551. Set the chrominance blue expression.
  8552. @item cr_expr, cr
  8553. Set the chrominance red expression.
  8554. @item alpha_expr, a
  8555. Set the alpha expression.
  8556. @item red_expr, r
  8557. Set the red expression.
  8558. @item green_expr, g
  8559. Set the green expression.
  8560. @item blue_expr, b
  8561. Set the blue expression.
  8562. @end table
  8563. The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
  8564. of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
  8565. options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
  8566. colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
  8567. @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
  8568. colorspace.
  8569. If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
  8570. one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
  8571. If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
  8572. to the luminance expression.
  8573. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  8574. @table @option
  8575. @item N
  8576. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  8577. @item X
  8578. @item Y
  8579. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8580. @item W
  8581. @item H
  8582. The width and height of the image.
  8583. @item SW
  8584. @item SH
  8585. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  8586. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  8587. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  8588. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  8589. @item T
  8590. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  8591. @item p(x, y)
  8592. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
  8593. plane.
  8594. @item lum(x, y)
  8595. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
  8596. plane.
  8597. @item cb(x, y)
  8598. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8599. blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8600. @item cr(x, y)
  8601. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8602. red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8603. @item r(x, y)
  8604. @item g(x, y)
  8605. @item b(x, y)
  8606. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8607. red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
  8608. @item alpha(x, y)
  8609. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
  8610. plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8611. @item interpolation
  8612. Set one of interpolation methods:
  8613. @table @option
  8614. @item nearest, n
  8615. @item bilinear, b
  8616. @end table
  8617. Default is bilinear.
  8618. @end table
  8619. For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
  8620. automatically clipped to the closer edge.
  8621. @subsection Examples
  8622. @itemize
  8623. @item
  8624. Flip the image horizontally:
  8625. @example
  8626. geq=p(W-X\,Y)
  8627. @end example
  8628. @item
  8629. Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
  8630. wavelength of 100 pixels:
  8631. @example
  8632. geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
  8633. @end example
  8634. @item
  8635. Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
  8636. @example
  8637. nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
  8638. @end example
  8639. @item
  8640. Generate a quick emboss effect:
  8641. @example
  8642. format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
  8643. @end example
  8644. @item
  8645. Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
  8646. @example
  8647. geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
  8648. @end example
  8649. @item
  8650. Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
  8651. the @ref{vignette} filter):
  8652. @example
  8653. geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
  8654. @end example
  8655. @end itemize
  8656. @section gradfun
  8657. Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
  8658. regions by truncation to 8-bit color depth.
  8659. Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
  8660. dither them.
  8661. It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
  8662. lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
  8663. bring back the bands.
  8664. It accepts the following parameters:
  8665. @table @option
  8666. @item strength
  8667. The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
  8668. the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
  8669. .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
  8670. valid range.
  8671. @item radius
  8672. The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
  8673. gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
  8674. regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
  8675. values will be clipped to the valid range.
  8676. @end table
  8677. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8678. @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
  8679. @subsection Examples
  8680. @itemize
  8681. @item
  8682. Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
  8683. @example
  8684. gradfun=3.5:8
  8685. @end example
  8686. @item
  8687. Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
  8688. value):
  8689. @example
  8690. gradfun=radius=8
  8691. @end example
  8692. @end itemize
  8693. @anchor{graphmonitor}
  8694. @section graphmonitor
  8695. Show various filtergraph stats.
  8696. With this filter one can debug complete filtergraph.
  8697. Especially issues with links filling with queued frames.
  8698. The filter accepts the following options:
  8699. @table @option
  8700. @item size, s
  8701. Set video output size. Default is @var{hd720}.
  8702. @item opacity, o
  8703. Set video opacity. Default is @var{0.9}. Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{1}.
  8704. @item mode, m
  8705. Set output mode, can be @var{fulll} or @var{compact}.
  8706. In @var{compact} mode only filters with some queued frames have displayed stats.
  8707. @item flags, f
  8708. Set flags which enable which stats are shown in video.
  8709. Available values for flags are:
  8710. @table @samp
  8711. @item queue
  8712. Display number of queued frames in each link.
  8713. @item frame_count_in
  8714. Display number of frames taken from filter.
  8715. @item frame_count_out
  8716. Display number of frames given out from filter.
  8717. @item pts
  8718. Display current filtered frame pts.
  8719. @item time
  8720. Display current filtered frame time.
  8721. @item timebase
  8722. Display time base for filter link.
  8723. @item format
  8724. Display used format for filter link.
  8725. @item size
  8726. Display video size or number of audio channels in case of audio used by filter link.
  8727. @item rate
  8728. Display video frame rate or sample rate in case of audio used by filter link.
  8729. @end table
  8730. @item rate, r
  8731. Set upper limit for video rate of output stream, Default value is @var{25}.
  8732. This guarantee that output video frame rate will not be higher than this value.
  8733. @end table
  8734. @section greyedge
  8735. A color constancy variation filter which estimates scene illumination via grey edge algorithm
  8736. and corrects the scene colors accordingly.
  8737. See: @url{https://staff.science.uva.nl/th.gevers/pub/GeversTIP07.pdf}
  8738. The filter accepts the following options:
  8739. @table @option
  8740. @item difford
  8741. The order of differentiation to be applied on the scene. Must be chosen in the range
  8742. [0,2] and default value is 1.
  8743. @item minknorm
  8744. The Minkowski parameter to be used for calculating the Minkowski distance. Must
  8745. be chosen in the range [0,20] and default value is 1. Set to 0 for getting
  8746. max value instead of calculating Minkowski distance.
  8747. @item sigma
  8748. The standard deviation of Gaussian blur to be applied on the scene. Must be
  8749. chosen in the range [0,1024.0] and default value = 1. floor( @var{sigma} * break_off_sigma(3) )
  8750. can't be equal to 0 if @var{difford} is greater than 0.
  8751. @end table
  8752. @subsection Examples
  8753. @itemize
  8754. @item
  8755. Grey Edge:
  8756. @example
  8757. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=5:sigma=2
  8758. @end example
  8759. @item
  8760. Max Edge:
  8761. @example
  8762. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=0:sigma=2
  8763. @end example
  8764. @end itemize
  8765. @anchor{haldclut}
  8766. @section haldclut
  8767. Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
  8768. First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
  8769. The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
  8770. The filter accepts the following options:
  8771. @table @option
  8772. @item shortest
  8773. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
  8774. @item repeatlast
  8775. Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
  8776. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
  8777. Default is @code{1}.
  8778. @end table
  8779. @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
  8780. filters share the same internals).
  8781. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  8782. More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
  8783. (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
  8784. @subsection Workflow examples
  8785. @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
  8786. Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
  8787. @example
  8788. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
  8789. @end example
  8790. Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
  8791. Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
  8792. @example
  8793. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
  8794. @end example
  8795. The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
  8796. @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
  8797. to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
  8798. @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
  8799. A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
  8800. @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
  8801. biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
  8802. padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
  8803. a preview of the Hald CLUT.
  8804. Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
  8805. @code{haldclut} filter:
  8806. @example
  8807. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
  8808. pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
  8809. smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
  8810. [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
  8811. [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
  8812. @end example
  8813. It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
  8814. bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
  8815. the color changes.
  8816. Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
  8817. @example
  8818. ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
  8819. @end example
  8820. @section hflip
  8821. Flip the input video horizontally.
  8822. For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  8823. @example
  8824. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
  8825. @end example
  8826. @section histeq
  8827. This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
  8828. per-frame basis.
  8829. It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
  8830. intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
  8831. equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
  8832. viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
  8833. useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
  8834. video.
  8835. The filter accepts the following options:
  8836. @table @option
  8837. @item strength
  8838. Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
  8839. is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
  8840. approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
  8841. in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
  8842. @item intensity
  8843. Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
  8844. values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
  8845. the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
  8846. must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
  8847. @item antibanding
  8848. Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
  8849. the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
  8850. the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
  8851. @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
  8852. @end table
  8853. @section histogram
  8854. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
  8855. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  8856. distribution in an image.
  8857. Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
  8858. Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
  8859. the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
  8860. current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
  8861. The filter accepts the following options:
  8862. @table @option
  8863. @item level_height
  8864. Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
  8865. Allowed range is [50, 2048].
  8866. @item scale_height
  8867. Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
  8868. Allowed range is [0, 40].
  8869. @item display_mode
  8870. Set display mode.
  8871. It accepts the following values:
  8872. @table @samp
  8873. @item stack
  8874. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  8875. @item parade
  8876. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  8877. @item overlay
  8878. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  8879. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  8880. over one another.
  8881. @end table
  8882. Default is @code{stack}.
  8883. @item levels_mode
  8884. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  8885. Default is @code{linear}.
  8886. @item components
  8887. Set what color components to display.
  8888. Default is @code{7}.
  8889. @item fgopacity
  8890. Set foreground opacity. Default is @code{0.7}.
  8891. @item bgopacity
  8892. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.5}.
  8893. @end table
  8894. @subsection Examples
  8895. @itemize
  8896. @item
  8897. Calculate and draw histogram:
  8898. @example
  8899. ffplay -i input -vf histogram
  8900. @end example
  8901. @end itemize
  8902. @anchor{hqdn3d}
  8903. @section hqdn3d
  8904. This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
  8905. image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
  8906. still. It should enhance compressibility.
  8907. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  8908. @table @option
  8909. @item luma_spatial
  8910. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
  8911. It defaults to 4.0.
  8912. @item chroma_spatial
  8913. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
  8914. It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  8915. @item luma_tmp
  8916. A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
  8917. 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  8918. @item chroma_tmp
  8919. A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
  8920. @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
  8921. @end table
  8922. @anchor{hwdownload}
  8923. @section hwdownload
  8924. Download hardware frames to system memory.
  8925. The input must be in hardware frames, and the output a non-hardware format.
  8926. Not all formats will be supported on the output - it may be necessary to insert
  8927. an additional @option{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get
  8928. the output in a supported format.
  8929. @section hwmap
  8930. Map hardware frames to system memory or to another device.
  8931. This filter has several different modes of operation; which one is used depends
  8932. on the input and output formats:
  8933. @itemize
  8934. @item
  8935. Hardware frame input, normal frame output
  8936. Map the input frames to system memory and pass them to the output. If the
  8937. original hardware frame is later required (for example, after overlaying
  8938. something else on part of it), the @option{hwmap} filter can be used again
  8939. in the next mode to retrieve it.
  8940. @item
  8941. Normal frame input, hardware frame output
  8942. If the input is actually a software-mapped hardware frame, then unmap it -
  8943. that is, return the original hardware frame.
  8944. Otherwise, a device must be provided. Create new hardware surfaces on that
  8945. device for the output, then map them back to the software format at the input
  8946. and give those frames to the preceding filter. This will then act like the
  8947. @option{hwupload} filter, but may be able to avoid an additional copy when
  8948. the input is already in a compatible format.
  8949. @item
  8950. Hardware frame input and output
  8951. A device must be supplied for the output, either directly or with the
  8952. @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices must be of
  8953. different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  8954. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  8955. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  8956. If the input frames were originally created on the output device, then unmap
  8957. to retrieve the original frames.
  8958. Otherwise, map the frames to the output device - create new hardware frames
  8959. on the output corresponding to the frames on the input.
  8960. @end itemize
  8961. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  8962. @table @option
  8963. @item mode
  8964. Set the frame mapping mode. Some combination of:
  8965. @table @var
  8966. @item read
  8967. The mapped frame should be readable.
  8968. @item write
  8969. The mapped frame should be writeable.
  8970. @item overwrite
  8971. The mapping will always overwrite the entire frame.
  8972. This may improve performance in some cases, as the original contents of the
  8973. frame need not be loaded.
  8974. @item direct
  8975. The mapping must not involve any copying.
  8976. Indirect mappings to copies of frames are created in some cases where either
  8977. direct mapping is not possible or it would have unexpected properties.
  8978. Setting this flag ensures that the mapping is direct and will fail if that is
  8979. not possible.
  8980. @end table
  8981. Defaults to @var{read+write} if not specified.
  8982. @item derive_device @var{type}
  8983. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  8984. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  8985. @item reverse
  8986. In a hardware to hardware mapping, map in reverse - create frames in the sink
  8987. and map them back to the source. This may be necessary in some cases where
  8988. a mapping in one direction is required but only the opposite direction is
  8989. supported by the devices being used.
  8990. This option is dangerous - it may break the preceding filter in undefined
  8991. ways if there are any additional constraints on that filter's output.
  8992. Do not use it without fully understanding the implications of its use.
  8993. @end table
  8994. @anchor{hwupload}
  8995. @section hwupload
  8996. Upload system memory frames to hardware surfaces.
  8997. The device to upload to must be supplied when the filter is initialised. If
  8998. using ffmpeg, select the appropriate device with the @option{-filter_hw_device}
  8999. option.
  9000. @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
  9001. @section hwupload_cuda
  9002. Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
  9003. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9004. @table @option
  9005. @item device
  9006. The number of the CUDA device to use
  9007. @end table
  9008. @section hqx
  9009. Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
  9010. was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
  9011. It accepts the following option:
  9012. @table @option
  9013. @item n
  9014. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
  9015. @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
  9016. Default is @code{3}.
  9017. @end table
  9018. @section hstack
  9019. Stack input videos horizontally.
  9020. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
  9021. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  9022. to create same output.
  9023. The filter accepts the following option:
  9024. @table @option
  9025. @item inputs
  9026. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  9027. @item shortest
  9028. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  9029. terminates. Default value is 0.
  9030. @end table
  9031. @section hue
  9032. Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
  9033. It accepts the following parameters:
  9034. @table @option
  9035. @item h
  9036. Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
  9037. and defaults to "0".
  9038. @item s
  9039. Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9040. defaults to "1".
  9041. @item H
  9042. Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
  9043. expression, and defaults to "0".
  9044. @item b
  9045. Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9046. defaults to "0".
  9047. @end table
  9048. @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
  9049. specified at the same time.
  9050. The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
  9051. expressions containing the following constants:
  9052. @table @option
  9053. @item n
  9054. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  9055. @item pts
  9056. presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
  9057. @item r
  9058. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  9059. @item t
  9060. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  9061. @item tb
  9062. time base of the input video
  9063. @end table
  9064. @subsection Examples
  9065. @itemize
  9066. @item
  9067. Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
  9068. @example
  9069. hue=h=90:s=1
  9070. @end example
  9071. @item
  9072. Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
  9073. @example
  9074. hue=H=PI/2:s=1
  9075. @end example
  9076. @item
  9077. Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
  9078. and 2 over a period of 1 second:
  9079. @example
  9080. hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
  9081. @end example
  9082. @item
  9083. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
  9084. @example
  9085. hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
  9086. @end example
  9087. The general fade-in expression can be written as:
  9088. @example
  9089. hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
  9090. @end example
  9091. @item
  9092. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
  9093. @example
  9094. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
  9095. @end example
  9096. The general fade-out expression can be written as:
  9097. @example
  9098. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
  9099. @end example
  9100. @end itemize
  9101. @subsection Commands
  9102. This filter supports the following commands:
  9103. @table @option
  9104. @item b
  9105. @item s
  9106. @item h
  9107. @item H
  9108. Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
  9109. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9110. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9111. value.
  9112. @end table
  9113. @section hysteresis
  9114. Grow first stream into second stream by connecting components.
  9115. This makes it possible to build more robust edge masks.
  9116. This filter accepts the following options:
  9117. @table @option
  9118. @item planes
  9119. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9120. copied from first stream.
  9121. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9122. @item threshold
  9123. Set threshold which is used in filtering. If pixel component value is higher than
  9124. this value filter algorithm for connecting components is activated.
  9125. By default value is 0.
  9126. @end table
  9127. @section idet
  9128. Detect video interlacing type.
  9129. This filter tries to detect if the input frames are interlaced, progressive,
  9130. top or bottom field first. It will also try to detect fields that are
  9131. repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
  9132. Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
  9133. Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
  9134. The filter will log these metadata values:
  9135. @table @option
  9136. @item single.current_frame
  9137. Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
  9138. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9139. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9140. @item single.tff
  9141. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
  9142. @item multiple.tff
  9143. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9144. @item single.bff
  9145. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
  9146. @item multiple.current_frame
  9147. Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
  9148. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9149. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9150. @item multiple.bff
  9151. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9152. @item single.progressive
  9153. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
  9154. @item multiple.progressive
  9155. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
  9156. @item single.undetermined
  9157. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
  9158. @item multiple.undetermined
  9159. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
  9160. @item repeated.current_frame
  9161. Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
  9162. @item repeated.neither
  9163. Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
  9164. @item repeated.top
  9165. Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
  9166. @item repeated.bottom
  9167. Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
  9168. @end table
  9169. The filter accepts the following options:
  9170. @table @option
  9171. @item intl_thres
  9172. Set interlacing threshold.
  9173. @item prog_thres
  9174. Set progressive threshold.
  9175. @item rep_thres
  9176. Threshold for repeated field detection.
  9177. @item half_life
  9178. Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
  9179. statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to its
  9180. classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
  9181. full weight of 1.0 forever.
  9182. @item analyze_interlaced_flag
  9183. When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
  9184. if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
  9185. If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
  9186. computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
  9187. further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
  9188. method to clean up the interlaced flag
  9189. @end table
  9190. @section il
  9191. Deinterleave or interleave fields.
  9192. This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
  9193. deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
  9194. fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
  9195. half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
  9196. You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
  9197. The filter accepts the following options:
  9198. @table @option
  9199. @item luma_mode, l
  9200. @item chroma_mode, c
  9201. @item alpha_mode, a
  9202. Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
  9203. @var{alpha_mode} are:
  9204. @table @samp
  9205. @item none
  9206. Do nothing.
  9207. @item deinterleave, d
  9208. Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
  9209. @item interleave, i
  9210. Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
  9211. @end table
  9212. Default value is @code{none}.
  9213. @item luma_swap, ls
  9214. @item chroma_swap, cs
  9215. @item alpha_swap, as
  9216. Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
  9217. @end table
  9218. @section inflate
  9219. Apply inflate effect to the video.
  9220. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  9221. only values higher than the pixel.
  9222. It accepts the following options:
  9223. @table @option
  9224. @item threshold0
  9225. @item threshold1
  9226. @item threshold2
  9227. @item threshold3
  9228. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  9229. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  9230. @end table
  9231. @section interlace
  9232. Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
  9233. lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
  9234. halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
  9235. @example
  9236. Original Original New Frame
  9237. Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
  9238. ========== =========== ==================
  9239. Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
  9240. Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
  9241. Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
  9242. Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
  9243. ... ... ...
  9244. New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
  9245. @end example
  9246. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9247. @table @option
  9248. @item scan
  9249. This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
  9250. (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
  9251. @item lowpass
  9252. Vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter interlacing and
  9253. reduce moire patterns.
  9254. @table @samp
  9255. @item 0, off
  9256. Disable vertical lowpass filter
  9257. @item 1, linear
  9258. Enable linear filter (default)
  9259. @item 2, complex
  9260. Enable complex filter. This will slightly less reduce twitter and moire
  9261. but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  9262. @end table
  9263. @end table
  9264. @section kerndeint
  9265. Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
  9266. deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
  9267. progressive frames.
  9268. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  9269. @table @option
  9270. @item thresh
  9271. Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
  9272. determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
  9273. in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
  9274. applying the process on every pixels.
  9275. @item map
  9276. Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
  9277. Default is 0.
  9278. @item order
  9279. Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
  9280. 0. Default is 0.
  9281. @item sharp
  9282. Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9283. @item twoway
  9284. Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9285. @end table
  9286. @subsection Examples
  9287. @itemize
  9288. @item
  9289. Apply default values:
  9290. @example
  9291. kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
  9292. @end example
  9293. @item
  9294. Enable additional sharpening:
  9295. @example
  9296. kerndeint=sharp=1
  9297. @end example
  9298. @item
  9299. Paint processed pixels in white:
  9300. @example
  9301. kerndeint=map=1
  9302. @end example
  9303. @end itemize
  9304. @section lagfun
  9305. Slowly update darker pixels.
  9306. This filter makes short flashes of light appear longer.
  9307. This filter accepts the following options:
  9308. @table @option
  9309. @item decay
  9310. Set factor for decaying. Default is .95. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  9311. @item planes
  9312. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  9313. @end table
  9314. @section lenscorrection
  9315. Correct radial lens distortion
  9316. This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
  9317. of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
  9318. one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
  9319. To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
  9320. and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
  9321. Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
  9322. Digikam from the KDE project.
  9323. In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
  9324. this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
  9325. brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
  9326. cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
  9327. be applied before or after lens correction.
  9328. @subsection Options
  9329. The filter accepts the following options:
  9330. @table @option
  9331. @item cx
  9332. Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9333. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9334. width. Default is 0.5.
  9335. @item cy
  9336. Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9337. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9338. height. Default is 0.5.
  9339. @item k1
  9340. Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1]. 0 means
  9341. no correction. Default is 0.
  9342. @item k2
  9343. Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1].
  9344. 0 means no correction. Default is 0.
  9345. @end table
  9346. The formula that generates the correction is:
  9347. @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
  9348. where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
  9349. distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
  9350. @section lensfun
  9351. Apply lens correction via the lensfun library (@url{http://lensfun.sourceforge.net/}).
  9352. The @code{lensfun} filter requires the camera make, camera model, and lens model
  9353. to apply the lens correction. The filter will load the lensfun database and
  9354. query it to find the corresponding camera and lens entries in the database. As
  9355. long as these entries can be found with the given options, the filter can
  9356. perform corrections on frames. Note that incomplete strings will result in the
  9357. filter choosing the best match with the given options, and the filter will
  9358. output the chosen camera and lens models (logged with level "info"). You must
  9359. provide the make, camera model, and lens model as they are required.
  9360. The filter accepts the following options:
  9361. @table @option
  9362. @item make
  9363. The make of the camera (for example, "Canon"). This option is required.
  9364. @item model
  9365. The model of the camera (for example, "Canon EOS 100D"). This option is
  9366. required.
  9367. @item lens_model
  9368. The model of the lens (for example, "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM"). This
  9369. option is required.
  9370. @item mode
  9371. The type of correction to apply. The following values are valid options:
  9372. @table @samp
  9373. @item vignetting
  9374. Enables fixing lens vignetting.
  9375. @item geometry
  9376. Enables fixing lens geometry. This is the default.
  9377. @item subpixel
  9378. Enables fixing chromatic aberrations.
  9379. @item vig_geo
  9380. Enables fixing lens vignetting and lens geometry.
  9381. @item vig_subpixel
  9382. Enables fixing lens vignetting and chromatic aberrations.
  9383. @item distortion
  9384. Enables fixing both lens geometry and chromatic aberrations.
  9385. @item all
  9386. Enables all possible corrections.
  9387. @end table
  9388. @item focal_length
  9389. The focal length of the image/video (zoom; expected constant for video). For
  9390. example, a 18--55mm lens has focal length range of [18--55], so a value in that
  9391. range should be chosen when using that lens. Default 18.
  9392. @item aperture
  9393. The aperture of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9394. aperture is only used for vignetting correction. Default 3.5.
  9395. @item focus_distance
  9396. The focus distance of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9397. focus distance is only used for vignetting and only slightly affects the
  9398. vignetting correction process. If unknown, leave it at the default value (which
  9399. is 1000).
  9400. @item scale
  9401. The scale factor which is applied after transformation. After correction the
  9402. video is no longer necessarily rectangular. This parameter controls how much of
  9403. the resulting image is visible. The value 0 means that a value will be chosen
  9404. automatically such that there is little or no unmapped area in the output
  9405. image. 1.0 means that no additional scaling is done. Lower values may result
  9406. in more of the corrected image being visible, while higher values may avoid
  9407. unmapped areas in the output.
  9408. @item target_geometry
  9409. The target geometry of the output image/video. The following values are valid
  9410. options:
  9411. @table @samp
  9412. @item rectilinear (default)
  9413. @item fisheye
  9414. @item panoramic
  9415. @item equirectangular
  9416. @item fisheye_orthographic
  9417. @item fisheye_stereographic
  9418. @item fisheye_equisolid
  9419. @item fisheye_thoby
  9420. @end table
  9421. @item reverse
  9422. Apply the reverse of image correction (instead of correcting distortion, apply
  9423. it).
  9424. @item interpolation
  9425. The type of interpolation used when correcting distortion. The following values
  9426. are valid options:
  9427. @table @samp
  9428. @item nearest
  9429. @item linear (default)
  9430. @item lanczos
  9431. @end table
  9432. @end table
  9433. @subsection Examples
  9434. @itemize
  9435. @item
  9436. Apply lens correction with make "Canon", camera model "Canon EOS 100D", and lens
  9437. model "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM" with focal length of "18" and
  9438. aperture of "8.0".
  9439. @example
  9440. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8 -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9441. @end example
  9442. @item
  9443. Apply the same as before, but only for the first 5 seconds of video.
  9444. @example
  9445. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8:enable='lte(t\,5)' -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9446. @end example
  9447. @end itemize
  9448. @section libvmaf
  9449. Obtain the VMAF (Video Multi-Method Assessment Fusion)
  9450. score between two input videos.
  9451. The obtained VMAF score is printed through the logging system.
  9452. It requires Netflix's vmaf library (libvmaf) as a pre-requisite.
  9453. After installing the library it can be enabled using:
  9454. @code{./configure --enable-libvmaf --enable-version3}.
  9455. If no model path is specified it uses the default model: @code{vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl}.
  9456. The filter has following options:
  9457. @table @option
  9458. @item model_path
  9459. Set the model path which is to be used for SVM.
  9460. Default value: @code{"vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl"}
  9461. @item log_path
  9462. Set the file path to be used to store logs.
  9463. @item log_fmt
  9464. Set the format of the log file (xml or json).
  9465. @item enable_transform
  9466. This option can enable/disable the @code{score_transform} applied to the final predicted VMAF score,
  9467. if you have specified score_transform option in the input parameter file passed to @code{run_vmaf_training.py}
  9468. Default value: @code{false}
  9469. @item phone_model
  9470. Invokes the phone model which will generate VMAF scores higher than in the
  9471. regular model, which is more suitable for laptop, TV, etc. viewing conditions.
  9472. @item psnr
  9473. Enables computing psnr along with vmaf.
  9474. @item ssim
  9475. Enables computing ssim along with vmaf.
  9476. @item ms_ssim
  9477. Enables computing ms_ssim along with vmaf.
  9478. @item pool
  9479. Set the pool method (mean, min or harmonic mean) to be used for computing vmaf.
  9480. @item n_threads
  9481. Set number of threads to be used when computing vmaf.
  9482. @item n_subsample
  9483. Set interval for frame subsampling used when computing vmaf.
  9484. @item enable_conf_interval
  9485. Enables confidence interval.
  9486. @end table
  9487. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9488. @subsection Examples
  9489. @itemize
  9490. @item
  9491. On the below examples the input file @file{main.mpg} being processed is
  9492. compared with the reference file @file{ref.mpg}.
  9493. @example
  9494. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf -f null -
  9495. @end example
  9496. @item
  9497. Example with options:
  9498. @example
  9499. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf="psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9500. @end example
  9501. @item
  9502. Example with options and different containers:
  9503. @example
  9504. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=1/AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=1/AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]libvmaf=psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9505. @end example
  9506. @end itemize
  9507. @section limiter
  9508. Limits the pixel components values to the specified range [min, max].
  9509. The filter accepts the following options:
  9510. @table @option
  9511. @item min
  9512. Lower bound. Defaults to the lowest allowed value for the input.
  9513. @item max
  9514. Upper bound. Defaults to the highest allowed value for the input.
  9515. @item planes
  9516. Specify which planes will be processed. Defaults to all available.
  9517. @end table
  9518. @section loop
  9519. Loop video frames.
  9520. The filter accepts the following options:
  9521. @table @option
  9522. @item loop
  9523. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  9524. Default is 0.
  9525. @item size
  9526. Set maximal size in number of frames. Default is 0.
  9527. @item start
  9528. Set first frame of loop. Default is 0.
  9529. @end table
  9530. @subsection Examples
  9531. @itemize
  9532. @item
  9533. Loop single first frame infinitely:
  9534. @example
  9535. loop=loop=-1:size=1:start=0
  9536. @end example
  9537. @item
  9538. Loop single first frame 10 times:
  9539. @example
  9540. loop=loop=10:size=1:start=0
  9541. @end example
  9542. @item
  9543. Loop 10 first frames 5 times:
  9544. @example
  9545. loop=loop=5:size=10:start=0
  9546. @end example
  9547. @end itemize
  9548. @section lut1d
  9549. Apply a 1D LUT to an input video.
  9550. The filter accepts the following options:
  9551. @table @option
  9552. @item file
  9553. Set the 1D LUT file name.
  9554. Currently supported formats:
  9555. @table @samp
  9556. @item cube
  9557. Iridas
  9558. @item csp
  9559. cineSpace
  9560. @end table
  9561. @item interp
  9562. Select interpolation mode.
  9563. Available values are:
  9564. @table @samp
  9565. @item nearest
  9566. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9567. @item linear
  9568. Interpolate values using the linear interpolation.
  9569. @item cosine
  9570. Interpolate values using the cosine interpolation.
  9571. @item cubic
  9572. Interpolate values using the cubic interpolation.
  9573. @item spline
  9574. Interpolate values using the spline interpolation.
  9575. @end table
  9576. @end table
  9577. @anchor{lut3d}
  9578. @section lut3d
  9579. Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
  9580. The filter accepts the following options:
  9581. @table @option
  9582. @item file
  9583. Set the 3D LUT file name.
  9584. Currently supported formats:
  9585. @table @samp
  9586. @item 3dl
  9587. AfterEffects
  9588. @item cube
  9589. Iridas
  9590. @item dat
  9591. DaVinci
  9592. @item m3d
  9593. Pandora
  9594. @item csp
  9595. cineSpace
  9596. @end table
  9597. @item interp
  9598. Select interpolation mode.
  9599. Available values are:
  9600. @table @samp
  9601. @item nearest
  9602. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9603. @item trilinear
  9604. Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
  9605. @item tetrahedral
  9606. Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
  9607. @end table
  9608. @end table
  9609. @section lumakey
  9610. Turn certain luma values into transparency.
  9611. The filter accepts the following options:
  9612. @table @option
  9613. @item threshold
  9614. Set the luma which will be used as base for transparency.
  9615. Default value is @code{0}.
  9616. @item tolerance
  9617. Set the range of luma values to be keyed out.
  9618. Default value is @code{0}.
  9619. @item softness
  9620. Set the range of softness. Default value is @code{0}.
  9621. Use this to control gradual transition from zero to full transparency.
  9622. @end table
  9623. @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
  9624. Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
  9625. to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
  9626. @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
  9627. to an RGB input video.
  9628. These filters accept the following parameters:
  9629. @table @option
  9630. @item c0
  9631. set first pixel component expression
  9632. @item c1
  9633. set second pixel component expression
  9634. @item c2
  9635. set third pixel component expression
  9636. @item c3
  9637. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9638. @item r
  9639. set red component expression
  9640. @item g
  9641. set green component expression
  9642. @item b
  9643. set blue component expression
  9644. @item a
  9645. alpha component expression
  9646. @item y
  9647. set Y/luminance component expression
  9648. @item u
  9649. set U/Cb component expression
  9650. @item v
  9651. set V/Cr component expression
  9652. @end table
  9653. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9654. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9655. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9656. format in input.
  9657. The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
  9658. @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
  9659. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  9660. @table @option
  9661. @item w
  9662. @item h
  9663. The input width and height.
  9664. @item val
  9665. The input value for the pixel component.
  9666. @item clipval
  9667. The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9668. @item maxval
  9669. The maximum value for the pixel component.
  9670. @item minval
  9671. The minimum value for the pixel component.
  9672. @item negval
  9673. The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
  9674. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
  9675. "maxval-clipval+minval".
  9676. @item clip(val)
  9677. The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
  9678. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9679. @item gammaval(gamma)
  9680. The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
  9681. clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
  9682. expression
  9683. "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
  9684. @end table
  9685. All expressions default to "val".
  9686. @subsection Examples
  9687. @itemize
  9688. @item
  9689. Negate input video:
  9690. @example
  9691. lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
  9692. lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
  9693. @end example
  9694. The above is the same as:
  9695. @example
  9696. lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
  9697. lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
  9698. @end example
  9699. @item
  9700. Negate luminance:
  9701. @example
  9702. lutyuv=y=negval
  9703. @end example
  9704. @item
  9705. Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
  9706. @example
  9707. lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
  9708. @end example
  9709. @item
  9710. Apply a luma burning effect:
  9711. @example
  9712. lutyuv="y=2*val"
  9713. @end example
  9714. @item
  9715. Remove green and blue components:
  9716. @example
  9717. lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
  9718. @end example
  9719. @item
  9720. Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
  9721. @example
  9722. format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
  9723. @end example
  9724. @item
  9725. Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
  9726. @example
  9727. lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
  9728. @end example
  9729. @item
  9730. Discard least significant bits of luma:
  9731. @example
  9732. lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
  9733. @end example
  9734. @item
  9735. Technicolor like effect:
  9736. @example
  9737. lutyuv=u='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2':v='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2'
  9738. @end example
  9739. @end itemize
  9740. @section lut2, tlut2
  9741. The @code{lut2} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  9742. stream.
  9743. The @code{tlut2} (time lut2) filter takes two consecutive frames
  9744. from one single stream.
  9745. This filter accepts the following parameters:
  9746. @table @option
  9747. @item c0
  9748. set first pixel component expression
  9749. @item c1
  9750. set second pixel component expression
  9751. @item c2
  9752. set third pixel component expression
  9753. @item c3
  9754. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9755. @item d
  9756. set output bit depth, only available for @code{lut2} filter. By default is 0,
  9757. which means bit depth is automatically picked from first input format.
  9758. @end table
  9759. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9760. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9761. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9762. format in inputs.
  9763. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  9764. @table @option
  9765. @item w
  9766. @item h
  9767. The input width and height.
  9768. @item x
  9769. The first input value for the pixel component.
  9770. @item y
  9771. The second input value for the pixel component.
  9772. @item bdx
  9773. The first input video bit depth.
  9774. @item bdy
  9775. The second input video bit depth.
  9776. @end table
  9777. All expressions default to "x".
  9778. @subsection Examples
  9779. @itemize
  9780. @item
  9781. Highlight differences between two RGB video streams:
  9782. @example
  9783. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  9784. @end example
  9785. @item
  9786. Highlight differences between two YUV video streams:
  9787. @example
  9788. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  9789. @end example
  9790. @item
  9791. Show max difference between two video streams:
  9792. @example
  9793. lut2='if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1)))'
  9794. @end example
  9795. @end itemize
  9796. @section maskedclamp
  9797. Clamp the first input stream with the second input and third input stream.
  9798. Returns the value of first stream to be between second input
  9799. stream - @code{undershoot} and third input stream + @code{overshoot}.
  9800. This filter accepts the following options:
  9801. @table @option
  9802. @item undershoot
  9803. Default value is @code{0}.
  9804. @item overshoot
  9805. Default value is @code{0}.
  9806. @item planes
  9807. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9808. copied from first stream.
  9809. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9810. @end table
  9811. @section maskedmax
  9812. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  9813. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  9814. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  9815. stream if second absolute difference is greater than first one or from third input stream
  9816. otherwise.
  9817. This filter accepts the following options:
  9818. @table @option
  9819. @item planes
  9820. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9821. copied from first stream.
  9822. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9823. @end table
  9824. @section maskedmerge
  9825. Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
  9826. weights in the third input stream.
  9827. A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
  9828. from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
  9829. 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
  9830. unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
  9831. input stream's pixel components.
  9832. This filter accepts the following options:
  9833. @table @option
  9834. @item planes
  9835. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9836. copied from first stream.
  9837. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9838. @end table
  9839. @section maskedmin
  9840. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  9841. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  9842. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  9843. stream if second absolute difference is less than first one or from third input stream
  9844. otherwise.
  9845. This filter accepts the following options:
  9846. @table @option
  9847. @item planes
  9848. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9849. copied from first stream.
  9850. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9851. @end table
  9852. @section maskfun
  9853. Create mask from input video.
  9854. For example it is useful to create motion masks after @code{tblend} filter.
  9855. This filter accepts the following options:
  9856. @table @option
  9857. @item low
  9858. Set low threshold. Any pixel component lower or exact than this value will be set to 0.
  9859. @item high
  9860. Set high threshold. Any pixel component higher than this value will be set to max value
  9861. allowed for current pixel format.
  9862. @item planes
  9863. Set planes to filter, by default all available planes are filtered.
  9864. @item fill
  9865. Fill all frame pixels with this value.
  9866. @item sum
  9867. Set max average pixel value for frame. If sum of all pixel components is higher that this
  9868. average, output frame will be completely filled with value set by @var{fill} option.
  9869. Typically useful for scene changes when used in combination with @code{tblend} filter.
  9870. @end table
  9871. @section mcdeint
  9872. Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
  9873. It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
  9874. with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
  9875. This filter accepts the following options:
  9876. @table @option
  9877. @item mode
  9878. Set the deinterlacing mode.
  9879. It accepts one of the following values:
  9880. @table @samp
  9881. @item fast
  9882. @item medium
  9883. @item slow
  9884. use iterative motion estimation
  9885. @item extra_slow
  9886. like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
  9887. @end table
  9888. Default value is @samp{fast}.
  9889. @item parity
  9890. Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
  9891. one of the following values:
  9892. @table @samp
  9893. @item 0, tff
  9894. assume top field first
  9895. @item 1, bff
  9896. assume bottom field first
  9897. @end table
  9898. Default value is @samp{bff}.
  9899. @item qp
  9900. Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
  9901. encoder.
  9902. Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
  9903. optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
  9904. @end table
  9905. @section median
  9906. Pick median pixel from certain rectangle defined by radius.
  9907. This filter accepts the following options:
  9908. @table @option
  9909. @item radius
  9910. Set horizontal radius size. Default value is @code{1}.
  9911. Allowed range is integer from 1 to 127.
  9912. @item planes
  9913. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  9914. @item radiusV
  9915. Set vertical radius size. Default value is @code{0}.
  9916. Allowed range is integer from 0 to 127.
  9917. If it is 0, value will be picked from horizontal @code{radius} option.
  9918. @end table
  9919. @section mergeplanes
  9920. Merge color channel components from several video streams.
  9921. The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
  9922. planes to the output video.
  9923. This filter accepts the following options:
  9924. @table @option
  9925. @item mapping
  9926. Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
  9927. The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
  9928. hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
  9929. mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
  9930. the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
  9931. corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
  9932. similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
  9933. plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
  9934. 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
  9935. @item format
  9936. Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
  9937. @end table
  9938. @subsection Examples
  9939. @itemize
  9940. @item
  9941. Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
  9942. @example
  9943. [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
  9944. @end example
  9945. @item
  9946. Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
  9947. @example
  9948. [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
  9949. @end example
  9950. @item
  9951. Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
  9952. @example
  9953. format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
  9954. @end example
  9955. @item
  9956. Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
  9957. @example
  9958. format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
  9959. @end example
  9960. @item
  9961. Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
  9962. @example
  9963. format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
  9964. @end example
  9965. @end itemize
  9966. @section mestimate
  9967. Estimate and export motion vectors using block matching algorithms.
  9968. Motion vectors are stored in frame side data to be used by other filters.
  9969. This filter accepts the following options:
  9970. @table @option
  9971. @item method
  9972. Specify the motion estimation method. Accepts one of the following values:
  9973. @table @samp
  9974. @item esa
  9975. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  9976. @item tss
  9977. Three step search algorithm.
  9978. @item tdls
  9979. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  9980. @item ntss
  9981. New three step search algorithm.
  9982. @item fss
  9983. Four step search algorithm.
  9984. @item ds
  9985. Diamond search algorithm.
  9986. @item hexbs
  9987. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  9988. @item epzs
  9989. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  9990. @item umh
  9991. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  9992. @end table
  9993. Default value is @samp{esa}.
  9994. @item mb_size
  9995. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  9996. @item search_param
  9997. Search parameter. Default @code{7}.
  9998. @end table
  9999. @section midequalizer
  10000. Apply Midway Image Equalization effect using two video streams.
  10001. Midway Image Equalization adjusts a pair of images to have the same
  10002. histogram, while maintaining their dynamics as much as possible. It's
  10003. useful for e.g. matching exposures from a pair of stereo cameras.
  10004. This filter has two inputs and one output, which must be of same pixel format, but
  10005. may be of different sizes. The output of filter is first input adjusted with
  10006. midway histogram of both inputs.
  10007. This filter accepts the following option:
  10008. @table @option
  10009. @item planes
  10010. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10011. @end table
  10012. @section minterpolate
  10013. Convert the video to specified frame rate using motion interpolation.
  10014. This filter accepts the following options:
  10015. @table @option
  10016. @item fps
  10017. Specify the output frame rate. This can be rational e.g. @code{60000/1001}. Frames are dropped if @var{fps} is lower than source fps. Default @code{60}.
  10018. @item mi_mode
  10019. Motion interpolation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10020. @table @samp
  10021. @item dup
  10022. Duplicate previous or next frame for interpolating new ones.
  10023. @item blend
  10024. Blend source frames. Interpolated frame is mean of previous and next frames.
  10025. @item mci
  10026. Motion compensated interpolation. Following options are effective when this mode is selected:
  10027. @table @samp
  10028. @item mc_mode
  10029. Motion compensation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10030. @table @samp
  10031. @item obmc
  10032. Overlapped block motion compensation.
  10033. @item aobmc
  10034. Adaptive overlapped block motion compensation. Window weighting coefficients are controlled adaptively according to the reliabilities of the neighboring motion vectors to reduce oversmoothing.
  10035. @end table
  10036. Default mode is @samp{obmc}.
  10037. @item me_mode
  10038. Motion estimation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10039. @table @samp
  10040. @item bidir
  10041. Bidirectional motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated for each source frame in both forward and backward directions.
  10042. @item bilat
  10043. Bilateral motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated directly for interpolated frame.
  10044. @end table
  10045. Default mode is @samp{bilat}.
  10046. @item me
  10047. The algorithm to be used for motion estimation. Following values are accepted:
  10048. @table @samp
  10049. @item esa
  10050. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10051. @item tss
  10052. Three step search algorithm.
  10053. @item tdls
  10054. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10055. @item ntss
  10056. New three step search algorithm.
  10057. @item fss
  10058. Four step search algorithm.
  10059. @item ds
  10060. Diamond search algorithm.
  10061. @item hexbs
  10062. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10063. @item epzs
  10064. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10065. @item umh
  10066. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10067. @end table
  10068. Default algorithm is @samp{epzs}.
  10069. @item mb_size
  10070. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10071. @item search_param
  10072. Motion estimation search parameter. Default @code{32}.
  10073. @item vsbmc
  10074. Enable variable-size block motion compensation. Motion estimation is applied with smaller block sizes at object boundaries in order to make the them less blur. Default is @code{0} (disabled).
  10075. @end table
  10076. @end table
  10077. @item scd
  10078. Scene change detection method. Scene change leads motion vectors to be in random direction. Scene change detection replace interpolated frames by duplicate ones. May not be needed for other modes. Following values are accepted:
  10079. @table @samp
  10080. @item none
  10081. Disable scene change detection.
  10082. @item fdiff
  10083. Frame difference. Corresponding pixel values are compared and if it satisfies @var{scd_threshold} scene change is detected.
  10084. @end table
  10085. Default method is @samp{fdiff}.
  10086. @item scd_threshold
  10087. Scene change detection threshold. Default is @code{5.0}.
  10088. @end table
  10089. @section mix
  10090. Mix several video input streams into one video stream.
  10091. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10092. @table @option
  10093. @item nb_inputs
  10094. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  10095. @item weights
  10096. Specify weight of each input video stream as sequence.
  10097. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights
  10098. is smaller than number of @var{frames} last specified
  10099. weight will be used for all remaining unset weights.
  10100. @item scale
  10101. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  10102. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  10103. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  10104. @item duration
  10105. Specify how end of stream is determined.
  10106. @table @samp
  10107. @item longest
  10108. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  10109. @item shortest
  10110. The duration of the shortest input.
  10111. @item first
  10112. The duration of the first input.
  10113. @end table
  10114. @end table
  10115. @section mpdecimate
  10116. Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
  10117. order to reduce frame rate.
  10118. The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
  10119. (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
  10120. fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
  10121. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10122. @table @option
  10123. @item max
  10124. Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
  10125. positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
  10126. negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped disregarding the
  10127. number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
  10128. Default value is 0.
  10129. @item hi
  10130. @item lo
  10131. @item frac
  10132. Set the dropping threshold values.
  10133. Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
  10134. represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
  10135. corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
  10136. out differently over the block.
  10137. A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
  10138. than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
  10139. meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
  10140. Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
  10141. 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
  10142. @end table
  10143. @section negate
  10144. Negate (invert) the input video.
  10145. It accepts the following option:
  10146. @table @option
  10147. @item negate_alpha
  10148. With value 1, it negates the alpha component, if present. Default value is 0.
  10149. @end table
  10150. @anchor{nlmeans}
  10151. @section nlmeans
  10152. Denoise frames using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  10153. Each pixel is adjusted by looking for other pixels with similar contexts. This
  10154. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  10155. @option{p}x@option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r}x@option{r}
  10156. around the pixel.
  10157. Note that the research area defines centers for patches, which means some
  10158. patches will be made of pixels outside that research area.
  10159. The filter accepts the following options.
  10160. @table @option
  10161. @item s
  10162. Set denoising strength. Default is 1.0. Must be in range [1.0, 30.0].
  10163. @item p
  10164. Set patch size. Default is 7. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10165. @item pc
  10166. Same as @option{p} but for chroma planes.
  10167. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10168. @item r
  10169. Set research size. Default is 15. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10170. @item rc
  10171. Same as @option{r} but for chroma planes.
  10172. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10173. @end table
  10174. @section nnedi
  10175. Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
  10176. This filter accepts the following options:
  10177. @table @option
  10178. @item weights
  10179. Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
  10180. Currently file can be found here:
  10181. https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
  10182. @item deint
  10183. Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
  10184. Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
  10185. @item field
  10186. Set mode of operation.
  10187. Can be one of the following:
  10188. @table @samp
  10189. @item af
  10190. Use frame flags, both fields.
  10191. @item a
  10192. Use frame flags, single field.
  10193. @item t
  10194. Use top field only.
  10195. @item b
  10196. Use bottom field only.
  10197. @item tf
  10198. Use both fields, top first.
  10199. @item bf
  10200. Use both fields, bottom first.
  10201. @end table
  10202. @item planes
  10203. Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
  10204. @item nsize
  10205. Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
  10206. network.
  10207. Can be one of the following:
  10208. @table @samp
  10209. @item s8x6
  10210. @item s16x6
  10211. @item s32x6
  10212. @item s48x6
  10213. @item s8x4
  10214. @item s16x4
  10215. @item s32x4
  10216. @end table
  10217. @item nns
  10218. Set the number of neurons in predictor neural network.
  10219. Can be one of the following:
  10220. @table @samp
  10221. @item n16
  10222. @item n32
  10223. @item n64
  10224. @item n128
  10225. @item n256
  10226. @end table
  10227. @item qual
  10228. Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
  10229. together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
  10230. @code{slow}.
  10231. @item etype
  10232. Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
  10233. Can be one of the following:
  10234. @table @samp
  10235. @item a
  10236. weights trained to minimize absolute error
  10237. @item s
  10238. weights trained to minimize squared error
  10239. @end table
  10240. @item pscrn
  10241. Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
  10242. which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
  10243. can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
  10244. The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
  10245. sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
  10246. The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
  10247. the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
  10248. using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
  10249. The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
  10250. using it is almost always unnoticeable.
  10251. Can be one of the following:
  10252. @table @samp
  10253. @item none
  10254. @item original
  10255. @item new
  10256. @end table
  10257. Default is @code{new}.
  10258. @item fapprox
  10259. Set various debugging flags.
  10260. @end table
  10261. @section noformat
  10262. Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
  10263. input to the next filter.
  10264. It accepts the following parameters:
  10265. @table @option
  10266. @item pix_fmts
  10267. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  10268. pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  10269. @end table
  10270. @subsection Examples
  10271. @itemize
  10272. @item
  10273. Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
  10274. input to the vflip filter:
  10275. @example
  10276. noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
  10277. @end example
  10278. @item
  10279. Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
  10280. @example
  10281. noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  10282. @end example
  10283. @end itemize
  10284. @section noise
  10285. Add noise on video input frame.
  10286. The filter accepts the following options:
  10287. @table @option
  10288. @item all_seed
  10289. @item c0_seed
  10290. @item c1_seed
  10291. @item c2_seed
  10292. @item c3_seed
  10293. Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10294. of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
  10295. @item all_strength, alls
  10296. @item c0_strength, c0s
  10297. @item c1_strength, c1s
  10298. @item c2_strength, c2s
  10299. @item c3_strength, c3s
  10300. Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10301. @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
  10302. @item all_flags, allf
  10303. @item c0_flags, c0f
  10304. @item c1_flags, c1f
  10305. @item c2_flags, c2f
  10306. @item c3_flags, c3f
  10307. Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
  10308. Available values for component flags are:
  10309. @table @samp
  10310. @item a
  10311. averaged temporal noise (smoother)
  10312. @item p
  10313. mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
  10314. @item t
  10315. temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
  10316. @item u
  10317. uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
  10318. @end table
  10319. @end table
  10320. @subsection Examples
  10321. Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
  10322. @example
  10323. noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
  10324. @end example
  10325. @section normalize
  10326. Normalize RGB video (aka histogram stretching, contrast stretching).
  10327. See: https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Normalization_(image_processing)
  10328. For each channel of each frame, the filter computes the input range and maps
  10329. it linearly to the user-specified output range. The output range defaults
  10330. to the full dynamic range from pure black to pure white.
  10331. Temporal smoothing can be used on the input range to reduce flickering (rapid
  10332. changes in brightness) caused when small dark or bright objects enter or leave
  10333. the scene. This is similar to the auto-exposure (automatic gain control) on a
  10334. video camera, and, like a video camera, it may cause a period of over- or
  10335. under-exposure of the video.
  10336. The R,G,B channels can be normalized independently, which may cause some
  10337. color shifting, or linked together as a single channel, which prevents
  10338. color shifting. Linked normalization preserves hue. Independent normalization
  10339. does not, so it can be used to remove some color casts. Independent and linked
  10340. normalization can be combined in any ratio.
  10341. The normalize filter accepts the following options:
  10342. @table @option
  10343. @item blackpt
  10344. @item whitept
  10345. Colors which define the output range. The minimum input value is mapped to
  10346. the @var{blackpt}. The maximum input value is mapped to the @var{whitept}.
  10347. The defaults are black and white respectively. Specifying white for
  10348. @var{blackpt} and black for @var{whitept} will give color-inverted,
  10349. normalized video. Shades of grey can be used to reduce the dynamic range
  10350. (contrast). Specifying saturated colors here can create some interesting
  10351. effects.
  10352. @item smoothing
  10353. The number of previous frames to use for temporal smoothing. The input range
  10354. of each channel is smoothed using a rolling average over the current frame
  10355. and the @var{smoothing} previous frames. The default is 0 (no temporal
  10356. smoothing).
  10357. @item independence
  10358. Controls the ratio of independent (color shifting) channel normalization to
  10359. linked (color preserving) normalization. 0.0 is fully linked, 1.0 is fully
  10360. independent. Defaults to 1.0 (fully independent).
  10361. @item strength
  10362. Overall strength of the filter. 1.0 is full strength. 0.0 is a rather
  10363. expensive no-op. Defaults to 1.0 (full strength).
  10364. @end table
  10365. @subsection Examples
  10366. Stretch video contrast to use the full dynamic range, with no temporal
  10367. smoothing; may flicker depending on the source content:
  10368. @example
  10369. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=0
  10370. @end example
  10371. As above, but with 50 frames of temporal smoothing; flicker should be
  10372. reduced, depending on the source content:
  10373. @example
  10374. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50
  10375. @end example
  10376. As above, but with hue-preserving linked channel normalization:
  10377. @example
  10378. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0
  10379. @end example
  10380. As above, but with half strength:
  10381. @example
  10382. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0:strength=0.5
  10383. @end example
  10384. Map the darkest input color to red, the brightest input color to cyan:
  10385. @example
  10386. normalize=blackpt=red:whitept=cyan
  10387. @end example
  10388. @section null
  10389. Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
  10390. @section ocr
  10391. Optical Character Recognition
  10392. This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition. To enable
  10393. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10394. @code{--enable-libtesseract}.
  10395. It accepts the following options:
  10396. @table @option
  10397. @item datapath
  10398. Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
  10399. set at installation.
  10400. @item language
  10401. Set language, default is "eng".
  10402. @item whitelist
  10403. Set character whitelist.
  10404. @item blacklist
  10405. Set character blacklist.
  10406. @end table
  10407. The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
  10408. The filter exports confidence of recognized words as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.confidence}.
  10409. @section ocv
  10410. Apply a video transform using libopencv.
  10411. To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
  10412. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
  10413. It accepts the following parameters:
  10414. @table @option
  10415. @item filter_name
  10416. The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
  10417. @item filter_params
  10418. The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
  10419. values are assumed.
  10420. @end table
  10421. Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
  10422. information:
  10423. @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
  10424. Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
  10425. @anchor{dilate}
  10426. @subsection dilate
  10427. Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10428. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
  10429. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
  10430. @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
  10431. @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
  10432. @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
  10433. the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
  10434. point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
  10435. must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
  10436. If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
  10437. string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
  10438. @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
  10439. printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
  10440. @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
  10441. or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
  10442. The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
  10443. @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
  10444. applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
  10445. Some examples:
  10446. @example
  10447. # Use the default values
  10448. ocv=dilate
  10449. # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
  10450. ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
  10451. # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
  10452. # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
  10453. # *
  10454. # ***
  10455. # *****
  10456. # ***
  10457. # *
  10458. # The specified columns and rows are ignored
  10459. # but the anchor point coordinates are not
  10460. ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
  10461. @end example
  10462. @subsection erode
  10463. Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10464. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
  10465. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
  10466. with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
  10467. @subsection smooth
  10468. Smooth the input video.
  10469. The filter takes the following parameters:
  10470. @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
  10471. @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
  10472. the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
  10473. or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
  10474. The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
  10475. depends on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
  10476. @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
  10477. @var{param4} accept floating point values.
  10478. The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
  10479. other parameters is 0.
  10480. These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
  10481. libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
  10482. @section oscilloscope
  10483. 2D Video Oscilloscope.
  10484. Useful to measure spatial impulse, step responses, chroma delays, etc.
  10485. It accepts the following parameters:
  10486. @table @option
  10487. @item x
  10488. Set scope center x position.
  10489. @item y
  10490. Set scope center y position.
  10491. @item s
  10492. Set scope size, relative to frame diagonal.
  10493. @item t
  10494. Set scope tilt/rotation.
  10495. @item o
  10496. Set trace opacity.
  10497. @item tx
  10498. Set trace center x position.
  10499. @item ty
  10500. Set trace center y position.
  10501. @item tw
  10502. Set trace width, relative to width of frame.
  10503. @item th
  10504. Set trace height, relative to height of frame.
  10505. @item c
  10506. Set which components to trace. By default it traces first three components.
  10507. @item g
  10508. Draw trace grid. By default is enabled.
  10509. @item st
  10510. Draw some statistics. By default is enabled.
  10511. @item sc
  10512. Draw scope. By default is enabled.
  10513. @end table
  10514. @subsection Examples
  10515. @itemize
  10516. @item
  10517. Inspect full first row of video frame.
  10518. @example
  10519. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=0:s=1
  10520. @end example
  10521. @item
  10522. Inspect full last row of video frame.
  10523. @example
  10524. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=1:s=1
  10525. @end example
  10526. @item
  10527. Inspect full 5th line of video frame of height 1080.
  10528. @example
  10529. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=5/1080:s=1
  10530. @end example
  10531. @item
  10532. Inspect full last column of video frame.
  10533. @example
  10534. oscilloscope=x=1:y=0.5:s=1:t=1
  10535. @end example
  10536. @end itemize
  10537. @anchor{overlay}
  10538. @section overlay
  10539. Overlay one video on top of another.
  10540. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  10541. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  10542. It accepts the following parameters:
  10543. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10544. @table @option
  10545. @item x
  10546. @item y
  10547. Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
  10548. on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
  10549. the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
  10550. overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
  10551. @item eof_action
  10552. See @ref{framesync}.
  10553. @item eval
  10554. Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
  10555. It accepts the following values:
  10556. @table @samp
  10557. @item init
  10558. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  10559. when a command is processed
  10560. @item frame
  10561. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  10562. @end table
  10563. Default value is @samp{frame}.
  10564. @item shortest
  10565. See @ref{framesync}.
  10566. @item format
  10567. Set the format for the output video.
  10568. It accepts the following values:
  10569. @table @samp
  10570. @item yuv420
  10571. force YUV420 output
  10572. @item yuv422
  10573. force YUV422 output
  10574. @item yuv444
  10575. force YUV444 output
  10576. @item rgb
  10577. force packed RGB output
  10578. @item gbrp
  10579. force planar RGB output
  10580. @item auto
  10581. automatically pick format
  10582. @end table
  10583. Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
  10584. @item repeatlast
  10585. See @ref{framesync}.
  10586. @item alpha
  10587. Set format of alpha of the overlaid video, it can be @var{straight} or
  10588. @var{premultiplied}. Default is @var{straight}.
  10589. @end table
  10590. The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
  10591. parameters.
  10592. @table @option
  10593. @item main_w, W
  10594. @item main_h, H
  10595. The main input width and height.
  10596. @item overlay_w, w
  10597. @item overlay_h, h
  10598. The overlay input width and height.
  10599. @item x
  10600. @item y
  10601. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  10602. each new frame.
  10603. @item hsub
  10604. @item vsub
  10605. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
  10606. format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
  10607. @var{vsub} is 1.
  10608. @item n
  10609. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  10610. @item pos
  10611. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  10612. @item t
  10613. The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  10614. @end table
  10615. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10616. Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
  10617. when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
  10618. when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
  10619. Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
  10620. order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
  10621. to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
  10622. have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
  10623. the @var{movie} filter does.
  10624. You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
  10625. efficiency of such approach.
  10626. @subsection Commands
  10627. This filter supports the following commands:
  10628. @table @option
  10629. @item x
  10630. @item y
  10631. Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
  10632. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10633. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10634. value.
  10635. @end table
  10636. @subsection Examples
  10637. @itemize
  10638. @item
  10639. Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
  10640. video:
  10641. @example
  10642. overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
  10643. @end example
  10644. Using named options the example above becomes:
  10645. @example
  10646. overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
  10647. @end example
  10648. @item
  10649. Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
  10650. using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
  10651. @example
  10652. ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
  10653. @end example
  10654. @item
  10655. Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
  10656. right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
  10657. @example
  10658. ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
  10659. @end example
  10660. @item
  10661. Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
  10662. must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
  10663. @example
  10664. color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
  10665. @end example
  10666. @item
  10667. Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
  10668. filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
  10669. @example
  10670. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
  10671. @end example
  10672. The above command is the same as:
  10673. @example
  10674. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
  10675. @end example
  10676. @item
  10677. Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
  10678. screen starting since time 2:
  10679. @example
  10680. overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
  10681. @end example
  10682. @item
  10683. Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
  10684. @example
  10685. ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
  10686. nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
  10687. [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
  10688. [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
  10689. [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
  10690. [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
  10691. "
  10692. @end example
  10693. @item
  10694. Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
  10695. @example
  10696. ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
  10697. -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
  10698. masked.avi
  10699. @end example
  10700. @item
  10701. Chain several overlays in cascade:
  10702. @example
  10703. nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
  10704. testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
  10705. [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
  10706. [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
  10707. [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
  10708. [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
  10709. @end example
  10710. @end itemize
  10711. @section owdenoise
  10712. Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
  10713. The filter accepts the following options:
  10714. @table @option
  10715. @item depth
  10716. Set depth.
  10717. Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
  10718. slow down filtering.
  10719. Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
  10720. @item luma_strength, ls
  10721. Set luma strength.
  10722. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  10723. @item chroma_strength, cs
  10724. Set chroma strength.
  10725. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  10726. @end table
  10727. @anchor{pad}
  10728. @section pad
  10729. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  10730. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  10731. It accepts the following parameters:
  10732. @table @option
  10733. @item width, w
  10734. @item height, h
  10735. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  10736. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  10737. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  10738. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  10739. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  10740. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  10741. @item x
  10742. @item y
  10743. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  10744. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  10745. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  10746. expression, and vice versa.
  10747. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  10748. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  10749. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  10750. @item color
  10751. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  10752. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  10753. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10754. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  10755. @item eval
  10756. Specify when to evaluate @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x} and @var{y} expression.
  10757. It accepts the following values:
  10758. @table @samp
  10759. @item init
  10760. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when
  10761. a command is processed.
  10762. @item frame
  10763. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  10764. @end table
  10765. Default value is @samp{init}.
  10766. @item aspect
  10767. Pad to aspect instead to a resolution.
  10768. @end table
  10769. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  10770. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  10771. @table @option
  10772. @item in_w
  10773. @item in_h
  10774. The input video width and height.
  10775. @item iw
  10776. @item ih
  10777. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  10778. @item out_w
  10779. @item out_h
  10780. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  10781. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  10782. @item ow
  10783. @item oh
  10784. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  10785. @item x
  10786. @item y
  10787. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  10788. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  10789. @item a
  10790. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  10791. @item sar
  10792. input sample aspect ratio
  10793. @item dar
  10794. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  10795. @item hsub
  10796. @item vsub
  10797. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  10798. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  10799. @end table
  10800. @subsection Examples
  10801. @itemize
  10802. @item
  10803. Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
  10804. size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
  10805. column 0, row 40
  10806. @example
  10807. pad=640:480:0:40:violet
  10808. @end example
  10809. The example above is equivalent to the following command:
  10810. @example
  10811. pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
  10812. @end example
  10813. @item
  10814. Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
  10815. and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
  10816. @example
  10817. pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10818. @end example
  10819. @item
  10820. Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
  10821. value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
  10822. the center of the padded area:
  10823. @example
  10824. pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10825. @end example
  10826. @item
  10827. Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
  10828. @example
  10829. pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10830. @end example
  10831. @item
  10832. In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
  10833. correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
  10834. according to the relation:
  10835. @example
  10836. (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
  10837. X = output_dar / sar
  10838. @end example
  10839. Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
  10840. @example
  10841. pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10842. @end example
  10843. @item
  10844. Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
  10845. corner of the output padded area:
  10846. @example
  10847. pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
  10848. @end example
  10849. @end itemize
  10850. @anchor{palettegen}
  10851. @section palettegen
  10852. Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
  10853. It accepts the following options:
  10854. @table @option
  10855. @item max_colors
  10856. Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
  10857. Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
  10858. will be black.
  10859. @item reserve_transparent
  10860. Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
  10861. transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
  10862. If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
  10863. to disable this option for a standalone image.
  10864. Set by default.
  10865. @item transparency_color
  10866. Set the color that will be used as background for transparency.
  10867. @item stats_mode
  10868. Set statistics mode.
  10869. It accepts the following values:
  10870. @table @samp
  10871. @item full
  10872. Compute full frame histograms.
  10873. @item diff
  10874. Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
  10875. might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
  10876. the background is static.
  10877. @item single
  10878. Compute new histogram for each frame.
  10879. @end table
  10880. Default value is @var{full}.
  10881. @end table
  10882. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
  10883. (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
  10884. color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
  10885. @var{info} logging level.
  10886. @subsection Examples
  10887. @itemize
  10888. @item
  10889. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  10890. @example
  10891. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
  10892. @end example
  10893. @end itemize
  10894. @section paletteuse
  10895. Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
  10896. The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
  10897. be a 256 pixels image.
  10898. It accepts the following options:
  10899. @table @option
  10900. @item dither
  10901. Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
  10902. @table @samp
  10903. @item bayer
  10904. Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
  10905. @item heckbert
  10906. Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
  10907. Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
  10908. reference.
  10909. @item floyd_steinberg
  10910. Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
  10911. @item sierra2
  10912. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
  10913. @item sierra2_4a
  10914. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
  10915. @end table
  10916. Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
  10917. @item bayer_scale
  10918. When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
  10919. pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
  10920. visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
  10921. at the cost of more banding.
  10922. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
  10923. @item diff_mode
  10924. If set, define the zone to process
  10925. @table @samp
  10926. @item rectangle
  10927. Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
  10928. cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
  10929. if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
  10930. scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
  10931. moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
  10932. much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
  10933. @end table
  10934. Default is @var{none}.
  10935. @item new
  10936. Take new palette for each output frame.
  10937. @item alpha_threshold
  10938. Sets the alpha threshold for transparency. Alpha values above this threshold
  10939. will be treated as completely opaque, and values below this threshold will be
  10940. treated as completely transparent.
  10941. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,255]. Default is @var{128}.
  10942. @end table
  10943. @subsection Examples
  10944. @itemize
  10945. @item
  10946. Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
  10947. using @command{ffmpeg}:
  10948. @example
  10949. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
  10950. @end example
  10951. @end itemize
  10952. @section perspective
  10953. Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
  10954. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  10955. @table @option
  10956. @item x0
  10957. @item y0
  10958. @item x1
  10959. @item y1
  10960. @item x2
  10961. @item y2
  10962. @item x3
  10963. @item y3
  10964. Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
  10965. Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
  10966. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
  10967. to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
  10968. then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
  10969. The expressions can use the following variables:
  10970. @table @option
  10971. @item W
  10972. @item H
  10973. the width and height of video frame.
  10974. @item in
  10975. Input frame count.
  10976. @item on
  10977. Output frame count.
  10978. @end table
  10979. @item interpolation
  10980. Set interpolation for perspective correction.
  10981. It accepts the following values:
  10982. @table @samp
  10983. @item linear
  10984. @item cubic
  10985. @end table
  10986. Default value is @samp{linear}.
  10987. @item sense
  10988. Set interpretation of coordinate options.
  10989. It accepts the following values:
  10990. @table @samp
  10991. @item 0, source
  10992. Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
  10993. the corners of the destination.
  10994. @item 1, destination
  10995. Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
  10996. by the given coordinates.
  10997. Default value is @samp{source}.
  10998. @end table
  10999. @item eval
  11000. Set when the expressions for coordinates @option{x0,y0,...x3,y3} are evaluated.
  11001. It accepts the following values:
  11002. @table @samp
  11003. @item init
  11004. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  11005. when a command is processed
  11006. @item frame
  11007. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  11008. @end table
  11009. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11010. @end table
  11011. @section phase
  11012. Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
  11013. The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
  11014. opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
  11015. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11016. @table @option
  11017. @item mode
  11018. Set phase mode.
  11019. It accepts the following values:
  11020. @table @samp
  11021. @item t
  11022. Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
  11023. Filter will delay the bottom field.
  11024. @item b
  11025. Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
  11026. Filter will delay the top field.
  11027. @item p
  11028. Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
  11029. for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
  11030. actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
  11031. @item a
  11032. Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
  11033. opposite.
  11034. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
  11035. basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
  11036. then this works just like @samp{u}.
  11037. @item u
  11038. Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
  11039. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
  11040. analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
  11041. match between the fields.
  11042. @item T
  11043. Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11044. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11045. @item B
  11046. Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11047. Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11048. @item A
  11049. Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
  11050. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
  11051. image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
  11052. like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
  11053. @item U
  11054. Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
  11055. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
  11056. @end table
  11057. @end table
  11058. @section photosensitivity
  11059. Reduce various flashes in video, so to help users with epilepsy.
  11060. It accepts the following options:
  11061. @table @option
  11062. @item frames, f
  11063. Set how many frames to use when filtering. Default is 30.
  11064. @item threshold, t
  11065. Set detection threshold factor. Default is 1.
  11066. Lower is stricter.
  11067. @item skip
  11068. Set how many pixels to skip when sampling frames. Default is 1.
  11069. Allowed range is from 1 to 1024.
  11070. @item bypass
  11071. Leave frames unchanged. Default is disabled.
  11072. @end table
  11073. @section pixdesctest
  11074. Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
  11075. testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
  11076. For example:
  11077. @example
  11078. format=monow, pixdesctest
  11079. @end example
  11080. can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
  11081. @section pixscope
  11082. Display sample values of color channels. Mainly useful for checking color
  11083. and levels. Minimum supported resolution is 640x480.
  11084. The filters accept the following options:
  11085. @table @option
  11086. @item x
  11087. Set scope X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11088. @item y
  11089. Set scope Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11090. @item w
  11091. Set scope width.
  11092. @item h
  11093. Set scope height.
  11094. @item o
  11095. Set window opacity. This window also holds statistics about pixel area.
  11096. @item wx
  11097. Set window X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11098. @item wy
  11099. Set window Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11100. @end table
  11101. @section pp
  11102. Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
  11103. library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
  11104. Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
  11105. Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
  11106. interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
  11107. The filters accept the following options:
  11108. @table @option
  11109. @item subfilters
  11110. Set postprocessing subfilters string.
  11111. @end table
  11112. All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
  11113. @table @option
  11114. @item a/autoq
  11115. Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
  11116. @item c/chrom
  11117. Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
  11118. @item y/nochrom
  11119. Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
  11120. @item n/noluma
  11121. Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
  11122. @end table
  11123. These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
  11124. Available subfilters are:
  11125. @table @option
  11126. @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11127. Horizontal deblocking filter
  11128. @table @option
  11129. @item difference
  11130. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11131. @item flatness
  11132. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11133. @end table
  11134. @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11135. Vertical deblocking filter
  11136. @table @option
  11137. @item difference
  11138. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11139. @item flatness
  11140. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11141. @end table
  11142. @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11143. Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
  11144. @table @option
  11145. @item difference
  11146. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11147. @item flatness
  11148. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11149. @end table
  11150. @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11151. Accurate vertical deblocking filter
  11152. @table @option
  11153. @item difference
  11154. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11155. @item flatness
  11156. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11157. @end table
  11158. @end table
  11159. The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
  11160. flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
  11161. thresholds.
  11162. @table @option
  11163. @item h1/x1hdeblock
  11164. Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
  11165. @item v1/x1vdeblock
  11166. Experimental vertical deblocking filter
  11167. @item dr/dering
  11168. Deringing filter
  11169. @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
  11170. @table @option
  11171. @item threshold1
  11172. larger -> stronger filtering
  11173. @item threshold2
  11174. larger -> stronger filtering
  11175. @item threshold3
  11176. larger -> stronger filtering
  11177. @end table
  11178. @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
  11179. @table @option
  11180. @item f/fullyrange
  11181. Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
  11182. @end table
  11183. @item lb/linblenddeint
  11184. Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11185. filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
  11186. @item li/linipoldeint
  11187. Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11188. linearly interpolating every second line.
  11189. @item ci/cubicipoldeint
  11190. Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
  11191. cubically interpolating every second line.
  11192. @item md/mediandeint
  11193. Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
  11194. median filter to every second line.
  11195. @item fd/ffmpegdeint
  11196. FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
  11197. second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
  11198. @item l5/lowpass5
  11199. Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
  11200. block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
  11201. @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
  11202. Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
  11203. specify.
  11204. @table @option
  11205. @item quantizer
  11206. Quantizer to use
  11207. @end table
  11208. @item de/default
  11209. Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
  11210. @item fa/fast
  11211. Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
  11212. @item ac
  11213. High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
  11214. @end table
  11215. @subsection Examples
  11216. @itemize
  11217. @item
  11218. Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
  11219. brightness/contrast:
  11220. @example
  11221. pp=hb/vb/dr/al
  11222. @end example
  11223. @item
  11224. Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
  11225. @example
  11226. pp=de/-al
  11227. @end example
  11228. @item
  11229. Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
  11230. @example
  11231. pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
  11232. @end example
  11233. @item
  11234. Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
  11235. automatically depending on available CPU time:
  11236. @example
  11237. pp=hb|y/vb|a
  11238. @end example
  11239. @end itemize
  11240. @section pp7
  11241. Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
  11242. similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
  11243. used after IDCT.
  11244. The filter accepts the following options:
  11245. @table @option
  11246. @item qp
  11247. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
  11248. 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
  11249. (if available).
  11250. @item mode
  11251. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  11252. @table @samp
  11253. @item hard
  11254. Set hard thresholding.
  11255. @item soft
  11256. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  11257. @item medium
  11258. Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
  11259. @end table
  11260. @end table
  11261. @section premultiply
  11262. Apply alpha premultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  11263. of second stream as alpha.
  11264. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  11265. The filter accepts the following option:
  11266. @table @option
  11267. @item planes
  11268. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11269. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11270. @item inplace
  11271. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  11272. @end table
  11273. @section prewitt
  11274. Apply prewitt operator to input video stream.
  11275. The filter accepts the following option:
  11276. @table @option
  11277. @item planes
  11278. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11279. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11280. @item scale
  11281. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11282. @item delta
  11283. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11284. @end table
  11285. @anchor{program_opencl}
  11286. @section program_opencl
  11287. Filter video using an OpenCL program.
  11288. @table @option
  11289. @item source
  11290. OpenCL program source file.
  11291. @item kernel
  11292. Kernel name in program.
  11293. @item inputs
  11294. Number of inputs to the filter. Defaults to 1.
  11295. @item size, s
  11296. Size of output frames. Defaults to the same as the first input.
  11297. @end table
  11298. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  11299. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  11300. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  11301. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  11302. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  11303. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  11304. @itemize
  11305. @item
  11306. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  11307. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  11308. @item
  11309. Frame index, @var{unsigned int}.
  11310. This is a counter starting from zero and increasing by one for each frame.
  11311. @item
  11312. Source images, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  11313. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  11314. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  11315. @end itemize
  11316. Example programs:
  11317. @itemize
  11318. @item
  11319. Copy the input to the output (output must be the same size as the input).
  11320. @verbatim
  11321. __kernel void copy(__write_only image2d_t destination,
  11322. unsigned int index,
  11323. __read_only image2d_t source)
  11324. {
  11325. const sampler_t sampler = CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE;
  11326. int2 location = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  11327. float4 value = read_imagef(source, sampler, location);
  11328. write_imagef(destination, location, value);
  11329. }
  11330. @end verbatim
  11331. @item
  11332. Apply a simple transformation, rotating the input by an amount increasing
  11333. with the index counter. Pixel values are linearly interpolated by the
  11334. sampler, and the output need not have the same dimensions as the input.
  11335. @verbatim
  11336. __kernel void rotate_image(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  11337. unsigned int index,
  11338. __read_only image2d_t src)
  11339. {
  11340. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  11341. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  11342. float angle = (float)index / 100.0f;
  11343. float2 dst_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  11344. float2 src_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(src));
  11345. float2 dst_cen = dst_dim / 2.0f;
  11346. float2 src_cen = src_dim / 2.0f;
  11347. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  11348. float2 dst_pos = convert_float2(dst_loc) - dst_cen;
  11349. float2 src_pos = {
  11350. cos(angle) * dst_pos.x - sin(angle) * dst_pos.y,
  11351. sin(angle) * dst_pos.x + cos(angle) * dst_pos.y
  11352. };
  11353. src_pos = src_pos * src_dim / dst_dim;
  11354. float2 src_loc = src_pos + src_cen;
  11355. if (src_loc.x < 0.0f || src_loc.y < 0.0f ||
  11356. src_loc.x > src_dim.x || src_loc.y > src_dim.y)
  11357. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, 0.5f);
  11358. else
  11359. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, read_imagef(src, sampler, src_loc));
  11360. }
  11361. @end verbatim
  11362. @item
  11363. Blend two inputs together, with the amount of each input used varying
  11364. with the index counter.
  11365. @verbatim
  11366. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  11367. unsigned int index,
  11368. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  11369. __read_only image2d_t src2)
  11370. {
  11371. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  11372. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  11373. float blend = (cos((float)index / 50.0f) + 1.0f) / 2.0f;
  11374. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  11375. int2 src1_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src1) / get_image_dim(dst);
  11376. int2 src2_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src2) / get_image_dim(dst);
  11377. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, src1_loc);
  11378. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, src2_loc);
  11379. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, val1 * blend + val2 * (1.0f - blend));
  11380. }
  11381. @end verbatim
  11382. @end itemize
  11383. @section pseudocolor
  11384. Alter frame colors in video with pseudocolors.
  11385. This filter accepts the following options:
  11386. @table @option
  11387. @item c0
  11388. set pixel first component expression
  11389. @item c1
  11390. set pixel second component expression
  11391. @item c2
  11392. set pixel third component expression
  11393. @item c3
  11394. set pixel fourth component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  11395. @item i
  11396. set component to use as base for altering colors
  11397. @end table
  11398. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  11399. the corresponding pixel component values.
  11400. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  11401. @table @option
  11402. @item w
  11403. @item h
  11404. The input width and height.
  11405. @item val
  11406. The input value for the pixel component.
  11407. @item ymin, umin, vmin, amin
  11408. The minimum allowed component value.
  11409. @item ymax, umax, vmax, amax
  11410. The maximum allowed component value.
  11411. @end table
  11412. All expressions default to "val".
  11413. @subsection Examples
  11414. @itemize
  11415. @item
  11416. Change too high luma values to gradient:
  11417. @example
  11418. pseudocolor="'if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(ymin,ymax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(umax,umin,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(vmin,vmax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):-1'"
  11419. @end example
  11420. @end itemize
  11421. @section psnr
  11422. Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
  11423. Ratio) between two input videos.
  11424. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  11425. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  11426. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  11427. the PSNR.
  11428. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  11429. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  11430. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  11431. The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
  11432. The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
  11433. frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
  11434. equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
  11435. @example
  11436. PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
  11437. @end example
  11438. Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
  11439. image.
  11440. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11441. @table @option
  11442. @item stats_file, f
  11443. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
  11444. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  11445. standard output.
  11446. @item stats_version
  11447. Specifies which version of the stats file format to use. Details of
  11448. each format are written below.
  11449. Default value is 1.
  11450. @item stats_add_max
  11451. Determines whether the max value is output to the stats log.
  11452. Default value is 0.
  11453. Requires stats_version >= 2. If this is set and stats_version < 2,
  11454. the filter will return an error.
  11455. @end table
  11456. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  11457. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  11458. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  11459. couple of frames.
  11460. If a @var{stats_version} greater than 1 is specified, a header line precedes
  11461. the list of per-frame-pair stats, with key value pairs following the frame
  11462. format with the following parameters:
  11463. @table @option
  11464. @item psnr_log_version
  11465. The version of the log file format. Will match @var{stats_version}.
  11466. @item fields
  11467. A comma separated list of the per-frame-pair parameters included in
  11468. the log.
  11469. @end table
  11470. A description of each shown per-frame-pair parameter follows:
  11471. @table @option
  11472. @item n
  11473. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  11474. @item mse_avg
  11475. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11476. frames, averaged over all the image components.
  11477. @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_b, mse_a
  11478. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11479. frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  11480. @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
  11481. Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
  11482. specified by the suffix.
  11483. @item max_avg, max_y, max_u, max_v
  11484. Maximum allowed value for each channel, and average over all
  11485. channels.
  11486. @end table
  11487. @subsection Examples
  11488. @itemize
  11489. @item
  11490. For example:
  11491. @example
  11492. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  11493. [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  11494. @end example
  11495. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  11496. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
  11497. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  11498. @item
  11499. Another example with different containers:
  11500. @example
  11501. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=1/AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=1/AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]psnr" -f null -
  11502. @end example
  11503. @end itemize
  11504. @anchor{pullup}
  11505. @section pullup
  11506. Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
  11507. hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
  11508. content.
  11509. The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
  11510. its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
  11511. onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
  11512. fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
  11513. To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
  11514. pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
  11515. @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
  11516. The filter accepts the following options:
  11517. @table @option
  11518. @item jl
  11519. @item jr
  11520. @item jt
  11521. @item jb
  11522. These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
  11523. bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
  11524. while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
  11525. The default is 8 pixels on each side.
  11526. @item sb
  11527. Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
  11528. filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
  11529. excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
  11530. Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
  11531. This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
  11532. the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
  11533. Default value is @code{0}.
  11534. @item mp
  11535. Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
  11536. @table @samp
  11537. @item l
  11538. Use luma plane.
  11539. @item u
  11540. Use chroma blue plane.
  11541. @item v
  11542. Use chroma red plane.
  11543. @end table
  11544. This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
  11545. for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
  11546. source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
  11547. is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
  11548. The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
  11549. load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
  11550. @end table
  11551. For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
  11552. necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
  11553. telecine NTSC input:
  11554. @example
  11555. ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
  11556. @end example
  11557. @section qp
  11558. Change video quantization parameters (QP).
  11559. The filter accepts the following option:
  11560. @table @option
  11561. @item qp
  11562. Set expression for quantization parameter.
  11563. @end table
  11564. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
  11565. the following constants:
  11566. @table @var
  11567. @item known
  11568. 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
  11569. @item qp
  11570. Sequential index starting from -129 to 128.
  11571. @end table
  11572. @subsection Examples
  11573. @itemize
  11574. @item
  11575. Some equation like:
  11576. @example
  11577. qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
  11578. @end example
  11579. @end itemize
  11580. @section random
  11581. Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
  11582. No frame is discarded.
  11583. Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
  11584. @table @option
  11585. @item frames
  11586. Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
  11587. @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
  11588. @item seed
  11589. Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
  11590. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  11591. less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
  11592. best effort basis.
  11593. @end table
  11594. @section readeia608
  11595. Read closed captioning (EIA-608) information from the top lines of a video frame.
  11596. This filter adds frame metadata for @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.cc} and
  11597. @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.line}, where @code{X} is the number of the identified line
  11598. with EIA-608 data (starting from 0). A description of each metadata value follows:
  11599. @table @option
  11600. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.cc
  11601. The two bytes stored as EIA-608 data (printed in hexadecimal).
  11602. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.line
  11603. The number of the line on which the EIA-608 data was identified and read.
  11604. @end table
  11605. This filter accepts the following options:
  11606. @table @option
  11607. @item scan_min
  11608. Set the line to start scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{0}.
  11609. @item scan_max
  11610. Set the line to end scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{29}.
  11611. @item mac
  11612. Set minimal acceptable amplitude change for sync codes detection.
  11613. Default is @code{0.2}. Allowed range is @code{[0.001 - 1]}.
  11614. @item spw
  11615. Set the ratio of width reserved for sync code detection.
  11616. Default is @code{0.27}. Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 0.7]}.
  11617. @item mhd
  11618. Set the max peaks height difference for sync code detection.
  11619. Default is @code{0.1}. Allowed range is @code{[0.0 - 0.5]}.
  11620. @item mpd
  11621. Set max peaks period difference for sync code detection.
  11622. Default is @code{0.1}. Allowed range is @code{[0.0 - 0.5]}.
  11623. @item msd
  11624. Set the first two max start code bits differences.
  11625. Default is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is @code{[0.0 - 0.5]}.
  11626. @item bhd
  11627. Set the minimum ratio of bits height compared to 3rd start code bit.
  11628. Default is @code{0.75}. Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 1]}.
  11629. @item th_w
  11630. Set the white color threshold. Default is @code{0.35}. Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 1]}.
  11631. @item th_b
  11632. Set the black color threshold. Default is @code{0.15}. Allowed range is @code{[0.0 - 0.5]}.
  11633. @item chp
  11634. Enable checking the parity bit. In the event of a parity error, the filter will output
  11635. @code{0x00} for that character. Default is false.
  11636. @item lp
  11637. Lowpass lines prior to further processing. Default is disabled.
  11638. @end table
  11639. @subsection Examples
  11640. @itemize
  11641. @item
  11642. Output a csv with presentation time and the first two lines of identified EIA-608 captioning data.
  11643. @example
  11644. ffprobe -f lavfi -i movie=captioned_video.mov,readeia608 -show_entries frame=pkt_pts_time:frame_tags=lavfi.readeia608.0.cc,lavfi.readeia608.1.cc -of csv
  11645. @end example
  11646. @end itemize
  11647. @section readvitc
  11648. Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a
  11649. video frame.
  11650. The filter adds frame metadata key @code{lavfi.readvitc.tc_str} with the
  11651. timecode value, if a valid timecode has been detected. Further metadata key
  11652. @code{lavfi.readvitc.found} is set to 0/1 depending on whether
  11653. timecode data has been found or not.
  11654. This filter accepts the following options:
  11655. @table @option
  11656. @item scan_max
  11657. Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to
  11658. @code{-1} the full video frame is scanned. Default is @code{45}.
  11659. @item thr_b
  11660. Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11661. default value is @code{0.2}. The value must be equal or less than @code{thr_w}.
  11662. @item thr_w
  11663. Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11664. default value is @code{0.6}. The value must be equal or greater than @code{thr_b}.
  11665. @end table
  11666. @subsection Examples
  11667. @itemize
  11668. @item
  11669. Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected,
  11670. draw @code{--:--:--:--} as a placeholder:
  11671. @example
  11672. ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%@{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--@}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'
  11673. @end example
  11674. @end itemize
  11675. @section remap
  11676. Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.
  11677. Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position
  11678. where x = Xmap(X, Y) and y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero
  11679. value for pixel will be used for destination pixel.
  11680. Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream
  11681. will have Xmap/Ymap video stream dimensions.
  11682. Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.
  11683. @table @option
  11684. @item format
  11685. Specify pixel format of output from this filter. Can be @code{color} or @code{gray}.
  11686. Default is @code{color}.
  11687. @end table
  11688. @section removegrain
  11689. The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
  11690. @table @option
  11691. @item m0
  11692. Set mode for the first plane.
  11693. @item m1
  11694. Set mode for the second plane.
  11695. @item m2
  11696. Set mode for the third plane.
  11697. @item m3
  11698. Set mode for the fourth plane.
  11699. @end table
  11700. Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
  11701. @table @var
  11702. @item 0
  11703. Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
  11704. @item 1
  11705. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11706. @item 2
  11707. Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11708. @item 3
  11709. Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11710. @item 4
  11711. Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11712. This is equivalent to a median filter.
  11713. @item 5
  11714. Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
  11715. @item 6
  11716. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11717. @item 7
  11718. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11719. @item 8
  11720. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11721. @item 9
  11722. Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
  11723. @item 10
  11724. Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
  11725. @item 11
  11726. [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
  11727. @item 12
  11728. Same as mode 11.
  11729. @item 13
  11730. Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
  11731. pixels are the closest.
  11732. @item 14
  11733. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
  11734. pixels are the closest.
  11735. @item 15
  11736. Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
  11737. interpolation formula.
  11738. @item 16
  11739. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
  11740. interpolation formula.
  11741. @item 17
  11742. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
  11743. minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
  11744. @item 18
  11745. Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
  11746. the current pixel is minimal.
  11747. @item 19
  11748. Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
  11749. @item 20
  11750. Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
  11751. @item 21
  11752. Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
  11753. @item 22
  11754. Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
  11755. @item 23
  11756. Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
  11757. @item 24
  11758. Similar as 23.
  11759. @end table
  11760. @section removelogo
  11761. Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
  11762. pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
  11763. comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
  11764. The filter accepts the following options:
  11765. @table @option
  11766. @item filename, f
  11767. Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
  11768. libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
  11769. video stream being processed.
  11770. @end table
  11771. Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
  11772. considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
  11773. the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
  11774. rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
  11775. recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
  11776. visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
  11777. filter once or twice.
  11778. If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
  11779. logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
  11780. reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
  11781. much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
  11782. the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
  11783. pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
  11784. @section repeatfields
  11785. This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
  11786. fields based on its value.
  11787. @section reverse
  11788. Reverse a video clip.
  11789. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  11790. is suggested.
  11791. @subsection Examples
  11792. @itemize
  11793. @item
  11794. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  11795. @example
  11796. trim=end=5,reverse
  11797. @end example
  11798. @end itemize
  11799. @section rgbashift
  11800. Shift R/G/B/A pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  11801. The filter accepts the following options:
  11802. @table @option
  11803. @item rh
  11804. Set amount to shift red horizontally.
  11805. @item rv
  11806. Set amount to shift red vertically.
  11807. @item gh
  11808. Set amount to shift green horizontally.
  11809. @item gv
  11810. Set amount to shift green vertically.
  11811. @item bh
  11812. Set amount to shift blue horizontally.
  11813. @item bv
  11814. Set amount to shift blue vertically.
  11815. @item ah
  11816. Set amount to shift alpha horizontally.
  11817. @item av
  11818. Set amount to shift alpha vertically.
  11819. @item edge
  11820. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  11821. @end table
  11822. @section roberts
  11823. Apply roberts cross operator to input video stream.
  11824. The filter accepts the following option:
  11825. @table @option
  11826. @item planes
  11827. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11828. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11829. @item scale
  11830. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11831. @item delta
  11832. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11833. @end table
  11834. @section rotate
  11835. Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
  11836. The filter accepts the following options:
  11837. A description of the optional parameters follows.
  11838. @table @option
  11839. @item angle, a
  11840. Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
  11841. clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
  11842. result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
  11843. This expression is evaluated for each frame.
  11844. @item out_w, ow
  11845. Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
  11846. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  11847. @item out_h, oh
  11848. Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
  11849. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  11850. @item bilinear
  11851. Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
  11852. it. Default value is 1.
  11853. @item fillcolor, c
  11854. Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
  11855. image. For the general syntax of this option, check the
  11856. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11857. If the special value "none" is selected then no
  11858. background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
  11859. Default value is "black".
  11860. @end table
  11861. The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
  11862. following constants and functions:
  11863. @table @option
  11864. @item n
  11865. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
  11866. before the first frame is filtered.
  11867. @item t
  11868. time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
  11869. configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
  11870. @item hsub
  11871. @item vsub
  11872. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11873. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11874. @item in_w, iw
  11875. @item in_h, ih
  11876. the input video width and height
  11877. @item out_w, ow
  11878. @item out_h, oh
  11879. the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
  11880. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
  11881. @item rotw(a)
  11882. @item roth(a)
  11883. the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
  11884. video rotated by @var{a} radians.
  11885. These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
  11886. @option{out_h} expressions.
  11887. @end table
  11888. @subsection Examples
  11889. @itemize
  11890. @item
  11891. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
  11892. @example
  11893. rotate=PI/6
  11894. @end example
  11895. @item
  11896. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
  11897. @example
  11898. rotate=-PI/6
  11899. @end example
  11900. @item
  11901. Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
  11902. @example
  11903. rotate=45*PI/180
  11904. @end example
  11905. @item
  11906. Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
  11907. @example
  11908. rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
  11909. @end example
  11910. @item
  11911. Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
  11912. seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
  11913. @example
  11914. rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
  11915. @end example
  11916. @item
  11917. Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
  11918. input video is always completely contained in the output:
  11919. @example
  11920. rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
  11921. @end example
  11922. @item
  11923. Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
  11924. shown:
  11925. @example
  11926. rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
  11927. @end example
  11928. @end itemize
  11929. @subsection Commands
  11930. The filter supports the following commands:
  11931. @table @option
  11932. @item a, angle
  11933. Set the angle expression.
  11934. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  11935. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  11936. value.
  11937. @end table
  11938. @section sab
  11939. Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
  11940. The filter accepts the following options:
  11941. @table @option
  11942. @item luma_radius, lr
  11943. Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
  11944. value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
  11945. in slower processing.
  11946. @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
  11947. Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
  11948. value is 1.0.
  11949. @item luma_strength, ls
  11950. Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
  11951. be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
  11952. @item chroma_radius, cr
  11953. Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range -0.9-4.0. A
  11954. greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
  11955. processing.
  11956. @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
  11957. Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the -0.9-2.0 range.
  11958. @item chroma_strength, cs
  11959. Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
  11960. must be a value in the -0.9-100.0 range.
  11961. @end table
  11962. Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
  11963. corresponding luma option value.
  11964. @anchor{scale}
  11965. @section scale
  11966. Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
  11967. The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  11968. of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  11969. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  11970. the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
  11971. requested format.
  11972. @subsection Options
  11973. The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
  11974. supported by the libswscale scaler.
  11975. See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
  11976. the complete list of scaler options.
  11977. @table @option
  11978. @item width, w
  11979. @item height, h
  11980. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  11981. dimension.
  11982. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  11983. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  11984. is used for the output.
  11985. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the scale filter
  11986. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  11987. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  11988. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  11989. adjust the value if necessary.
  11990. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  11991. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  11992. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  11993. expression.
  11994. @item eval
  11995. Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
  11996. @table @samp
  11997. @item init
  11998. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
  11999. @item frame
  12000. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  12001. @end table
  12002. Default value is @samp{init}.
  12003. @item interl
  12004. Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
  12005. @table @samp
  12006. @item 1
  12007. Force interlaced aware scaling.
  12008. @item 0
  12009. Do not apply interlaced scaling.
  12010. @item -1
  12011. Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
  12012. are flagged as interlaced or not.
  12013. @end table
  12014. Default value is @samp{0}.
  12015. @item flags
  12016. Set libswscale scaling flags. See
  12017. @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12018. complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12019. the default flags.
  12020. @item param0, param1
  12021. Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
  12022. @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12023. complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12024. empty parameters.
  12025. @item size, s
  12026. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12027. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12028. @item in_color_matrix
  12029. @item out_color_matrix
  12030. Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
  12031. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12032. a specific value used for the output and encoder.
  12033. If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
  12034. Possible values:
  12035. @table @samp
  12036. @item auto
  12037. Choose automatically.
  12038. @item bt709
  12039. Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
  12040. Recommendation BT.709.
  12041. @item fcc
  12042. Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
  12043. Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
  12044. @item bt601
  12045. @item bt470
  12046. @item smpte170m
  12047. Set color space conforming to:
  12048. @itemize
  12049. @item
  12050. ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
  12051. @item
  12052. ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
  12053. @item
  12054. Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
  12055. @end itemize
  12056. @item smpte240m
  12057. Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
  12058. @item bt2020
  12059. Set color space conforming to ITU-R BT.2020 non-constant luminance system.
  12060. @end table
  12061. @item in_range
  12062. @item out_range
  12063. Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
  12064. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12065. a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
  12066. range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
  12067. @table @samp
  12068. @item auto/unknown
  12069. Choose automatically.
  12070. @item jpeg/full/pc
  12071. Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12072. @item mpeg/limited/tv
  12073. Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12074. @end table
  12075. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12076. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12077. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12078. @table @samp
  12079. @item disable
  12080. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12081. @item decrease
  12082. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12083. @item increase
  12084. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12085. @end table
  12086. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12087. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12088. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12089. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12090. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12091. 1280x533.
  12092. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12093. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12094. to work.
  12095. @item force_divisible_by
  12096. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12097. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12098. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12099. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12100. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12101. may be slightly modified.
  12102. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12103. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12104. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12105. @end table
  12106. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  12107. containing the following constants:
  12108. @table @var
  12109. @item in_w
  12110. @item in_h
  12111. The input width and height
  12112. @item iw
  12113. @item ih
  12114. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  12115. @item out_w
  12116. @item out_h
  12117. The output (scaled) width and height
  12118. @item ow
  12119. @item oh
  12120. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  12121. @item a
  12122. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  12123. @item sar
  12124. input sample aspect ratio
  12125. @item dar
  12126. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  12127. @item hsub
  12128. @item vsub
  12129. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12130. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12131. @item ohsub
  12132. @item ovsub
  12133. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12134. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12135. @end table
  12136. @subsection Examples
  12137. @itemize
  12138. @item
  12139. Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
  12140. @example
  12141. scale=w=200:h=100
  12142. @end example
  12143. This is equivalent to:
  12144. @example
  12145. scale=200:100
  12146. @end example
  12147. or:
  12148. @example
  12149. scale=200x100
  12150. @end example
  12151. @item
  12152. Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
  12153. @example
  12154. scale=qcif
  12155. @end example
  12156. which can also be written as:
  12157. @example
  12158. scale=size=qcif
  12159. @end example
  12160. @item
  12161. Scale the input to 2x:
  12162. @example
  12163. scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
  12164. @end example
  12165. @item
  12166. The above is the same as:
  12167. @example
  12168. scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
  12169. @end example
  12170. @item
  12171. Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
  12172. @example
  12173. scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
  12174. @end example
  12175. @item
  12176. Scale the input to half size:
  12177. @example
  12178. scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
  12179. @end example
  12180. @item
  12181. Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
  12182. @example
  12183. scale=3/2*iw:ow
  12184. @end example
  12185. @item
  12186. Seek Greek harmony:
  12187. @example
  12188. scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
  12189. scale=ih*PHI:ih
  12190. @end example
  12191. @item
  12192. Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
  12193. @example
  12194. scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
  12195. @end example
  12196. @item
  12197. Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
  12198. subsample values:
  12199. @example
  12200. scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
  12201. @end example
  12202. @item
  12203. Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
  12204. keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
  12205. @example
  12206. scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
  12207. @end example
  12208. @item
  12209. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar:
  12210. @example
  12211. scale='trunc(ih*dar):ih',setsar=1/1
  12212. @end example
  12213. @item
  12214. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar,
  12215. making sure the resulting resolution is even (required by some codecs):
  12216. @example
  12217. scale='trunc(ih*dar/2)*2:trunc(ih/2)*2',setsar=1/1
  12218. @end example
  12219. @end itemize
  12220. @subsection Commands
  12221. This filter supports the following commands:
  12222. @table @option
  12223. @item width, w
  12224. @item height, h
  12225. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12226. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12227. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12228. value.
  12229. @end table
  12230. @section scale_npp
  12231. Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel
  12232. format conversion on CUDA video frames. Setting the output width and height
  12233. works in the same way as for the @var{scale} filter.
  12234. The following additional options are accepted:
  12235. @table @option
  12236. @item format
  12237. The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the
  12238. default), the input format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation
  12239. and conversion is not yet supported for hardware frames
  12240. @item interp_algo
  12241. The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:
  12242. @table @option
  12243. @item nn
  12244. Nearest neighbour.
  12245. @item linear
  12246. @item cubic
  12247. @item cubic2p_bspline
  12248. 2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)
  12249. @item cubic2p_catmullrom
  12250. 2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)
  12251. @item cubic2p_b05c03
  12252. 2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)
  12253. @item super
  12254. Supersampling
  12255. @item lanczos
  12256. @end table
  12257. @end table
  12258. @section scale2ref
  12259. Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
  12260. See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
  12261. uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis. scale2ref also
  12262. supports the following additional constants for the @option{w} and
  12263. @option{h} options:
  12264. @table @var
  12265. @item main_w
  12266. @item main_h
  12267. The main input video's width and height
  12268. @item main_a
  12269. The same as @var{main_w} / @var{main_h}
  12270. @item main_sar
  12271. The main input video's sample aspect ratio
  12272. @item main_dar, mdar
  12273. The main input video's display aspect ratio. Calculated from
  12274. @code{(main_w / main_h) * main_sar}.
  12275. @item main_hsub
  12276. @item main_vsub
  12277. The main input video's horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values.
  12278. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub}
  12279. is 1.
  12280. @end table
  12281. @subsection Examples
  12282. @itemize
  12283. @item
  12284. Scale a subtitle stream (b) to match the main video (a) in size before overlaying
  12285. @example
  12286. 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
  12287. @end example
  12288. @item
  12289. Scale a logo to 1/10th the height of a video, while preserving its display aspect ratio.
  12290. @example
  12291. [logo-in][video-in]scale2ref=w=oh*mdar:h=ih/10[logo-out][video-out]
  12292. @end example
  12293. @end itemize
  12294. @section scroll
  12295. Scroll input video horizontally and/or vertically by constant speed.
  12296. The filter accepts the following options:
  12297. @table @option
  12298. @item horizontal, h
  12299. Set the horizontal scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12300. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12301. @item vertical, v
  12302. Set the vertical scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12303. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12304. @item hpos
  12305. Set the initial horizontal scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12306. @item vpos
  12307. Set the initial vertical scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12308. @end table
  12309. @subsection Commands
  12310. This filter supports the following @ref{commands}:
  12311. @table @option
  12312. @item horizontal, h
  12313. Set the horizontal scrolling speed.
  12314. @item vertical, v
  12315. Set the vertical scrolling speed.
  12316. @end table
  12317. @anchor{selectivecolor}
  12318. @section selectivecolor
  12319. Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
  12320. as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
  12321. by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
  12322. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
  12323. The filter accepts the following options:
  12324. @table @option
  12325. @item correction_method
  12326. Select color correction method.
  12327. Available values are:
  12328. @table @samp
  12329. @item absolute
  12330. Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
  12331. component value).
  12332. @item relative
  12333. Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
  12334. @end table
  12335. Default is @code{absolute}.
  12336. @item reds
  12337. Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
  12338. @item yellows
  12339. Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
  12340. @item greens
  12341. Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
  12342. @item cyans
  12343. Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
  12344. @item blues
  12345. Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
  12346. @item magentas
  12347. Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
  12348. @item whites
  12349. Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
  12350. @item neutrals
  12351. Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
  12352. @item blacks
  12353. Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
  12354. @item psfile
  12355. Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
  12356. @end table
  12357. All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
  12358. 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
  12359. respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
  12360. pixels of its range.
  12361. @subsection Examples
  12362. @itemize
  12363. @item
  12364. Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
  12365. increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
  12366. @example
  12367. selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
  12368. @end example
  12369. @item
  12370. Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
  12371. @example
  12372. selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
  12373. @end example
  12374. @end itemize
  12375. @anchor{separatefields}
  12376. @section separatefields
  12377. The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
  12378. each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
  12379. with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
  12380. This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  12381. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  12382. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
  12383. @section setdar, setsar
  12384. The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
  12385. output video.
  12386. This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
  12387. Ratio, according to the following equation:
  12388. @example
  12389. @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
  12390. @end example
  12391. Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
  12392. dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
  12393. this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
  12394. e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
  12395. applied.
  12396. The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
  12397. the filter output video.
  12398. Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
  12399. output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
  12400. above.
  12401. Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
  12402. filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
  12403. another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
  12404. It accepts the following parameters:
  12405. @table @option
  12406. @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
  12407. Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
  12408. The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
  12409. a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
  12410. @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
  12411. the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
  12412. In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
  12413. should be escaped.
  12414. @item max
  12415. Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
  12416. denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
  12417. Default value is @code{100}.
  12418. @end table
  12419. The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
  12420. the following constants:
  12421. @table @option
  12422. @item E, PI, PHI
  12423. These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
  12424. (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
  12425. @item w, h
  12426. The input width and height.
  12427. @item a
  12428. These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
  12429. @item sar
  12430. The input sample aspect ratio.
  12431. @item dar
  12432. The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
  12433. (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  12434. @item hsub, vsub
  12435. Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  12436. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12437. @end table
  12438. @subsection Examples
  12439. @itemize
  12440. @item
  12441. To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
  12442. @example
  12443. setdar=dar=1.77777
  12444. setdar=dar=16/9
  12445. @end example
  12446. @item
  12447. To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
  12448. @example
  12449. setsar=sar=10/11
  12450. @end example
  12451. @item
  12452. To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
  12453. 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
  12454. @example
  12455. setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
  12456. @end example
  12457. @end itemize
  12458. @anchor{setfield}
  12459. @section setfield
  12460. Force field for the output video frame.
  12461. The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
  12462. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12463. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12464. following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
  12465. The filter accepts the following options:
  12466. @table @option
  12467. @item mode
  12468. Available values are:
  12469. @table @samp
  12470. @item auto
  12471. Keep the same field property.
  12472. @item bff
  12473. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12474. @item tff
  12475. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12476. @item prog
  12477. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12478. @end table
  12479. @end table
  12480. @anchor{setparams}
  12481. @section setparams
  12482. Force frame parameter for the output video frame.
  12483. The @code{setparams} filter marks interlace and color range for the
  12484. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12485. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12486. filters/encoders.
  12487. @table @option
  12488. @item field_mode
  12489. Available values are:
  12490. @table @samp
  12491. @item auto
  12492. Keep the same field property (default).
  12493. @item bff
  12494. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12495. @item tff
  12496. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12497. @item prog
  12498. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12499. @end table
  12500. @item range
  12501. Available values are:
  12502. @table @samp
  12503. @item auto
  12504. Keep the same color range property (default).
  12505. @item unspecified, unknown
  12506. Mark the frame as unspecified color range.
  12507. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  12508. Mark the frame as limited range.
  12509. @item full, pc, jpeg
  12510. Mark the frame as full range.
  12511. @end table
  12512. @item color_primaries
  12513. Set the color primaries.
  12514. Available values are:
  12515. @table @samp
  12516. @item auto
  12517. Keep the same color primaries property (default).
  12518. @item bt709
  12519. @item unknown
  12520. @item bt470m
  12521. @item bt470bg
  12522. @item smpte170m
  12523. @item smpte240m
  12524. @item film
  12525. @item bt2020
  12526. @item smpte428
  12527. @item smpte431
  12528. @item smpte432
  12529. @item jedec-p22
  12530. @end table
  12531. @item color_trc
  12532. Set the color transfer.
  12533. Available values are:
  12534. @table @samp
  12535. @item auto
  12536. Keep the same color trc property (default).
  12537. @item bt709
  12538. @item unknown
  12539. @item bt470m
  12540. @item bt470bg
  12541. @item smpte170m
  12542. @item smpte240m
  12543. @item linear
  12544. @item log100
  12545. @item log316
  12546. @item iec61966-2-4
  12547. @item bt1361e
  12548. @item iec61966-2-1
  12549. @item bt2020-10
  12550. @item bt2020-12
  12551. @item smpte2084
  12552. @item smpte428
  12553. @item arib-std-b67
  12554. @end table
  12555. @item colorspace
  12556. Set the colorspace.
  12557. Available values are:
  12558. @table @samp
  12559. @item auto
  12560. Keep the same colorspace property (default).
  12561. @item gbr
  12562. @item bt709
  12563. @item unknown
  12564. @item fcc
  12565. @item bt470bg
  12566. @item smpte170m
  12567. @item smpte240m
  12568. @item ycgco
  12569. @item bt2020nc
  12570. @item bt2020c
  12571. @item smpte2085
  12572. @item chroma-derived-nc
  12573. @item chroma-derived-c
  12574. @item ictcp
  12575. @end table
  12576. @end table
  12577. @section showinfo
  12578. Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
  12579. The input video is not modified.
  12580. This filter supports the following options:
  12581. @table @option
  12582. @item checksum
  12583. Calculate checksums of each plane. By default enabled.
  12584. @end table
  12585. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  12586. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  12587. The following values are shown in the output:
  12588. @table @option
  12589. @item n
  12590. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12591. @item pts
  12592. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12593. time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
  12594. @item pts_time
  12595. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12596. seconds.
  12597. @item pos
  12598. The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
  12599. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12600. @item fmt
  12601. The pixel format name.
  12602. @item sar
  12603. The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12604. @var{num}/@var{den}.
  12605. @item s
  12606. The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12607. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12608. @item i
  12609. The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
  12610. for bottom field first).
  12611. @item iskey
  12612. This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
  12613. @item type
  12614. The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
  12615. P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
  12616. Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
  12617. the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
  12618. @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
  12619. @item checksum
  12620. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
  12621. @item plane_checksum
  12622. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
  12623. expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
  12624. @end table
  12625. @section showpalette
  12626. Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
  12627. @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
  12628. It accepts the following option:
  12629. @table @option
  12630. @item s
  12631. Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
  12632. @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
  12633. @end table
  12634. @section shuffleframes
  12635. Reorder and/or duplicate and/or drop video frames.
  12636. It accepts the following parameters:
  12637. @table @option
  12638. @item mapping
  12639. Set the destination indexes of input frames.
  12640. This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
  12641. frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
  12642. '-1' index have special meaning and that is to drop frame.
  12643. @end table
  12644. The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12645. @subsection Examples
  12646. @itemize
  12647. @item
  12648. Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
  12649. @example
  12650. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
  12651. @end example
  12652. @item
  12653. Swap 10th and 1st frame of every ten frames of the input:
  12654. @example
  12655. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0" OUTPUT
  12656. @end example
  12657. @end itemize
  12658. @section shuffleplanes
  12659. Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
  12660. It accepts the following parameters:
  12661. @table @option
  12662. @item map0
  12663. The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
  12664. @item map1
  12665. The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
  12666. @item map2
  12667. The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
  12668. @item map3
  12669. The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
  12670. @end table
  12671. The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12672. @subsection Examples
  12673. @itemize
  12674. @item
  12675. Swap the second and third planes of the input:
  12676. @example
  12677. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
  12678. @end example
  12679. @end itemize
  12680. @anchor{signalstats}
  12681. @section signalstats
  12682. Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
  12683. with the digitization of analog video media.
  12684. By default the filter will log these metadata values:
  12685. @table @option
  12686. @item YMIN
  12687. Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12688. range of [0-255].
  12689. @item YLOW
  12690. Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12691. range of [0-255].
  12692. @item YAVG
  12693. Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12694. [0-255].
  12695. @item YHIGH
  12696. Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12697. range of [0-255].
  12698. @item YMAX
  12699. Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12700. range of [0-255].
  12701. @item UMIN
  12702. Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12703. range of [0-255].
  12704. @item ULOW
  12705. Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12706. range of [0-255].
  12707. @item UAVG
  12708. Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12709. [0-255].
  12710. @item UHIGH
  12711. Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12712. range of [0-255].
  12713. @item UMAX
  12714. Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12715. range of [0-255].
  12716. @item VMIN
  12717. Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12718. range of [0-255].
  12719. @item VLOW
  12720. Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12721. range of [0-255].
  12722. @item VAVG
  12723. Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12724. [0-255].
  12725. @item VHIGH
  12726. Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12727. range of [0-255].
  12728. @item VMAX
  12729. Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12730. range of [0-255].
  12731. @item SATMIN
  12732. Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12733. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12734. @item SATLOW
  12735. Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
  12736. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12737. @item SATAVG
  12738. Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
  12739. of [0-~181.02].
  12740. @item SATHIGH
  12741. Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
  12742. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12743. @item SATMAX
  12744. Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12745. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12746. @item HUEMED
  12747. Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12748. [0-360].
  12749. @item HUEAVG
  12750. Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12751. [0-360].
  12752. @item YDIF
  12753. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
  12754. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12755. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12756. @item UDIF
  12757. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
  12758. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12759. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12760. @item VDIF
  12761. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
  12762. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12763. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12764. @item YBITDEPTH
  12765. Display bit depth of Y plane in current frame.
  12766. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12767. @item UBITDEPTH
  12768. Display bit depth of U plane in current frame.
  12769. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12770. @item VBITDEPTH
  12771. Display bit depth of V plane in current frame.
  12772. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12773. @end table
  12774. The filter accepts the following options:
  12775. @table @option
  12776. @item stat
  12777. @item out
  12778. @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
  12779. @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
  12780. Both options accept the following values:
  12781. @table @samp
  12782. @item tout
  12783. Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
  12784. unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
  12785. include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
  12786. @item vrep
  12787. Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
  12788. similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
  12789. repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
  12790. analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
  12791. analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
  12792. @item brng
  12793. Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
  12794. @end table
  12795. @item color, c
  12796. Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
  12797. yellow.
  12798. @end table
  12799. @subsection Examples
  12800. @itemize
  12801. @item
  12802. Output data of various video metrics:
  12803. @example
  12804. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
  12805. @end example
  12806. @item
  12807. Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
  12808. @example
  12809. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
  12810. @end example
  12811. @item
  12812. Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
  12813. @example
  12814. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
  12815. @end example
  12816. @item
  12817. Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
  12818. @example
  12819. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
  12820. @end example
  12821. The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
  12822. @example
  12823. time %@{pts:hms@}
  12824. Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
  12825. U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
  12826. V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
  12827. saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
  12828. @end example
  12829. @end itemize
  12830. @anchor{signature}
  12831. @section signature
  12832. Calculates the MPEG-7 Video Signature. The filter can handle more than one
  12833. input. In this case the matching between the inputs can be calculated additionally.
  12834. The filter always passes through the first input. The signature of each stream can
  12835. be written into a file.
  12836. It accepts the following options:
  12837. @table @option
  12838. @item detectmode
  12839. Enable or disable the matching process.
  12840. Available values are:
  12841. @table @samp
  12842. @item off
  12843. Disable the calculation of a matching (default).
  12844. @item full
  12845. Calculate the matching for the whole video and output whether the whole video
  12846. matches or only parts.
  12847. @item fast
  12848. Calculate only until a matching is found or the video ends. Should be faster in
  12849. some cases.
  12850. @end table
  12851. @item nb_inputs
  12852. Set the number of inputs. The option value must be a non negative integer.
  12853. Default value is 1.
  12854. @item filename
  12855. Set the path to which the output is written. If there is more than one input,
  12856. the path must be a prototype, i.e. must contain %d or %0nd (where n is a positive
  12857. integer), that will be replaced with the input number. If no filename is
  12858. specified, no output will be written. This is the default.
  12859. @item format
  12860. Choose the output format.
  12861. Available values are:
  12862. @table @samp
  12863. @item binary
  12864. Use the specified binary representation (default).
  12865. @item xml
  12866. Use the specified xml representation.
  12867. @end table
  12868. @item th_d
  12869. Set threshold to detect one word as similar. The option value must be an integer
  12870. greater than zero. The default value is 9000.
  12871. @item th_dc
  12872. Set threshold to detect all words as similar. The option value must be an integer
  12873. greater than zero. The default value is 60000.
  12874. @item th_xh
  12875. Set threshold to detect frames as similar. The option value must be an integer
  12876. greater than zero. The default value is 116.
  12877. @item th_di
  12878. Set the minimum length of a sequence in frames to recognize it as matching
  12879. sequence. The option value must be a non negative integer value.
  12880. The default value is 0.
  12881. @item th_it
  12882. Set the minimum relation, that matching frames to all frames must have.
  12883. The option value must be a double value between 0 and 1. The default value is 0.5.
  12884. @end table
  12885. @subsection Examples
  12886. @itemize
  12887. @item
  12888. To calculate the signature of an input video and store it in signature.bin:
  12889. @example
  12890. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf signature=filename=signature.bin -map 0:v -f null -
  12891. @end example
  12892. @item
  12893. To detect whether two videos match and store the signatures in XML format in
  12894. signature0.xml and signature1.xml:
  12895. @example
  12896. ffmpeg -i input1.mkv -i input2.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] signature=nb_inputs=2:detectmode=full:format=xml:filename=signature%d.xml" -map :v -f null -
  12897. @end example
  12898. @end itemize
  12899. @anchor{smartblur}
  12900. @section smartblur
  12901. Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
  12902. It accepts the following options:
  12903. @table @option
  12904. @item luma_radius, lr
  12905. Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  12906. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  12907. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  12908. @item luma_strength, ls
  12909. Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
  12910. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  12911. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  12912. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  12913. @item luma_threshold, lt
  12914. Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  12915. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  12916. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  12917. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  12918. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  12919. @item chroma_radius, cr
  12920. Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  12921. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  12922. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is @option{luma_radius}.
  12923. @item chroma_strength, cs
  12924. Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
  12925. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  12926. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  12927. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is @option{luma_strength}.
  12928. @item chroma_threshold, ct
  12929. Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  12930. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  12931. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  12932. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  12933. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is @option{luma_threshold}.
  12934. @end table
  12935. If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
  12936. is set.
  12937. @section sobel
  12938. Apply sobel operator to input video stream.
  12939. The filter accepts the following option:
  12940. @table @option
  12941. @item planes
  12942. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  12943. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  12944. @item scale
  12945. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  12946. @item delta
  12947. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  12948. @end table
  12949. @anchor{spp}
  12950. @section spp
  12951. Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
  12952. at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
  12953. and average the results.
  12954. The filter accepts the following options:
  12955. @table @option
  12956. @item quality
  12957. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  12958. an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  12959. effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  12960. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  12961. @code{3}.
  12962. @item qp
  12963. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  12964. from the video stream (if available).
  12965. @item mode
  12966. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  12967. @table @samp
  12968. @item hard
  12969. Set hard thresholding (default).
  12970. @item soft
  12971. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  12972. @end table
  12973. @item use_bframe_qp
  12974. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  12975. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  12976. @code{0} (not enabled).
  12977. @end table
  12978. @section sr
  12979. Scale the input by applying one of the super-resolution methods based on
  12980. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  12981. @itemize
  12982. @item
  12983. Super-Resolution Convolutional Neural Network model (SRCNN).
  12984. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1501.00092}.
  12985. @item
  12986. Efficient Sub-Pixel Convolutional Neural Network model (ESPCN).
  12987. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1609.05158}.
  12988. @end itemize
  12989. Training scripts as well as scripts for model file (.pb) saving can be found at
  12990. @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/sr/tree/sr_dnn_native}. Original repository
  12991. is at @url{https://github.com/HighVoltageRocknRoll/sr.git}.
  12992. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  12993. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  12994. The filter accepts the following options:
  12995. @table @option
  12996. @item dnn_backend
  12997. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  12998. the following values:
  12999. @table @samp
  13000. @item native
  13001. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  13002. @item tensorflow
  13003. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  13004. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  13005. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  13006. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  13007. @end table
  13008. Default value is @samp{native}.
  13009. @item model
  13010. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  13011. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow backend
  13012. can load files for both formats, while native backend can load files for only
  13013. its format.
  13014. @item scale_factor
  13015. Set scale factor for SRCNN model. Allowed values are @code{2}, @code{3} and @code{4}.
  13016. Default value is @code{2}. Scale factor is necessary for SRCNN model, because it accepts
  13017. input upscaled using bicubic upscaling with proper scale factor.
  13018. @end table
  13019. @section ssim
  13020. Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
  13021. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  13022. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  13023. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  13024. the SSIM.
  13025. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  13026. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  13027. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  13028. The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
  13029. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  13030. @table @option
  13031. @item stats_file, f
  13032. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
  13033. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  13034. standard output.
  13035. @end table
  13036. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  13037. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  13038. couple of frames.
  13039. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  13040. @table @option
  13041. @item n
  13042. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  13043. @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
  13044. SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  13045. @item All
  13046. SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
  13047. @item dB
  13048. Same as above but in dB representation.
  13049. @end table
  13050. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  13051. @subsection Examples
  13052. @itemize
  13053. @item
  13054. For example:
  13055. @example
  13056. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  13057. [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  13058. @end example
  13059. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  13060. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
  13061. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  13062. @item
  13063. Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
  13064. @example
  13065. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
  13066. @end example
  13067. @item
  13068. Another example with different containers:
  13069. @example
  13070. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=1/AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=1/AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]ssim" -f null -
  13071. @end example
  13072. @end itemize
  13073. @section stereo3d
  13074. Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
  13075. The filters accept the following options:
  13076. @table @option
  13077. @item in
  13078. Set stereoscopic image format of input.
  13079. Available values for input image formats are:
  13080. @table @samp
  13081. @item sbsl
  13082. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13083. @item sbsr
  13084. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13085. @item sbs2l
  13086. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13087. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13088. @item sbs2r
  13089. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13090. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13091. @item abl
  13092. @item tbl
  13093. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13094. @item abr
  13095. @item tbr
  13096. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13097. @item ab2l
  13098. @item tb2l
  13099. above-below with half height resolution
  13100. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13101. @item ab2r
  13102. @item tb2r
  13103. above-below with half height resolution
  13104. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13105. @item al
  13106. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13107. @item ar
  13108. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13109. @item irl
  13110. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13111. @item irr
  13112. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13113. @item icl
  13114. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13115. @item icr
  13116. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13117. Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
  13118. @end table
  13119. @item out
  13120. Set stereoscopic image format of output.
  13121. @table @samp
  13122. @item sbsl
  13123. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13124. @item sbsr
  13125. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13126. @item sbs2l
  13127. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13128. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13129. @item sbs2r
  13130. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13131. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13132. @item abl
  13133. @item tbl
  13134. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13135. @item abr
  13136. @item tbr
  13137. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13138. @item ab2l
  13139. @item tb2l
  13140. above-below with half height resolution
  13141. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13142. @item ab2r
  13143. @item tb2r
  13144. above-below with half height resolution
  13145. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13146. @item al
  13147. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13148. @item ar
  13149. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13150. @item irl
  13151. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13152. @item irr
  13153. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13154. @item arbg
  13155. anaglyph red/blue gray
  13156. (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13157. @item argg
  13158. anaglyph red/green gray
  13159. (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
  13160. @item arcg
  13161. anaglyph red/cyan gray
  13162. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13163. @item arch
  13164. anaglyph red/cyan half colored
  13165. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13166. @item arcc
  13167. anaglyph red/cyan color
  13168. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13169. @item arcd
  13170. anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13171. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13172. @item agmg
  13173. anaglyph green/magenta gray
  13174. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13175. @item agmh
  13176. anaglyph green/magenta half colored
  13177. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13178. @item agmc
  13179. anaglyph green/magenta colored
  13180. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13181. @item agmd
  13182. anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13183. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13184. @item aybg
  13185. anaglyph yellow/blue gray
  13186. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13187. @item aybh
  13188. anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
  13189. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13190. @item aybc
  13191. anaglyph yellow/blue colored
  13192. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13193. @item aybd
  13194. anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13195. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13196. @item ml
  13197. mono output (left eye only)
  13198. @item mr
  13199. mono output (right eye only)
  13200. @item chl
  13201. checkerboard, left eye first
  13202. @item chr
  13203. checkerboard, right eye first
  13204. @item icl
  13205. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13206. @item icr
  13207. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13208. @item hdmi
  13209. HDMI frame pack
  13210. @end table
  13211. Default value is @samp{arcd}.
  13212. @end table
  13213. @subsection Examples
  13214. @itemize
  13215. @item
  13216. Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
  13217. @example
  13218. stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
  13219. @end example
  13220. @item
  13221. Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
  13222. @example
  13223. stereo3d=abl:sbsr
  13224. @end example
  13225. @end itemize
  13226. @section streamselect, astreamselect
  13227. Select video or audio streams.
  13228. The filter accepts the following options:
  13229. @table @option
  13230. @item inputs
  13231. Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
  13232. @item map
  13233. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13234. @end table
  13235. @subsection Commands
  13236. The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
  13237. commands:
  13238. @table @option
  13239. @item map
  13240. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13241. @end table
  13242. @subsection Examples
  13243. @itemize
  13244. @item
  13245. Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
  13246. @example
  13247. sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13248. @end example
  13249. @item
  13250. Same as above, but for audio:
  13251. @example
  13252. asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13253. @end example
  13254. @end itemize
  13255. @anchor{subtitles}
  13256. @section subtitles
  13257. Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
  13258. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  13259. @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
  13260. libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
  13261. Alpha) subtitles format.
  13262. The filter accepts the following options:
  13263. @table @option
  13264. @item filename, f
  13265. Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
  13266. @item original_size
  13267. Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
  13268. was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13269. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13270. Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
  13271. correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
  13272. @item fontsdir
  13273. Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
  13274. These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
  13275. @item alpha
  13276. Process alpha channel, by default alpha channel is untouched.
  13277. @item charenc
  13278. Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
  13279. useful if not UTF-8.
  13280. @item stream_index, si
  13281. Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
  13282. @item force_style
  13283. Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
  13284. string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
  13285. @end table
  13286. If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
  13287. specifies the @option{filename}.
  13288. For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
  13289. video, use the command:
  13290. @example
  13291. subtitles=sub.srt
  13292. @end example
  13293. which is equivalent to:
  13294. @example
  13295. subtitles=filename=sub.srt
  13296. @end example
  13297. To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
  13298. @example
  13299. subtitles=video.mkv
  13300. @end example
  13301. To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
  13302. @example
  13303. subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
  13304. @end example
  13305. To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in 80% transparent blue
  13306. @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
  13307. @example
  13308. subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HCCFF0000'
  13309. @end example
  13310. @section super2xsai
  13311. Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
  13312. Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
  13313. Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
  13314. @section swaprect
  13315. Swap two rectangular objects in video.
  13316. This filter accepts the following options:
  13317. @table @option
  13318. @item w
  13319. Set object width.
  13320. @item h
  13321. Set object height.
  13322. @item x1
  13323. Set 1st rect x coordinate.
  13324. @item y1
  13325. Set 1st rect y coordinate.
  13326. @item x2
  13327. Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
  13328. @item y2
  13329. Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
  13330. All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
  13331. @end table
  13332. The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
  13333. @table @option
  13334. @item w
  13335. @item h
  13336. The input width and height.
  13337. @item a
  13338. same as @var{w} / @var{h}
  13339. @item sar
  13340. input sample aspect ratio
  13341. @item dar
  13342. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  13343. @item n
  13344. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  13345. @item t
  13346. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  13347. @item pos
  13348. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  13349. @end table
  13350. @section swapuv
  13351. Swap U & V plane.
  13352. @section telecine
  13353. Apply telecine process to the video.
  13354. This filter accepts the following options:
  13355. @table @option
  13356. @item first_field
  13357. @table @samp
  13358. @item top, t
  13359. top field first
  13360. @item bottom, b
  13361. bottom field first
  13362. The default value is @code{top}.
  13363. @end table
  13364. @item pattern
  13365. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  13366. The default value is @code{23}.
  13367. @end table
  13368. @example
  13369. Some typical patterns:
  13370. NTSC output (30i):
  13371. 27.5p: 32222
  13372. 24p: 23 (classic)
  13373. 24p: 2332 (preferred)
  13374. 20p: 33
  13375. 18p: 334
  13376. 16p: 3444
  13377. PAL output (25i):
  13378. 27.5p: 12222
  13379. 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
  13380. 16.67p: 33
  13381. 16p: 33333334
  13382. @end example
  13383. @section threshold
  13384. Apply threshold effect to video stream.
  13385. This filter needs four video streams to perform thresholding.
  13386. First stream is stream we are filtering.
  13387. Second stream is holding threshold values, third stream is holding min values,
  13388. and last, fourth stream is holding max values.
  13389. The filter accepts the following option:
  13390. @table @option
  13391. @item planes
  13392. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13393. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13394. @end table
  13395. For example if first stream pixel's component value is less then threshold value
  13396. of pixel component from 2nd threshold stream, third stream value will picked,
  13397. otherwise fourth stream pixel component value will be picked.
  13398. Using color source filter one can perform various types of thresholding:
  13399. @subsection Examples
  13400. @itemize
  13401. @item
  13402. Binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13403. @example
  13404. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=black -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13405. @end example
  13406. @item
  13407. Inverted binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13408. @example
  13409. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -f lavfi -i color=black -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13410. @end example
  13411. @item
  13412. Truncate binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13413. @example
  13414. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13415. @end example
  13416. @item
  13417. Threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13418. @example
  13419. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -i 320x240.avi -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13420. @end example
  13421. @item
  13422. Inverted threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13423. @example
  13424. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13425. @end example
  13426. @end itemize
  13427. @section thumbnail
  13428. Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
  13429. The filter accepts the following options:
  13430. @table @option
  13431. @item n
  13432. Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
  13433. will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
  13434. the end. Default is @code{100}.
  13435. @end table
  13436. Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
  13437. value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
  13438. @subsection Examples
  13439. @itemize
  13440. @item
  13441. Extract one picture each 50 frames:
  13442. @example
  13443. thumbnail=50
  13444. @end example
  13445. @item
  13446. Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
  13447. @example
  13448. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
  13449. @end example
  13450. @end itemize
  13451. @section tile
  13452. Tile several successive frames together.
  13453. The filter accepts the following options:
  13454. @table @option
  13455. @item layout
  13456. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  13457. this option, check the
  13458. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13459. @item nb_frames
  13460. Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
  13461. than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
  13462. the area will be used.
  13463. @item margin
  13464. Set the outer border margin in pixels.
  13465. @item padding
  13466. Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
  13467. more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
  13468. refer to the pad video filter.
  13469. @item color
  13470. Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13471. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13472. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  13473. @item overlap
  13474. Set the number of frames to overlap when tiling several successive frames together.
  13475. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13476. @item init_padding
  13477. Set the number of frames to initially be empty before displaying first output frame.
  13478. This controls how soon will one get first output frame.
  13479. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13480. @end table
  13481. @subsection Examples
  13482. @itemize
  13483. @item
  13484. Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
  13485. @example
  13486. ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
  13487. @end example
  13488. The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
  13489. duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
  13490. rate.
  13491. @item
  13492. Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
  13493. with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
  13494. mixed flat and named options:
  13495. @example
  13496. tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
  13497. @end example
  13498. @end itemize
  13499. @section tinterlace
  13500. Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
  13501. Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
  13502. considered odd.
  13503. The filter accepts the following options:
  13504. @table @option
  13505. @item mode
  13506. Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
  13507. as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
  13508. Available values are:
  13509. @table @samp
  13510. @item merge, 0
  13511. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13512. generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
  13513. @example
  13514. ------> time
  13515. Input:
  13516. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13517. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13518. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13519. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13520. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13521. Output:
  13522. 11111 33333
  13523. 22222 44444
  13524. 11111 33333
  13525. 22222 44444
  13526. 11111 33333
  13527. 22222 44444
  13528. 11111 33333
  13529. 22222 44444
  13530. @end example
  13531. @item drop_even, 1
  13532. Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13533. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13534. @example
  13535. ------> time
  13536. Input:
  13537. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13538. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13539. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13540. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13541. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13542. Output:
  13543. 11111 33333
  13544. 11111 33333
  13545. 11111 33333
  13546. 11111 33333
  13547. @end example
  13548. @item drop_odd, 2
  13549. Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13550. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13551. @example
  13552. ------> time
  13553. Input:
  13554. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13555. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13556. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13557. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13558. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13559. Output:
  13560. 22222 44444
  13561. 22222 44444
  13562. 22222 44444
  13563. 22222 44444
  13564. @end example
  13565. @item pad, 3
  13566. Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
  13567. generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
  13568. @example
  13569. ------> time
  13570. Input:
  13571. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13572. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13573. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13574. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13575. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13576. Output:
  13577. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13578. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13579. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13580. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13581. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13582. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13583. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13584. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13585. @end example
  13586. @item interleave_top, 4
  13587. Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
  13588. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13589. @example
  13590. ------> time
  13591. Input:
  13592. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13593. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13594. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13595. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13596. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13597. Output:
  13598. 11111 33333
  13599. 22222 44444
  13600. 11111 33333
  13601. 22222 44444
  13602. @end example
  13603. @item interleave_bottom, 5
  13604. Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
  13605. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13606. @example
  13607. ------> time
  13608. Input:
  13609. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13610. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13611. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13612. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13613. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13614. Output:
  13615. 22222 44444
  13616. 11111 33333
  13617. 22222 44444
  13618. 11111 33333
  13619. @end example
  13620. @item interlacex2, 6
  13621. Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
  13622. containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
  13623. the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
  13624. the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
  13625. field synchronisation.
  13626. @example
  13627. ------> time
  13628. Input:
  13629. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13630. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13631. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13632. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13633. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13634. Output:
  13635. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13636. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13637. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13638. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13639. @end example
  13640. @item mergex2, 7
  13641. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13642. generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
  13643. @example
  13644. ------> time
  13645. Input:
  13646. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13647. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13648. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13649. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13650. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13651. Output:
  13652. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13653. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13654. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13655. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13656. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13657. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13658. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13659. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13660. @end example
  13661. @end table
  13662. Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
  13663. compatibility reasons.
  13664. Default mode is @code{merge}.
  13665. @item flags
  13666. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  13667. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  13668. @table @option
  13669. @item low_pass_filter, vlpf
  13670. Enable linear vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
  13671. Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
  13672. destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
  13673. vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13674. patterning.
  13675. @item complex_filter, cvlpf
  13676. Enable complex vertical low-pass filtering.
  13677. This will slightly less reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13678. patterning but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  13679. @end table
  13680. Vertical low-pass filtering can only be enabled for @option{mode}
  13681. @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
  13682. @end table
  13683. @section tmix
  13684. Mix successive video frames.
  13685. A description of the accepted options follows.
  13686. @table @option
  13687. @item frames
  13688. The number of successive frames to mix. If unspecified, it defaults to 3.
  13689. @item weights
  13690. Specify weight of each input video frame.
  13691. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights is smaller than
  13692. number of @var{frames} last specified weight will be used for all remaining
  13693. unset weights.
  13694. @item scale
  13695. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  13696. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  13697. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  13698. @end table
  13699. @subsection Examples
  13700. @itemize
  13701. @item
  13702. Average 7 successive frames:
  13703. @example
  13704. tmix=frames=7:weights="1 1 1 1 1 1 1"
  13705. @end example
  13706. @item
  13707. Apply simple temporal convolution:
  13708. @example
  13709. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 3 -1"
  13710. @end example
  13711. @item
  13712. Similar as above but only showing temporal differences:
  13713. @example
  13714. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 2 -1":scale=1
  13715. @end example
  13716. @end itemize
  13717. @anchor{tonemap}
  13718. @section tonemap
  13719. Tone map colors from different dynamic ranges.
  13720. This filter expects data in single precision floating point, as it needs to
  13721. operate on (and can output) out-of-range values. Another filter, such as
  13722. @ref{zscale}, is needed to convert the resulting frame to a usable format.
  13723. The tonemapping algorithms implemented only work on linear light, so input
  13724. data should be linearized beforehand (and possibly correctly tagged).
  13725. @example
  13726. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf zscale=transfer=linear,tonemap=clip,zscale=transfer=bt709,format=yuv420p OUTPUT
  13727. @end example
  13728. @subsection Options
  13729. The filter accepts the following options.
  13730. @table @option
  13731. @item tonemap
  13732. Set the tone map algorithm to use.
  13733. Possible values are:
  13734. @table @var
  13735. @item none
  13736. Do not apply any tone map, only desaturate overbright pixels.
  13737. @item clip
  13738. Hard-clip any out-of-range values. Use it for perfect color accuracy for
  13739. in-range values, while distorting out-of-range values.
  13740. @item linear
  13741. Stretch the entire reference gamut to a linear multiple of the display.
  13742. @item gamma
  13743. Fit a logarithmic transfer between the tone curves.
  13744. @item reinhard
  13745. Preserve overall image brightness with a simple curve, using nonlinear
  13746. contrast, which results in flattening details and degrading color accuracy.
  13747. @item hable
  13748. Preserve both dark and bright details better than @var{reinhard}, at the cost
  13749. of slightly darkening everything. Use it when detail preservation is more
  13750. important than color and brightness accuracy.
  13751. @item mobius
  13752. Smoothly map out-of-range values, while retaining contrast and colors for
  13753. in-range material as much as possible. Use it when color accuracy is more
  13754. important than detail preservation.
  13755. @end table
  13756. Default is none.
  13757. @item param
  13758. Tune the tone mapping algorithm.
  13759. This affects the following algorithms:
  13760. @table @var
  13761. @item none
  13762. Ignored.
  13763. @item linear
  13764. Specifies the scale factor to use while stretching.
  13765. Default to 1.0.
  13766. @item gamma
  13767. Specifies the exponent of the function.
  13768. Default to 1.8.
  13769. @item clip
  13770. Specify an extra linear coefficient to multiply into the signal before clipping.
  13771. Default to 1.0.
  13772. @item reinhard
  13773. Specify the local contrast coefficient at the display peak.
  13774. Default to 0.5, which means that in-gamut values will be about half as bright
  13775. as when clipping.
  13776. @item hable
  13777. Ignored.
  13778. @item mobius
  13779. Specify the transition point from linear to mobius transform. Every value
  13780. below this point is guaranteed to be mapped 1:1. The higher the value, the
  13781. more accurate the result will be, at the cost of losing bright details.
  13782. Default to 0.3, which due to the steep initial slope still preserves in-range
  13783. colors fairly accurately.
  13784. @end table
  13785. @item desat
  13786. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  13787. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  13788. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  13789. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  13790. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  13791. The default of 2.0 is somewhat conservative and will mostly just apply to
  13792. skies or directly sunlit surfaces. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  13793. This option works only if the input frame has a supported color tag.
  13794. @item peak
  13795. Override signal/nominal/reference peak with this value. Useful when the
  13796. embedded peak information in display metadata is not reliable or when tone
  13797. mapping from a lower range to a higher range.
  13798. @end table
  13799. @section tpad
  13800. Temporarily pad video frames.
  13801. The filter accepts the following options:
  13802. @table @option
  13803. @item start
  13804. Specify number of delay frames before input video stream.
  13805. @item stop
  13806. Specify number of padding frames after input video stream.
  13807. Set to -1 to pad indefinitely.
  13808. @item start_mode
  13809. Set kind of frames added to beginning of stream.
  13810. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  13811. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  13812. With @var{clone} frames are clones of first frame.
  13813. @item stop_mode
  13814. Set kind of frames added to end of stream.
  13815. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  13816. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  13817. With @var{clone} frames are clones of last frame.
  13818. @item start_duration, stop_duration
  13819. Specify the duration of the start/stop delay. See
  13820. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  13821. for the accepted syntax.
  13822. These options override @var{start} and @var{stop}.
  13823. @item color
  13824. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  13825. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  13826. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13827. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  13828. @end table
  13829. @anchor{transpose}
  13830. @section transpose
  13831. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  13832. It accepts the following parameters:
  13833. @table @option
  13834. @item dir
  13835. Specify the transposition direction.
  13836. Can assume the following values:
  13837. @table @samp
  13838. @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
  13839. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
  13840. @example
  13841. L.R L.l
  13842. . . -> . .
  13843. l.r R.r
  13844. @end example
  13845. @item 1, 5, clock
  13846. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
  13847. @example
  13848. L.R l.L
  13849. . . -> . .
  13850. l.r r.R
  13851. @end example
  13852. @item 2, 6, cclock
  13853. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
  13854. @example
  13855. L.R R.r
  13856. . . -> . .
  13857. l.r L.l
  13858. @end example
  13859. @item 3, 7, clock_flip
  13860. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
  13861. @example
  13862. L.R r.R
  13863. . . -> . .
  13864. l.r l.L
  13865. @end example
  13866. @end table
  13867. For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
  13868. video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
  13869. deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
  13870. Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
  13871. symbolic constants.
  13872. @item passthrough
  13873. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  13874. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  13875. @table @samp
  13876. @item none
  13877. Always apply transposition.
  13878. @item portrait
  13879. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  13880. @item landscape
  13881. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  13882. @end table
  13883. Default value is @code{none}.
  13884. @end table
  13885. For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
  13886. layout:
  13887. @example
  13888. transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
  13889. @end example
  13890. The command above can also be specified as:
  13891. @example
  13892. transpose=1:portrait
  13893. @end example
  13894. @section transpose_npp
  13895. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  13896. For more in depth examples see the @ref{transpose} video filter, which shares mostly the same options.
  13897. It accepts the following parameters:
  13898. @table @option
  13899. @item dir
  13900. Specify the transposition direction.
  13901. Can assume the following values:
  13902. @table @samp
  13903. @item cclock_flip
  13904. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip. (default)
  13905. @item clock
  13906. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise.
  13907. @item cclock
  13908. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise.
  13909. @item clock_flip
  13910. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip.
  13911. @end table
  13912. @item passthrough
  13913. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  13914. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  13915. @table @samp
  13916. @item none
  13917. Always apply transposition. (default)
  13918. @item portrait
  13919. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  13920. @item landscape
  13921. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  13922. @end table
  13923. @end table
  13924. @section trim
  13925. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  13926. It accepts the following parameters:
  13927. @table @option
  13928. @item start
  13929. Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
  13930. timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
  13931. @item end
  13932. Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
  13933. immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
  13934. frame in the output.
  13935. @item start_pts
  13936. This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
  13937. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  13938. @item end_pts
  13939. This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
  13940. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  13941. @item duration
  13942. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  13943. @item start_frame
  13944. The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
  13945. @item end_frame
  13946. The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
  13947. @end table
  13948. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  13949. duration specifications; see
  13950. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  13951. for the accepted syntax.
  13952. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  13953. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
  13954. frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
  13955. the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
  13956. setpts filter after the trim filter.
  13957. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  13958. keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  13959. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
  13960. filters.
  13961. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  13962. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  13963. Examples:
  13964. @itemize
  13965. @item
  13966. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  13967. @example
  13968. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
  13969. @end example
  13970. @item
  13971. Keep only the first second:
  13972. @example
  13973. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
  13974. @end example
  13975. @end itemize
  13976. @section unpremultiply
  13977. Apply alpha unpremultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  13978. of second stream as alpha.
  13979. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  13980. The filter accepts the following option:
  13981. @table @option
  13982. @item planes
  13983. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13984. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13985. If the format has 1 or 2 components, then luma is bit 0.
  13986. If the format has 3 or 4 components:
  13987. for RGB formats bit 0 is green, bit 1 is blue and bit 2 is red;
  13988. for YUV formats bit 0 is luma, bit 1 is chroma-U and bit 2 is chroma-V.
  13989. If present, the alpha channel is always the last bit.
  13990. @item inplace
  13991. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  13992. @end table
  13993. @anchor{unsharp}
  13994. @section unsharp
  13995. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  13996. It accepts the following parameters:
  13997. @table @option
  13998. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  13999. Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
  14000. 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14001. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  14002. Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
  14003. and 23. The default value is 5.
  14004. @item luma_amount, la
  14005. Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14006. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14007. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14008. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14009. Default value is 1.0.
  14010. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  14011. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
  14012. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14013. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  14014. Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
  14015. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14016. @item chroma_amount, ca
  14017. Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14018. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14019. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14020. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14021. Default value is 0.0.
  14022. @end table
  14023. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  14024. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  14025. @subsection Examples
  14026. @itemize
  14027. @item
  14028. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  14029. @example
  14030. unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
  14031. @end example
  14032. @item
  14033. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  14034. @example
  14035. unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
  14036. @end example
  14037. @end itemize
  14038. @section uspp
  14039. Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
  14040. the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
  14041. shifts and average the results.
  14042. The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
  14043. decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
  14044. DCT similar to MJPEG.
  14045. The filter accepts the following options:
  14046. @table @option
  14047. @item quality
  14048. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  14049. an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  14050. effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  14051. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  14052. @code{3}.
  14053. @item qp
  14054. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  14055. from the video stream (if available).
  14056. @end table
  14057. @section v360
  14058. Convert 360 videos between various formats.
  14059. The filter accepts the following options:
  14060. @table @option
  14061. @item input
  14062. @item output
  14063. Set format of the input/output video.
  14064. Available formats:
  14065. @table @samp
  14066. @item e
  14067. @item equirect
  14068. Equirectangular projection.
  14069. @item c3x2
  14070. @item c6x1
  14071. @item c1x6
  14072. Cubemap with 3x2/6x1/1x6 layout.
  14073. Format specific options:
  14074. @table @option
  14075. @item in_pad
  14076. @item out_pad
  14077. Set padding proportion for the input/output cubemap. Values in decimals.
  14078. Example values:
  14079. @table @samp
  14080. @item 0
  14081. No padding.
  14082. @item 0.01
  14083. 1% of face is padding. For example, with 1920x1280 resolution face size would be 640x640 and padding would be 3 pixels from each side. (640 * 0.01 = 6 pixels)
  14084. @end table
  14085. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  14086. @item fin_pad
  14087. @item fout_pad
  14088. Set fixed padding for the input/output cubemap. Values in pixels.
  14089. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}. If greater than zero it overrides other padding options.
  14090. @item in_forder
  14091. @item out_forder
  14092. Set order of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one direction for each position.
  14093. Designation of directions:
  14094. @table @samp
  14095. @item r
  14096. right
  14097. @item l
  14098. left
  14099. @item u
  14100. up
  14101. @item d
  14102. down
  14103. @item f
  14104. forward
  14105. @item b
  14106. back
  14107. @end table
  14108. Default value is @b{@samp{rludfb}}.
  14109. @item in_frot
  14110. @item out_frot
  14111. Set rotation of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one angle for each position.
  14112. Designation of angles:
  14113. @table @samp
  14114. @item 0
  14115. 0 degrees clockwise
  14116. @item 1
  14117. 90 degrees clockwise
  14118. @item 2
  14119. 180 degrees clockwise
  14120. @item 3
  14121. 270 degrees clockwise
  14122. @end table
  14123. Default value is @b{@samp{000000}}.
  14124. @end table
  14125. @item eac
  14126. Equi-Angular Cubemap.
  14127. @item flat
  14128. @item gnomonic
  14129. @item rectilinear
  14130. Regular video. @i{(output only)}
  14131. Format specific options:
  14132. @table @option
  14133. @item h_fov
  14134. @item v_fov
  14135. @item d_fov
  14136. Set horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14137. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14138. @end table
  14139. @item dfisheye
  14140. Dual fisheye.
  14141. Format specific options:
  14142. @table @option
  14143. @item in_pad
  14144. @item out_pad
  14145. Set padding proportion. Values in decimals.
  14146. Example values:
  14147. @table @samp
  14148. @item 0
  14149. No padding.
  14150. @item 0.01
  14151. 1% padding.
  14152. @end table
  14153. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  14154. @end table
  14155. @item barrel
  14156. @item fb
  14157. Facebook's 360 format.
  14158. @item sg
  14159. Stereographic format.
  14160. Format specific options:
  14161. @table @option
  14162. @item h_fov
  14163. @item v_fov
  14164. @item d_fov
  14165. Set horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14166. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14167. @end table
  14168. @item mercator
  14169. Mercator format.
  14170. @item ball
  14171. Ball format, gives significant distortion toward the back.
  14172. @item hammer
  14173. Hammer-Aitoff map projection format.
  14174. @item sinusoidal
  14175. Sinusoidal map projection format.
  14176. @end table
  14177. @item interp
  14178. Set interpolation method.@*
  14179. @i{Note: more complex interpolation methods require much more memory to run.}
  14180. Available methods:
  14181. @table @samp
  14182. @item near
  14183. @item nearest
  14184. Nearest neighbour.
  14185. @item line
  14186. @item linear
  14187. Bilinear interpolation.
  14188. @item cube
  14189. @item cubic
  14190. Bicubic interpolation.
  14191. @item lanc
  14192. @item lanczos
  14193. Lanczos interpolation.
  14194. @end table
  14195. Default value is @b{@samp{line}}.
  14196. @item w
  14197. @item h
  14198. Set the output video resolution.
  14199. Default resolution depends on formats.
  14200. @item in_stereo
  14201. @item out_stereo
  14202. Set the input/output stereo format.
  14203. @table @samp
  14204. @item 2d
  14205. 2D mono
  14206. @item sbs
  14207. Side by side
  14208. @item tb
  14209. Top bottom
  14210. @end table
  14211. Default value is @b{@samp{2d}} for input and output format.
  14212. @item yaw
  14213. @item pitch
  14214. @item roll
  14215. Set rotation for the output video. Values in degrees.
  14216. @item rorder
  14217. Set rotation order for the output video. Choose one item for each position.
  14218. @table @samp
  14219. @item y, Y
  14220. yaw
  14221. @item p, P
  14222. pitch
  14223. @item r, R
  14224. roll
  14225. @end table
  14226. Default value is @b{@samp{ypr}}.
  14227. @item h_flip
  14228. @item v_flip
  14229. @item d_flip
  14230. Flip the output video horizontally(swaps left-right)/vertically(swaps up-down)/in-depth(swaps back-forward). Boolean values.
  14231. @item ih_flip
  14232. @item iv_flip
  14233. Set if input video is flipped horizontally/vertically. Boolean values.
  14234. @item in_trans
  14235. Set if input video is transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14236. @item out_trans
  14237. Set if output video needs to be transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14238. @end table
  14239. @subsection Examples
  14240. @itemize
  14241. @item
  14242. Convert equirectangular video to cubemap with 3x2 layout and 1% padding using bicubic interpolation:
  14243. @example
  14244. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=e:c3x2:cubic:out_pad=0.01 output.mkv
  14245. @end example
  14246. @item
  14247. Extract back view of Equi-Angular Cubemap:
  14248. @example
  14249. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=eac:flat:yaw=180 output.mkv
  14250. @end example
  14251. @item
  14252. Convert transposed and horizontally flipped Equi-Angular Cubemap in side-by-side stereo format to equirectangular top-bottom stereo format:
  14253. @example
  14254. v360=eac:equirect:in_stereo=sbs:in_trans=1:ih_flip=1:out_stereo=tb
  14255. @end example
  14256. @end itemize
  14257. @section vaguedenoiser
  14258. Apply a wavelet based denoiser.
  14259. It transforms each frame from the video input into the wavelet domain,
  14260. using Cohen-Daubechies-Feauveau 9/7. Then it applies some filtering to
  14261. the obtained coefficients. It does an inverse wavelet transform after.
  14262. Due to wavelet properties, it should give a nice smoothed result, and
  14263. reduced noise, without blurring picture features.
  14264. This filter accepts the following options:
  14265. @table @option
  14266. @item threshold
  14267. The filtering strength. The higher, the more filtered the video will be.
  14268. Hard thresholding can use a higher threshold than soft thresholding
  14269. before the video looks overfiltered. Default value is 2.
  14270. @item method
  14271. The filtering method the filter will use.
  14272. It accepts the following values:
  14273. @table @samp
  14274. @item hard
  14275. All values under the threshold will be zeroed.
  14276. @item soft
  14277. All values under the threshold will be zeroed. All values above will be
  14278. reduced by the threshold.
  14279. @item garrote
  14280. Scales or nullifies coefficients - intermediary between (more) soft and
  14281. (less) hard thresholding.
  14282. @end table
  14283. Default is garrote.
  14284. @item nsteps
  14285. Number of times, the wavelet will decompose the picture. Picture can't
  14286. be decomposed beyond a particular point (typically, 8 for a 640x480
  14287. frame - as 2^9 = 512 > 480). Valid values are integers between 1 and 32. Default value is 6.
  14288. @item percent
  14289. Partial of full denoising (limited coefficients shrinking), from 0 to 100. Default value is 85.
  14290. @item planes
  14291. A list of the planes to process. By default all planes are processed.
  14292. @end table
  14293. @section vectorscope
  14294. Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
  14295. a vectorscope).
  14296. This filter accepts the following options:
  14297. @table @option
  14298. @item mode, m
  14299. Set vectorscope mode.
  14300. It accepts the following values:
  14301. @table @samp
  14302. @item gray
  14303. Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
  14304. same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
  14305. @item color
  14306. Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
  14307. present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
  14308. set by option @code{x} and @code{y}. The 3rd color component is static.
  14309. @item color2
  14310. Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
  14311. @item color3
  14312. Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
  14313. on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
  14314. default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
  14315. @item color4
  14316. Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
  14317. colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
  14318. not present in graph is picked.
  14319. @item color5
  14320. Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to @code{color} but with 3rd color
  14321. component picked from radial gradient.
  14322. @end table
  14323. @item x
  14324. Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
  14325. @item y
  14326. Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
  14327. @item intensity, i
  14328. Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness
  14329. of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
  14330. @item envelope, e
  14331. @table @samp
  14332. @item none
  14333. No envelope, this is default.
  14334. @item instant
  14335. Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
  14336. @item peak
  14337. Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
  14338. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
  14339. @item peak+instant
  14340. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  14341. @end table
  14342. @item graticule, g
  14343. Set what kind of graticule to draw.
  14344. @table @samp
  14345. @item none
  14346. @item green
  14347. @item color
  14348. @end table
  14349. @item opacity, o
  14350. Set graticule opacity.
  14351. @item flags, f
  14352. Set graticule flags.
  14353. @table @samp
  14354. @item white
  14355. Draw graticule for white point.
  14356. @item black
  14357. Draw graticule for black point.
  14358. @item name
  14359. Draw color points short names.
  14360. @end table
  14361. @item bgopacity, b
  14362. Set background opacity.
  14363. @item lthreshold, l
  14364. Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14365. Values lower than this value will be ignored. Default is 0.
  14366. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14367. can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold
  14368. is 0.1 * 255 = 25.
  14369. @item hthreshold, h
  14370. Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14371. Values higher than this value will be ignored. Default is 1.
  14372. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14373. can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold
  14374. is 0.9 * 255 = 230.
  14375. @item colorspace, c
  14376. Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.
  14377. @table @samp
  14378. @item auto
  14379. @item 601
  14380. @item 709
  14381. @end table
  14382. Default is auto.
  14383. @end table
  14384. @anchor{vidstabdetect}
  14385. @section vidstabdetect
  14386. Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
  14387. @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
  14388. This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
  14389. transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
  14390. the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
  14391. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14392. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14393. This filter accepts the following options:
  14394. @table @option
  14395. @item result
  14396. Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
  14397. Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
  14398. @item shakiness
  14399. Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
  14400. integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
  14401. value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
  14402. @item accuracy
  14403. Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
  14404. range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
  14405. accuracy. Default value is 15.
  14406. @item stepsize
  14407. Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
  14408. scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
  14409. @item mincontrast
  14410. Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
  14411. discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
  14412. value is 0.3.
  14413. @item tripod
  14414. Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
  14415. If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
  14416. in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
  14417. is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
  14418. the camera view absolutely still.
  14419. If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
  14420. @item show
  14421. Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
  14422. integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
  14423. visualization.
  14424. @end table
  14425. @subsection Examples
  14426. @itemize
  14427. @item
  14428. Use default values:
  14429. @example
  14430. vidstabdetect
  14431. @end example
  14432. @item
  14433. Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
  14434. @file{mytransforms.trf}:
  14435. @example
  14436. vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
  14437. @end example
  14438. @item
  14439. Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
  14440. video:
  14441. @example
  14442. vidstabdetect=show=1
  14443. @end example
  14444. @item
  14445. Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
  14446. @example
  14447. ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
  14448. @end example
  14449. @end itemize
  14450. @anchor{vidstabtransform}
  14451. @section vidstabtransform
  14452. Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
  14453. see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
  14454. Read a file with transform information for each frame and
  14455. apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
  14456. filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
  14457. @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
  14458. the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
  14459. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14460. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14461. @subsection Options
  14462. @table @option
  14463. @item input
  14464. Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
  14465. @file{transforms.trf}.
  14466. @item smoothing
  14467. Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
  14468. camera movements. Default value is 10.
  14469. For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
  14470. past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
  14471. larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
  14472. the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
  14473. camera is simulated.
  14474. @item optalgo
  14475. Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
  14476. Accepted values are:
  14477. @table @samp
  14478. @item gauss
  14479. gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
  14480. @item avg
  14481. averaging on transformations
  14482. @end table
  14483. @item maxshift
  14484. Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
  14485. meaning no limit.
  14486. @item maxangle
  14487. Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
  14488. value is -1, meaning no limit.
  14489. @item crop
  14490. Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
  14491. compensation.
  14492. Available values are:
  14493. @table @samp
  14494. @item keep
  14495. keep image information from previous frame (default)
  14496. @item black
  14497. fill the border black
  14498. @end table
  14499. @item invert
  14500. Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
  14501. @item relative
  14502. Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
  14503. absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
  14504. @item zoom
  14505. Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
  14506. effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
  14507. zoom).
  14508. @item optzoom
  14509. Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
  14510. Accepted values are:
  14511. @table @samp
  14512. @item 0
  14513. disabled
  14514. @item 1
  14515. optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
  14516. will lead to visible borders) (default)
  14517. @item 2
  14518. optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
  14519. visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
  14520. @end table
  14521. Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
  14522. @item zoomspeed
  14523. Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
  14524. @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
  14525. 0.25.
  14526. @item interpol
  14527. Specify type of interpolation.
  14528. Available values are:
  14529. @table @samp
  14530. @item no
  14531. no interpolation
  14532. @item linear
  14533. linear only horizontal
  14534. @item bilinear
  14535. linear in both directions (default)
  14536. @item bicubic
  14537. cubic in both directions (slow)
  14538. @end table
  14539. @item tripod
  14540. Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
  14541. @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
  14542. Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
  14543. @item debug
  14544. Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
  14545. are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
  14546. value is 0.
  14547. @end table
  14548. @subsection Examples
  14549. @itemize
  14550. @item
  14551. Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
  14552. @example
  14553. ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
  14554. @end example
  14555. Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
  14556. @item
  14557. Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
  14558. @example
  14559. vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
  14560. @end example
  14561. @item
  14562. Smoothen the video even more:
  14563. @example
  14564. vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
  14565. @end example
  14566. @end itemize
  14567. @section vflip
  14568. Flip the input video vertically.
  14569. For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  14570. @example
  14571. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
  14572. @end example
  14573. @section vfrdet
  14574. Detect variable frame rate video.
  14575. This filter tries to detect if the input is variable or constant frame rate.
  14576. At end it will output number of frames detected as having variable delta pts,
  14577. and ones with constant delta pts.
  14578. If there was frames with variable delta, than it will also show min, max and
  14579. average delta encountered.
  14580. @section vibrance
  14581. Boost or alter saturation.
  14582. The filter accepts the following options:
  14583. @table @option
  14584. @item intensity
  14585. Set strength of boost if positive value or strength of alter if negative value.
  14586. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -2 to 2.
  14587. @item rbal
  14588. Set the red balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14589. @item gbal
  14590. Set the green balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14591. @item bbal
  14592. Set the blue balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14593. @item rlum
  14594. Set the red luma coefficient.
  14595. @item glum
  14596. Set the green luma coefficient.
  14597. @item blum
  14598. Set the blue luma coefficient.
  14599. @item alternate
  14600. If @code{intensity} is negative and this is set to 1, colors will change,
  14601. otherwise colors will be less saturated, more towards gray.
  14602. @end table
  14603. @anchor{vignette}
  14604. @section vignette
  14605. Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
  14606. The filter accepts the following options:
  14607. @table @option
  14608. @item angle, a
  14609. Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
  14610. The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
  14611. Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
  14612. @item x0
  14613. @item y0
  14614. Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
  14615. by default.
  14616. @item mode
  14617. Set forward/backward mode.
  14618. Available modes are:
  14619. @table @samp
  14620. @item forward
  14621. The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
  14622. @item backward
  14623. The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
  14624. This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
  14625. detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
  14626. also be used to create a burning effect.
  14627. @end table
  14628. Default value is @samp{forward}.
  14629. @item eval
  14630. Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
  14631. It accepts the following values:
  14632. @table @samp
  14633. @item init
  14634. Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
  14635. @item frame
  14636. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
  14637. @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
  14638. allows advanced dynamic expressions.
  14639. @end table
  14640. Default value is @samp{init}.
  14641. @item dither
  14642. Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
  14643. (enabled).
  14644. @item aspect
  14645. Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
  14646. Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
  14647. following the dimensions of the video.
  14648. Default is @code{1/1}.
  14649. @end table
  14650. @subsection Expressions
  14651. The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
  14652. following parameters.
  14653. @table @option
  14654. @item w
  14655. @item h
  14656. input width and height
  14657. @item n
  14658. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  14659. @item pts
  14660. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
  14661. @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
  14662. @item r
  14663. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  14664. @item t
  14665. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  14666. expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
  14667. @item tb
  14668. time base of the input video
  14669. @end table
  14670. @subsection Examples
  14671. @itemize
  14672. @item
  14673. Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
  14674. @example
  14675. vignette=PI/4
  14676. @end example
  14677. @item
  14678. Make a flickering vignetting:
  14679. @example
  14680. vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
  14681. @end example
  14682. @end itemize
  14683. @section vmafmotion
  14684. Obtain the average vmaf motion score of a video.
  14685. It is one of the component filters of VMAF.
  14686. The obtained average motion score is printed through the logging system.
  14687. In the below example the input file @file{ref.mpg} is being processed and score
  14688. is computed.
  14689. @example
  14690. ffmpeg -i ref.mpg -lavfi vmafmotion -f null -
  14691. @end example
  14692. @section vstack
  14693. Stack input videos vertically.
  14694. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
  14695. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  14696. to create same output.
  14697. The filter accepts the following options:
  14698. @table @option
  14699. @item inputs
  14700. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  14701. @item shortest
  14702. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  14703. terminates. Default value is 0.
  14704. @end table
  14705. @section w3fdif
  14706. Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
  14707. Deinterlacing Filter").
  14708. Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
  14709. implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
  14710. Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
  14711. uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
  14712. This filter uses field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  14713. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  14714. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{w3fdif} filter.
  14715. There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple"
  14716. and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
  14717. be set by passing an optional parameter:
  14718. @table @option
  14719. @item filter
  14720. Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
  14721. @table @samp
  14722. @item simple
  14723. Simple filter coefficient set.
  14724. @item complex
  14725. More-complex filter coefficient set.
  14726. @end table
  14727. Default value is @samp{complex}.
  14728. @item deint
  14729. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:
  14730. @table @samp
  14731. @item all
  14732. Deinterlace all frames,
  14733. @item interlaced
  14734. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  14735. @end table
  14736. Default value is @samp{all}.
  14737. @end table
  14738. @section waveform
  14739. Video waveform monitor.
  14740. The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
  14741. only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
  14742. source video.
  14743. It accepts the following options:
  14744. @table @option
  14745. @item mode, m
  14746. Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
  14747. In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
  14748. the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
  14749. color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
  14750. @item intensity, i
  14751. Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
  14752. luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
  14753. Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
  14754. @item mirror, r
  14755. Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
  14756. In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
  14757. side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
  14758. @code{1} (mirrored).
  14759. @item display, d
  14760. Set display mode.
  14761. It accepts the following values:
  14762. @table @samp
  14763. @item overlay
  14764. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  14765. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  14766. over one another.
  14767. This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
  14768. in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
  14769. such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
  14770. @item stack
  14771. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  14772. @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
  14773. @item parade
  14774. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  14775. @code{column} mode or one below the other in @code{row} mode.
  14776. Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
  14777. and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
  14778. graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
  14779. by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
  14780. should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
  14781. correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
  14782. @end table
  14783. Default is @code{stack}.
  14784. @item components, c
  14785. Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
  14786. or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
  14787. 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
  14788. @item envelope, e
  14789. @table @samp
  14790. @item none
  14791. No envelope, this is default.
  14792. @item instant
  14793. Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
  14794. visible even with small @code{step} value.
  14795. @item peak
  14796. Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
  14797. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
  14798. @item peak+instant
  14799. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  14800. @end table
  14801. @item filter, f
  14802. @table @samp
  14803. @item lowpass
  14804. No filtering, this is default.
  14805. @item flat
  14806. Luma and chroma combined together.
  14807. @item aflat
  14808. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  14809. @item xflat
  14810. Similar as above, but use different colors.
  14811. @item yflat
  14812. Similar as above, but again with different colors.
  14813. @item chroma
  14814. Displays only chroma.
  14815. @item color
  14816. Displays actual color value on waveform.
  14817. @item acolor
  14818. Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.
  14819. @end table
  14820. @item graticule, g
  14821. Set which graticule to display.
  14822. @table @samp
  14823. @item none
  14824. Do not display graticule.
  14825. @item green
  14826. Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  14827. @item orange
  14828. Display orange graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  14829. @item invert
  14830. Display invert graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  14831. @end table
  14832. @item opacity, o
  14833. Set graticule opacity.
  14834. @item flags, fl
  14835. Set graticule flags.
  14836. @table @samp
  14837. @item numbers
  14838. Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.
  14839. @item dots
  14840. Draw dots instead of lines.
  14841. @end table
  14842. @item scale, s
  14843. Set scale used for displaying graticule.
  14844. @table @samp
  14845. @item digital
  14846. @item millivolts
  14847. @item ire
  14848. @end table
  14849. Default is digital.
  14850. @item bgopacity, b
  14851. Set background opacity.
  14852. @end table
  14853. @section weave, doubleweave
  14854. The @code{weave} takes a field-based video input and join
  14855. each two sequential fields into single frame, producing a new double
  14856. height clip with half the frame rate and half the frame count.
  14857. The @code{doubleweave} works same as @code{weave} but without
  14858. halving frame rate and frame count.
  14859. It accepts the following option:
  14860. @table @option
  14861. @item first_field
  14862. Set first field. Available values are:
  14863. @table @samp
  14864. @item top, t
  14865. Set the frame as top-field-first.
  14866. @item bottom, b
  14867. Set the frame as bottom-field-first.
  14868. @end table
  14869. @end table
  14870. @subsection Examples
  14871. @itemize
  14872. @item
  14873. Interlace video using @ref{select} and @ref{separatefields} filter:
  14874. @example
  14875. separatefields,select=eq(mod(n,4),0)+eq(mod(n,4),3),weave
  14876. @end example
  14877. @end itemize
  14878. @section xbr
  14879. Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
  14880. art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
  14881. @url{https://forums.libretro.com/t/xbr-algorithm-tutorial/123}.
  14882. It accepts the following option:
  14883. @table @option
  14884. @item n
  14885. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
  14886. @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
  14887. Default is @code{3}.
  14888. @end table
  14889. @section xmedian
  14890. Pick median pixels from several input videos.
  14891. The filter accepts the following options:
  14892. @table @option
  14893. @item inputs
  14894. Set number of inputs.
  14895. Default is 3. Allowed range is from 3 to 255.
  14896. If number of inputs is even number, than result will be mean value between two median values.
  14897. @item planes
  14898. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{15}, by which all planes are processed.
  14899. @end table
  14900. @section xstack
  14901. Stack video inputs into custom layout.
  14902. All streams must be of same pixel format.
  14903. The filter accepts the following options:
  14904. @table @option
  14905. @item inputs
  14906. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  14907. @item layout
  14908. Specify layout of inputs.
  14909. This option requires the desired layout configuration to be explicitly set by the user.
  14910. This sets position of each video input in output. Each input
  14911. is separated by '|'.
  14912. The first number represents the column, and the second number represents the row.
  14913. Numbers start at 0 and are separated by '_'. Optionally one can use wX and hX,
  14914. where X is video input from which to take width or height.
  14915. Multiple values can be used when separated by '+'. In such
  14916. case values are summed together.
  14917. Note that if inputs are of different sizes gaps may appear, as not all of
  14918. the output video frame will be filled. Similarly, videos can overlap each
  14919. other if their position doesn't leave enough space for the full frame of
  14920. adjoining videos.
  14921. For 2 inputs, a default layout of @code{0_0|w0_0} is set. In all other cases,
  14922. a layout must be set by the user.
  14923. @item shortest
  14924. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  14925. terminates. Default value is 0.
  14926. @end table
  14927. @subsection Examples
  14928. @itemize
  14929. @item
  14930. Display 4 inputs into 2x2 grid.
  14931. Layout:
  14932. @example
  14933. input1(0, 0) | input3(w0, 0)
  14934. input2(0, h0) | input4(w0, h0)
  14935. @end example
  14936. @example
  14937. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|w0_0|w0_h0
  14938. @end example
  14939. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  14940. @item
  14941. Display 4 inputs into 1x4 grid.
  14942. Layout:
  14943. @example
  14944. input1(0, 0)
  14945. input2(0, h0)
  14946. input3(0, h0+h1)
  14947. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)
  14948. @end example
  14949. @example
  14950. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2
  14951. @end example
  14952. Note that if inputs are of different widths, unused space will appear.
  14953. @item
  14954. Display 9 inputs into 3x3 grid.
  14955. Layout:
  14956. @example
  14957. input1(0, 0) | input4(w0, 0) | input7(w0+w3, 0)
  14958. input2(0, h0) | input5(w0, h0) | input8(w0+w3, h0)
  14959. input3(0, h0+h1) | input6(w0, h0+h1) | input9(w0+w3, h0+h1)
  14960. @end example
  14961. @example
  14962. xstack=inputs=9:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0+w3_0|w0+w3_h0|w0+w3_h0+h1
  14963. @end example
  14964. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  14965. @item
  14966. Display 16 inputs into 4x4 grid.
  14967. Layout:
  14968. @example
  14969. input1(0, 0) | input5(w0, 0) | input9 (w0+w4, 0) | input13(w0+w4+w8, 0)
  14970. input2(0, h0) | input6(w0, h0) | input10(w0+w4, h0) | input14(w0+w4+w8, h0)
  14971. input3(0, h0+h1) | input7(w0, h0+h1) | input11(w0+w4, h0+h1) | input15(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1)
  14972. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)| input8(w0, h0+h1+h2)| input12(w0+w4, h0+h1+h2)| input16(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1+h2)
  14973. @end example
  14974. @example
  14975. xstack=inputs=16:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4_0|
  14976. w0+w4_h0|w0+w4_h0+h1|w0+w4_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4+w8_0|w0+w4+w8_h0|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1+h2
  14977. @end example
  14978. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  14979. @end itemize
  14980. @anchor{yadif}
  14981. @section yadif
  14982. Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
  14983. filter").
  14984. It accepts the following parameters:
  14985. @table @option
  14986. @item mode
  14987. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  14988. @table @option
  14989. @item 0, send_frame
  14990. Output one frame for each frame.
  14991. @item 1, send_field
  14992. Output one frame for each field.
  14993. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  14994. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  14995. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  14996. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  14997. @end table
  14998. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  14999. @item parity
  15000. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15001. of the following values:
  15002. @table @option
  15003. @item 0, tff
  15004. Assume the top field is first.
  15005. @item 1, bff
  15006. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15007. @item -1, auto
  15008. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15009. @end table
  15010. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15011. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15012. top field first will be assumed.
  15013. @item deint
  15014. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15015. values:
  15016. @table @option
  15017. @item 0, all
  15018. Deinterlace all frames.
  15019. @item 1, interlaced
  15020. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15021. @end table
  15022. The default value is @code{all}.
  15023. @end table
  15024. @section yadif_cuda
  15025. Deinterlace the input video using the @ref{yadif} algorithm, but implemented
  15026. in CUDA so that it can work as part of a GPU accelerated pipeline with nvdec
  15027. and/or nvenc.
  15028. It accepts the following parameters:
  15029. @table @option
  15030. @item mode
  15031. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15032. @table @option
  15033. @item 0, send_frame
  15034. Output one frame for each frame.
  15035. @item 1, send_field
  15036. Output one frame for each field.
  15037. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15038. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15039. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15040. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15041. @end table
  15042. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15043. @item parity
  15044. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15045. of the following values:
  15046. @table @option
  15047. @item 0, tff
  15048. Assume the top field is first.
  15049. @item 1, bff
  15050. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15051. @item -1, auto
  15052. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15053. @end table
  15054. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15055. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15056. top field first will be assumed.
  15057. @item deint
  15058. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15059. values:
  15060. @table @option
  15061. @item 0, all
  15062. Deinterlace all frames.
  15063. @item 1, interlaced
  15064. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15065. @end table
  15066. The default value is @code{all}.
  15067. @end table
  15068. @section zoompan
  15069. Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
  15070. This filter accepts the following options:
  15071. @table @option
  15072. @item zoom, z
  15073. Set the zoom expression. Range is 1-10. Default is 1.
  15074. @item x
  15075. @item y
  15076. Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
  15077. @item d
  15078. Set the duration expression in number of frames.
  15079. This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
  15080. single input image.
  15081. @item s
  15082. Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
  15083. @item fps
  15084. Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
  15085. @end table
  15086. Each expression can contain the following constants:
  15087. @table @option
  15088. @item in_w, iw
  15089. Input width.
  15090. @item in_h, ih
  15091. Input height.
  15092. @item out_w, ow
  15093. Output width.
  15094. @item out_h, oh
  15095. Output height.
  15096. @item in
  15097. Input frame count.
  15098. @item on
  15099. Output frame count.
  15100. @item x
  15101. @item y
  15102. Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
  15103. for current input frame.
  15104. @item px
  15105. @item py
  15106. 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
  15107. not yet such frame (first input frame).
  15108. @item zoom
  15109. Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
  15110. @item pzoom
  15111. Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
  15112. @item duration
  15113. Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
  15114. for each input frame.
  15115. @item pduration
  15116. number of output frames created for previous input frame
  15117. @item a
  15118. Rational number: input width / input height
  15119. @item sar
  15120. sample aspect ratio
  15121. @item dar
  15122. display aspect ratio
  15123. @end table
  15124. @subsection Examples
  15125. @itemize
  15126. @item
  15127. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
  15128. @example
  15129. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
  15130. @end example
  15131. @item
  15132. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan always at center of picture:
  15133. @example
  15134. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15135. @end example
  15136. @item
  15137. Same as above but without pausing:
  15138. @example
  15139. zoompan=z='min(max(zoom,pzoom)+0.0015,1.5)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15140. @end example
  15141. @end itemize
  15142. @anchor{zscale}
  15143. @section zscale
  15144. Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
  15145. @url{https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg}. To enable compilation of this
  15146. filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzimg}.
  15147. The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  15148. as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  15149. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  15150. the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
  15151. requested format.
  15152. @subsection Options
  15153. The filter accepts the following options.
  15154. @table @option
  15155. @item width, w
  15156. @item height, h
  15157. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  15158. dimension.
  15159. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  15160. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  15161. is used for the output.
  15162. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the zscale filter
  15163. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  15164. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  15165. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  15166. adjust the value if necessary.
  15167. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  15168. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  15169. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  15170. expression.
  15171. @item size, s
  15172. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15173. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15174. @item dither, d
  15175. Set the dither type.
  15176. Possible values are:
  15177. @table @var
  15178. @item none
  15179. @item ordered
  15180. @item random
  15181. @item error_diffusion
  15182. @end table
  15183. Default is none.
  15184. @item filter, f
  15185. Set the resize filter type.
  15186. Possible values are:
  15187. @table @var
  15188. @item point
  15189. @item bilinear
  15190. @item bicubic
  15191. @item spline16
  15192. @item spline36
  15193. @item lanczos
  15194. @end table
  15195. Default is bilinear.
  15196. @item range, r
  15197. Set the color range.
  15198. Possible values are:
  15199. @table @var
  15200. @item input
  15201. @item limited
  15202. @item full
  15203. @end table
  15204. Default is same as input.
  15205. @item primaries, p
  15206. Set the color primaries.
  15207. Possible values are:
  15208. @table @var
  15209. @item input
  15210. @item 709
  15211. @item unspecified
  15212. @item 170m
  15213. @item 240m
  15214. @item 2020
  15215. @end table
  15216. Default is same as input.
  15217. @item transfer, t
  15218. Set the transfer characteristics.
  15219. Possible values are:
  15220. @table @var
  15221. @item input
  15222. @item 709
  15223. @item unspecified
  15224. @item 601
  15225. @item linear
  15226. @item 2020_10
  15227. @item 2020_12
  15228. @item smpte2084
  15229. @item iec61966-2-1
  15230. @item arib-std-b67
  15231. @end table
  15232. Default is same as input.
  15233. @item matrix, m
  15234. Set the colorspace matrix.
  15235. Possible value are:
  15236. @table @var
  15237. @item input
  15238. @item 709
  15239. @item unspecified
  15240. @item 470bg
  15241. @item 170m
  15242. @item 2020_ncl
  15243. @item 2020_cl
  15244. @end table
  15245. Default is same as input.
  15246. @item rangein, rin
  15247. Set the input color range.
  15248. Possible values are:
  15249. @table @var
  15250. @item input
  15251. @item limited
  15252. @item full
  15253. @end table
  15254. Default is same as input.
  15255. @item primariesin, pin
  15256. Set the input color primaries.
  15257. Possible values are:
  15258. @table @var
  15259. @item input
  15260. @item 709
  15261. @item unspecified
  15262. @item 170m
  15263. @item 240m
  15264. @item 2020
  15265. @end table
  15266. Default is same as input.
  15267. @item transferin, tin
  15268. Set the input transfer characteristics.
  15269. Possible values are:
  15270. @table @var
  15271. @item input
  15272. @item 709
  15273. @item unspecified
  15274. @item 601
  15275. @item linear
  15276. @item 2020_10
  15277. @item 2020_12
  15278. @end table
  15279. Default is same as input.
  15280. @item matrixin, min
  15281. Set the input colorspace matrix.
  15282. Possible value are:
  15283. @table @var
  15284. @item input
  15285. @item 709
  15286. @item unspecified
  15287. @item 470bg
  15288. @item 170m
  15289. @item 2020_ncl
  15290. @item 2020_cl
  15291. @end table
  15292. @item chromal, c
  15293. Set the output chroma location.
  15294. Possible values are:
  15295. @table @var
  15296. @item input
  15297. @item left
  15298. @item center
  15299. @item topleft
  15300. @item top
  15301. @item bottomleft
  15302. @item bottom
  15303. @end table
  15304. @item chromalin, cin
  15305. Set the input chroma location.
  15306. Possible values are:
  15307. @table @var
  15308. @item input
  15309. @item left
  15310. @item center
  15311. @item topleft
  15312. @item top
  15313. @item bottomleft
  15314. @item bottom
  15315. @end table
  15316. @item npl
  15317. Set the nominal peak luminance.
  15318. @end table
  15319. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  15320. containing the following constants:
  15321. @table @var
  15322. @item in_w
  15323. @item in_h
  15324. The input width and height
  15325. @item iw
  15326. @item ih
  15327. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  15328. @item out_w
  15329. @item out_h
  15330. The output (scaled) width and height
  15331. @item ow
  15332. @item oh
  15333. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  15334. @item a
  15335. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  15336. @item sar
  15337. input sample aspect ratio
  15338. @item dar
  15339. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  15340. @item hsub
  15341. @item vsub
  15342. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15343. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15344. @item ohsub
  15345. @item ovsub
  15346. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15347. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15348. @end table
  15349. @table @option
  15350. @end table
  15351. @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
  15352. @chapter OpenCL Video Filters
  15353. @c man begin OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  15354. Below is a description of the currently available OpenCL video filters.
  15355. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  15356. @code{--enable-opencl}.
  15357. Running OpenCL filters requires you to initialize a hardware device and to pass that device to all filters in any filter graph.
  15358. @table @option
  15359. @item -init_hw_device opencl[=@var{name}][:@var{device}[,@var{key=value}...]]
  15360. Initialise a new hardware device of type @var{opencl} called @var{name}, using the
  15361. given device parameters.
  15362. @item -filter_hw_device @var{name}
  15363. Pass the hardware device called @var{name} to all filters in any filter graph.
  15364. @end table
  15365. For more detailed information see @url{https://www.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg.html#Advanced-Video-options}
  15366. @itemize
  15367. @item
  15368. Example of choosing the first device on the second platform and running avgblur_opencl filter with default parameters on it.
  15369. @example
  15370. -init_hw_device opencl=gpu:1.0 -filter_hw_device gpu -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15371. @end example
  15372. @end itemize
  15373. Since OpenCL filters are not able to access frame data in normal memory, all frame data needs to be uploaded(@ref{hwupload}) to hardware surfaces connected to the appropriate device before being used and then downloaded(@ref{hwdownload}) back to normal memory. Note that @ref{hwupload} will upload to a surface with the same layout as the software frame, so it may be necessary to add a @ref{format} filter immediately before to get the input into the right format and @ref{hwdownload} does not support all formats on the output - it may be necessary to insert an additional @ref{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get the output in a supported format.
  15374. @section avgblur_opencl
  15375. Apply average blur filter.
  15376. The filter accepts the following options:
  15377. @table @option
  15378. @item sizeX
  15379. Set horizontal radius size.
  15380. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{1}.
  15381. @item planes
  15382. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15383. @item sizeY
  15384. Set vertical radius size. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{0}. If zero, @code{sizeX} value will be used.
  15385. @end table
  15386. @subsection Example
  15387. @itemize
  15388. @item
  15389. Apply average blur filter with horizontal and vertical size of 3, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of the 7x7 region centered on it in the input. For pixels on the edges of the image, the region does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15390. @example
  15391. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15392. @end example
  15393. @end itemize
  15394. @section boxblur_opencl
  15395. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  15396. It accepts the following parameters:
  15397. @table @option
  15398. @item luma_radius, lr
  15399. @item luma_power, lp
  15400. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15401. @item chroma_power, cp
  15402. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15403. @item alpha_power, ap
  15404. @end table
  15405. A description of the accepted options follows.
  15406. @table @option
  15407. @item luma_radius, lr
  15408. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15409. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15410. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  15411. corresponding input plane.
  15412. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  15413. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  15414. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  15415. planes.
  15416. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  15417. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  15418. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  15419. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  15420. @table @option
  15421. @item w
  15422. @item h
  15423. The input width and height in pixels.
  15424. @item cw
  15425. @item ch
  15426. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  15427. @item hsub
  15428. @item vsub
  15429. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  15430. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15431. @end table
  15432. @item luma_power, lp
  15433. @item chroma_power, cp
  15434. @item alpha_power, ap
  15435. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  15436. corresponding plane.
  15437. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  15438. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  15439. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  15440. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  15441. @end table
  15442. @subsection Examples
  15443. Apply boxblur filter, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of box-radiuses @var{luma_radius}, @var{chroma_radius}, @var{alpha_radius} for each plane respectively. The filter will apply @var{luma_power}, @var{chroma_power}, @var{alpha_power} times onto the corresponding plane. For pixels on the edges of the image, the radius does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15444. @itemize
  15445. @item
  15446. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radius
  15447. set to 2 and luma, chroma, and alpha power set to 3. The filter will run 3 times with box-radius set to 2 for every plane of the image.
  15448. @example
  15449. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=luma_radius=2:luma_power=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15450. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15451. @end example
  15452. @item
  15453. Apply a boxblur filter with luma radius set to 2, luma_power to 1, chroma_radius to 4, chroma_power to 5, alpha_radius to 3 and alpha_power to 7.
  15454. For the luma plane, a 2x2 box radius will be run once.
  15455. For the chroma plane, a 4x4 box radius will be run 5 times.
  15456. For the alpha plane, a 3x3 box radius will be run 7 times.
  15457. @example
  15458. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:1:4:5:3:7, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15459. @end example
  15460. @end itemize
  15461. @section convolution_opencl
  15462. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 matrix.
  15463. The filter accepts the following options:
  15464. @table @option
  15465. @item 0m
  15466. @item 1m
  15467. @item 2m
  15468. @item 3m
  15469. Set matrix for each plane.
  15470. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed numbers.
  15471. Default value for each plane is @code{0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0}.
  15472. @item 0rdiv
  15473. @item 1rdiv
  15474. @item 2rdiv
  15475. @item 3rdiv
  15476. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  15477. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  15478. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{1.0}.
  15479. @item 0bias
  15480. @item 1bias
  15481. @item 2bias
  15482. @item 3bias
  15483. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  15484. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker.
  15485. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{0.0}.
  15486. @end table
  15487. @subsection Examples
  15488. @itemize
  15489. @item
  15490. Apply sharpen:
  15491. @example
  15492. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15493. @end example
  15494. @item
  15495. Apply blur:
  15496. @example
  15497. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15498. @end example
  15499. @item
  15500. Apply edge enhance:
  15501. @example
  15502. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15503. @end example
  15504. @item
  15505. Apply edge detect:
  15506. @example
  15507. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15508. @end example
  15509. @item
  15510. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  15511. @example
  15512. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15513. @end example
  15514. @item
  15515. Apply emboss:
  15516. @example
  15517. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15518. @end example
  15519. @end itemize
  15520. @section dilation_opencl
  15521. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  15522. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  15523. It accepts the following options:
  15524. @table @option
  15525. @item threshold0
  15526. @item threshold1
  15527. @item threshold2
  15528. @item threshold3
  15529. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  15530. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  15531. @item coordinates
  15532. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  15533. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  15534. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  15535. 1 2 3
  15536. 4 x 5
  15537. 6 7 8
  15538. @end table
  15539. @subsection Example
  15540. @itemize
  15541. @item
  15542. Apply dilation filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local maximum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local maximum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel + threshold of corresponding plane.
  15543. @example
  15544. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, dilation_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15545. @end example
  15546. @end itemize
  15547. @section erosion_opencl
  15548. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  15549. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  15550. It accepts the following options:
  15551. @table @option
  15552. @item threshold0
  15553. @item threshold1
  15554. @item threshold2
  15555. @item threshold3
  15556. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  15557. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  15558. @item coordinates
  15559. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  15560. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  15561. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  15562. 1 2 3
  15563. 4 x 5
  15564. 6 7 8
  15565. @end table
  15566. @subsection Example
  15567. @itemize
  15568. @item
  15569. Apply erosion filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local minimum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local minimum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel - threshold of corresponding plane.
  15570. @example
  15571. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, erosion_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15572. @end example
  15573. @end itemize
  15574. @section colorkey_opencl
  15575. RGB colorspace color keying.
  15576. The filter accepts the following options:
  15577. @table @option
  15578. @item color
  15579. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  15580. @item similarity
  15581. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  15582. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  15583. @item blend
  15584. Blend percentage.
  15585. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  15586. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  15587. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  15588. @end table
  15589. @subsection Examples
  15590. @itemize
  15591. @item
  15592. Make every semi-green pixel in the input transparent with some slight blending:
  15593. @example
  15594. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, colorkey_opencl=green:0.3:0.1, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15595. @end example
  15596. @end itemize
  15597. @section deshake_opencl
  15598. Feature-point based video stabilization filter.
  15599. The filter accepts the following options:
  15600. @table @option
  15601. @item tripod
  15602. Simulates a tripod by preventing any camera movement whatsoever from the original frame. Defaults to @code{0}.
  15603. @item debug
  15604. Whether or not additional debug info should be displayed, both in the processed output and in the console.
  15605. Note that in order to see console debug output you will also need to pass @code{-v verbose} to ffmpeg.
  15606. Viewing point matches in the output video is only supported for RGB input.
  15607. Defaults to @code{0}.
  15608. @item adaptive_crop
  15609. Whether or not to do a tiny bit of cropping at the borders to cut down on the amount of mirrored pixels.
  15610. Defaults to @code{1}.
  15611. @item refine_features
  15612. Whether or not feature points should be refined at a sub-pixel level.
  15613. This can be turned off for a slight performance gain at the cost of precision.
  15614. Defaults to @code{1}.
  15615. @item smooth_strength
  15616. The strength of the smoothing applied to the camera path from @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}.
  15617. @code{1.0} is the maximum smoothing strength while values less than that result in less smoothing.
  15618. @code{0.0} causes the filter to adaptively choose a smoothing strength on a per-frame basis.
  15619. Defaults to @code{0.0}.
  15620. @item smooth_window_multiplier
  15621. Controls the size of the smoothing window (the number of frames buffered to determine motion information from).
  15622. The size of the smoothing window is determined by multiplying the framerate of the video by this number.
  15623. Acceptable values range from @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}.
  15624. Larger values increase the amount of motion data available for determining how to smooth the camera path,
  15625. potentially improving smoothness, but also increase latency and memory usage.
  15626. Defaults to @code{2.0}.
  15627. @end table
  15628. @subsection Examples
  15629. @itemize
  15630. @item
  15631. Stabilize a video with a fixed, medium smoothing strength:
  15632. @example
  15633. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, deshake_opencl=smooth_strength=0.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15634. @end example
  15635. @item
  15636. Stabilize a video with debugging (both in console and in rendered video):
  15637. @example
  15638. -i INPUT -filter_complex "[0:v]format=rgba, hwupload, deshake_opencl=debug=1, hwdownload, format=rgba, format=yuv420p" -v verbose OUTPUT
  15639. @end example
  15640. @end itemize
  15641. @section nlmeans_opencl
  15642. Non-local Means denoise filter through OpenCL, this filter accepts same options as @ref{nlmeans}.
  15643. @section overlay_opencl
  15644. Overlay one video on top of another.
  15645. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is overlaid.
  15646. This filter requires same memory layout for all the inputs. So, format conversion may be needed.
  15647. The filter accepts the following options:
  15648. @table @option
  15649. @item x
  15650. Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  15651. Default value is @code{0}.
  15652. @item y
  15653. Set the y coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  15654. Default value is @code{0}.
  15655. @end table
  15656. @subsection Examples
  15657. @itemize
  15658. @item
  15659. Overlay an image LOGO at the top-left corner of the INPUT video. Both inputs are yuv420p format.
  15660. @example
  15661. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuv420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15662. @end example
  15663. @item
  15664. The inputs have same memory layout for color channels , the overlay has additional alpha plane, like INPUT is yuv420p, and the LOGO is yuva420p.
  15665. @example
  15666. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuva420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15667. @end example
  15668. @end itemize
  15669. @section prewitt_opencl
  15670. Apply the Prewitt operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Prewitt_operator}) to input video stream.
  15671. The filter accepts the following option:
  15672. @table @option
  15673. @item planes
  15674. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15675. @item scale
  15676. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  15677. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15678. @item delta
  15679. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  15680. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15681. @end table
  15682. @subsection Example
  15683. @itemize
  15684. @item
  15685. Apply the Prewitt operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10.
  15686. @example
  15687. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, prewitt_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15688. @end example
  15689. @end itemize
  15690. @section roberts_opencl
  15691. Apply the Roberts cross operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Roberts_cross}) to input video stream.
  15692. The filter accepts the following option:
  15693. @table @option
  15694. @item planes
  15695. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15696. @item scale
  15697. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  15698. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15699. @item delta
  15700. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  15701. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15702. @end table
  15703. @subsection Example
  15704. @itemize
  15705. @item
  15706. Apply the Roberts cross operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  15707. @example
  15708. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, roberts_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15709. @end example
  15710. @end itemize
  15711. @section sobel_opencl
  15712. Apply the Sobel operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Sobel_operator}) to input video stream.
  15713. The filter accepts the following option:
  15714. @table @option
  15715. @item planes
  15716. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15717. @item scale
  15718. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  15719. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15720. @item delta
  15721. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  15722. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15723. @end table
  15724. @subsection Example
  15725. @itemize
  15726. @item
  15727. Apply sobel operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  15728. @example
  15729. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, sobel_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15730. @end example
  15731. @end itemize
  15732. @section tonemap_opencl
  15733. Perform HDR(PQ/HLG) to SDR conversion with tone-mapping.
  15734. It accepts the following parameters:
  15735. @table @option
  15736. @item tonemap
  15737. Specify the tone-mapping operator to be used. Same as tonemap option in @ref{tonemap}.
  15738. @item param
  15739. Tune the tone mapping algorithm. same as param option in @ref{tonemap}.
  15740. @item desat
  15741. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  15742. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  15743. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  15744. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  15745. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  15746. The default value is 0.5, and the algorithm here is a little different from
  15747. the cpu version tonemap currently. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  15748. @item threshold
  15749. The tonemapping algorithm parameters is fine-tuned per each scene. And a threshold
  15750. is used to detect whether the scene has changed or not. If the distance between
  15751. the current frame average brightness and the current running average exceeds
  15752. a threshold value, we would re-calculate scene average and peak brightness.
  15753. The default value is 0.2.
  15754. @item format
  15755. Specify the output pixel format.
  15756. Currently supported formats are:
  15757. @table @var
  15758. @item p010
  15759. @item nv12
  15760. @end table
  15761. @item range, r
  15762. Set the output color range.
  15763. Possible values are:
  15764. @table @var
  15765. @item tv/mpeg
  15766. @item pc/jpeg
  15767. @end table
  15768. Default is same as input.
  15769. @item primaries, p
  15770. Set the output color primaries.
  15771. Possible values are:
  15772. @table @var
  15773. @item bt709
  15774. @item bt2020
  15775. @end table
  15776. Default is same as input.
  15777. @item transfer, t
  15778. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  15779. Possible values are:
  15780. @table @var
  15781. @item bt709
  15782. @item bt2020
  15783. @end table
  15784. Default is bt709.
  15785. @item matrix, m
  15786. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  15787. Possible value are:
  15788. @table @var
  15789. @item bt709
  15790. @item bt2020
  15791. @end table
  15792. Default is same as input.
  15793. @end table
  15794. @subsection Example
  15795. @itemize
  15796. @item
  15797. Convert HDR(PQ/HLG) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format using linear operator.
  15798. @example
  15799. -i INPUT -vf "format=p010,hwupload,tonemap_opencl=t=bt2020:tonemap=linear:format=p010,hwdownload,format=p010" OUTPUT
  15800. @end example
  15801. @end itemize
  15802. @section unsharp_opencl
  15803. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  15804. It accepts the following parameters:
  15805. @table @option
  15806. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  15807. Set the luma matrix horizontal size.
  15808. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  15809. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  15810. Set the luma matrix vertical size.
  15811. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  15812. @item luma_amount, la
  15813. Set the luma effect strength.
  15814. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15815. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  15816. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  15817. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  15818. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size.
  15819. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  15820. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  15821. Set the chroma matrix vertical size.
  15822. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  15823. @item chroma_amount, ca
  15824. Set the chroma effect strength.
  15825. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15826. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  15827. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  15828. @end table
  15829. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  15830. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  15831. @subsection Examples
  15832. @itemize
  15833. @item
  15834. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  15835. @example
  15836. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15837. @end example
  15838. @item
  15839. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  15840. @example
  15841. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=7:7:-2:7:7:-2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15842. @end example
  15843. @end itemize
  15844. @c man end OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  15845. @chapter Video Sources
  15846. @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
  15847. Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
  15848. @section buffer
  15849. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  15850. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  15851. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
  15852. It accepts the following parameters:
  15853. @table @option
  15854. @item video_size
  15855. Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
  15856. syntax of this option, check the
  15857. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15858. @item width
  15859. The input video width.
  15860. @item height
  15861. The input video height.
  15862. @item pix_fmt
  15863. A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
  15864. It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
  15865. name.
  15866. @item time_base
  15867. Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
  15868. @item frame_rate
  15869. Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
  15870. @item pixel_aspect, sar
  15871. The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
  15872. @item sws_param
  15873. Specify the optional parameters to be used for the scale filter which
  15874. is automatically inserted when an input change is detected in the
  15875. input size or format.
  15876. @item hw_frames_ctx
  15877. When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
  15878. AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
  15879. @end table
  15880. For example:
  15881. @example
  15882. buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
  15883. @end example
  15884. will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
  15885. with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
  15886. square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
  15887. Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
  15888. (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
  15889. this example corresponds to:
  15890. @example
  15891. buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
  15892. @end example
  15893. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
  15894. syntax is deprecated:
  15895. @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}[:@var{sws_param}]
  15896. @section cellauto
  15897. Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
  15898. The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
  15899. @option{filename} and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
  15900. not specified an initial state is created randomly.
  15901. At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
  15902. the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
  15903. frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
  15904. This source accepts the following options:
  15905. @table @option
  15906. @item filename, f
  15907. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  15908. the specified file.
  15909. In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
  15910. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  15911. file will be ignored.
  15912. @item pattern, p
  15913. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  15914. the specified string.
  15915. Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
  15916. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  15917. string will be ignored.
  15918. @item rate, r
  15919. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  15920. Default is 25.
  15921. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  15922. Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
  15923. is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
  15924. 1/PHI.
  15925. This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
  15926. @item random_seed, seed
  15927. Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
  15928. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  15929. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  15930. effort basis.
  15931. @item rule
  15932. Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
  15933. Default value is 110.
  15934. @item size, s
  15935. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15936. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15937. If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
  15938. by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
  15939. height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
  15940. If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
  15941. pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
  15942. larger row.
  15943. If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
  15944. defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
  15945. @item scroll
  15946. If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
  15947. have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
  15948. written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
  15949. Defaults to 1.
  15950. @item start_full, full
  15951. If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
  15952. outputting the first frame.
  15953. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  15954. @item stitch
  15955. If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
  15956. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  15957. @end table
  15958. @subsection Examples
  15959. @itemize
  15960. @item
  15961. Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
  15962. size 200x400.
  15963. @example
  15964. cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
  15965. @end example
  15966. @item
  15967. Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
  15968. ratio of 2/3:
  15969. @example
  15970. cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  15971. @end example
  15972. @item
  15973. Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
  15974. centered on an initial row with width 100:
  15975. @example
  15976. cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  15977. @end example
  15978. @item
  15979. Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
  15980. @example
  15981. cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  15982. @end example
  15983. @end itemize
  15984. @anchor{coreimagesrc}
  15985. @section coreimagesrc
  15986. Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  15987. This video source is a specialized version of the @ref{coreimage} video filter.
  15988. Use a core image generator at the beginning of the applied filterchain to
  15989. generate the content.
  15990. The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:
  15991. @table @option
  15992. @item list_generators
  15993. List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as
  15994. possible minimum and maximum values along with the default values.
  15995. @example
  15996. list_generators=true
  15997. @end example
  15998. @item size, s
  15999. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16000. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16001. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  16002. @item rate, r
  16003. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16004. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16005. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16006. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16007. "25".
  16008. @item sar
  16009. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  16010. @item duration, d
  16011. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16012. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16013. for the accepted syntax.
  16014. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16015. supposed to be generated forever.
  16016. @end table
  16017. Additionally, all options of the @ref{coreimage} video filter are accepted.
  16018. A complete filterchain can be used for further processing of the
  16019. generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See @ref{coreimage} documentation
  16020. and examples for details.
  16021. @subsection Examples
  16022. @itemize
  16023. @item
  16024. Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  16025. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  16026. @example
  16027. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  16028. @end example
  16029. This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of @ref{coreimage} without the
  16030. need for a nullsrc video source.
  16031. @end itemize
  16032. @section mandelbrot
  16033. Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
  16034. point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
  16035. This source accepts the following options:
  16036. @table @option
  16037. @item end_pts
  16038. Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
  16039. @item end_scale
  16040. Set the terminal scale value.
  16041. Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
  16042. @item inner
  16043. Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
  16044. Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
  16045. It shall assume one of the following values:
  16046. @table @option
  16047. @item black
  16048. Set black mode.
  16049. @item convergence
  16050. Show time until convergence.
  16051. @item mincol
  16052. Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
  16053. @item period
  16054. Set period mode.
  16055. @end table
  16056. Default value is @var{mincol}.
  16057. @item bailout
  16058. Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
  16059. @item maxiter
  16060. Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
  16061. algorithm. Default value is 7189.
  16062. @item outer
  16063. Set outer coloring mode.
  16064. It shall assume one of following values:
  16065. @table @option
  16066. @item iteration_count
  16067. Set iteration count mode.
  16068. @item normalized_iteration_count
  16069. set normalized iteration count mode.
  16070. @end table
  16071. Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
  16072. @item rate, r
  16073. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16074. value is "25".
  16075. @item size, s
  16076. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  16077. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  16078. @item start_scale
  16079. Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
  16080. @item start_x
  16081. Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
  16082. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
  16083. @item start_y
  16084. Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
  16085. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
  16086. @end table
  16087. @section mptestsrc
  16088. Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
  16089. The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
  16090. This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
  16091. This source accepts the following options:
  16092. @table @option
  16093. @item rate, r
  16094. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16095. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16096. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16097. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16098. "25".
  16099. @item duration, d
  16100. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16101. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16102. for the accepted syntax.
  16103. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16104. supposed to be generated forever.
  16105. @item test, t
  16106. Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
  16107. @table @option
  16108. @item dc_luma
  16109. @item dc_chroma
  16110. @item freq_luma
  16111. @item freq_chroma
  16112. @item amp_luma
  16113. @item amp_chroma
  16114. @item cbp
  16115. @item mv
  16116. @item ring1
  16117. @item ring2
  16118. @item all
  16119. @item max_frames, m
  16120. Set the maximum number of frames generated for each test, default value is 30.
  16121. @end table
  16122. Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
  16123. @end table
  16124. Some examples:
  16125. @example
  16126. mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
  16127. @end example
  16128. will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
  16129. @section frei0r_src
  16130. Provide a frei0r source.
  16131. To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
  16132. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  16133. This source accepts the following parameters:
  16134. @table @option
  16135. @item size
  16136. The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16137. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16138. @item framerate
  16139. The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
  16140. @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
  16141. @item filter_name
  16142. The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
  16143. how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
  16144. documentation.
  16145. @item filter_params
  16146. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
  16147. @end table
  16148. For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
  16149. and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
  16150. @example
  16151. frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
  16152. @end example
  16153. @section life
  16154. Generate a life pattern.
  16155. This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
  16156. The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
  16157. which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
  16158. interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
  16159. horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
  16160. At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
  16161. which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
  16162. cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
  16163. the rule to adopt.
  16164. This source accepts the following options:
  16165. @table @option
  16166. @item filename, f
  16167. Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
  16168. each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
  16169. is used to delimit the end of each row.
  16170. If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
  16171. randomly.
  16172. @item rate, r
  16173. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  16174. Default is 25.
  16175. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  16176. Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
  16177. floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
  16178. It is ignored when a file is specified.
  16179. @item random_seed, seed
  16180. Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
  16181. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  16182. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  16183. effort basis.
  16184. @item rule
  16185. Set the life rule.
  16186. A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
  16187. where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
  16188. @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
  16189. live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
  16190. which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
  16191. "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
  16192. Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
  16193. high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
  16194. for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
  16195. the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
  16196. higher number of neighbor cells.
  16197. For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
  16198. rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
  16199. Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
  16200. rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
  16201. cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
  16202. a dead cell.
  16203. @item size, s
  16204. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16205. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16206. If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
  16207. same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
  16208. the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
  16209. that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
  16210. If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
  16211. (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
  16212. @item stitch
  16213. If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
  16214. top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
  16215. @item mold
  16216. Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
  16217. @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
  16218. value from 0 to 255.
  16219. @item life_color
  16220. Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
  16221. @item death_color
  16222. Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
  16223. used to represent a dead cell.
  16224. @item mold_color
  16225. Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
  16226. For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  16227. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16228. @end table
  16229. @subsection Examples
  16230. @itemize
  16231. @item
  16232. Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
  16233. 300x300 pixels:
  16234. @example
  16235. life=f=pattern:s=300x300
  16236. @end example
  16237. @item
  16238. Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
  16239. @example
  16240. life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  16241. @end example
  16242. @item
  16243. Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
  16244. @example
  16245. life=rule=S14/B34
  16246. @end example
  16247. @item
  16248. Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
  16249. @example
  16250. ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
  16251. @end example
  16252. @end itemize
  16253. @anchor{allrgb}
  16254. @anchor{allyuv}
  16255. @anchor{color}
  16256. @anchor{haldclutsrc}
  16257. @anchor{nullsrc}
  16258. @anchor{pal75bars}
  16259. @anchor{pal100bars}
  16260. @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
  16261. @anchor{smptebars}
  16262. @anchor{smptehdbars}
  16263. @anchor{testsrc}
  16264. @anchor{testsrc2}
  16265. @anchor{yuvtestsrc}
  16266. @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, pal75bars, pal100bars, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2, yuvtestsrc
  16267. The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
  16268. The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
  16269. The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
  16270. The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
  16271. @ref{haldclut} filter.
  16272. The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
  16273. mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
  16274. source for filters which ignore the input data.
  16275. The @code{pal75bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16276. EBU PAL recommendations with 75% color levels.
  16277. The @code{pal100bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16278. EBU PAL recommendations with 100% color levels.
  16279. The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
  16280. detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
  16281. stripe from top to bottom.
  16282. The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16283. the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
  16284. The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16285. the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
  16286. The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
  16287. color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
  16288. intended for testing purposes.
  16289. The @code{testsrc2} source is similar to testsrc, but supports more
  16290. pixel formats instead of just @code{rgb24}. This allows using it as an
  16291. input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.
  16292. The @code{yuvtestsrc} source generates an YUV test pattern. You should
  16293. see a y, cb and cr stripe from top to bottom.
  16294. The sources accept the following parameters:
  16295. @table @option
  16296. @item level
  16297. Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
  16298. source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
  16299. pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
  16300. coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
  16301. @item color, c
  16302. Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
  16303. source. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16304. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16305. @item size, s
  16306. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16307. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16308. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  16309. This option is not available with the @code{allrgb}, @code{allyuv}, and
  16310. @code{haldclutsrc} filters.
  16311. @item rate, r
  16312. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16313. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16314. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16315. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16316. "25".
  16317. @item duration, d
  16318. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16319. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16320. for the accepted syntax.
  16321. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16322. supposed to be generated forever.
  16323. @item sar
  16324. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  16325. @item alpha
  16326. Specify the alpha (opacity) of the background, only available in the
  16327. @code{testsrc2} source. The value must be between 0 (fully transparent) and
  16328. 255 (fully opaque, the default).
  16329. @item decimals, n
  16330. Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
  16331. @code{testsrc} source.
  16332. The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
  16333. timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
  16334. value. Default value is 0.
  16335. @end table
  16336. @subsection Examples
  16337. @itemize
  16338. @item
  16339. Generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
  16340. 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second:
  16341. @example
  16342. testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
  16343. @end example
  16344. @item
  16345. The following graph description will generate a red source
  16346. with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
  16347. frames per second:
  16348. @example
  16349. color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
  16350. @end example
  16351. @item
  16352. If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
  16353. following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
  16354. the @code{geq} filter:
  16355. @example
  16356. nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
  16357. @end example
  16358. @end itemize
  16359. @subsection Commands
  16360. The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
  16361. @table @option
  16362. @item c, color
  16363. Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
  16364. corresponding @option{color} option.
  16365. @end table
  16366. @section openclsrc
  16367. Generate video using an OpenCL program.
  16368. @table @option
  16369. @item source
  16370. OpenCL program source file.
  16371. @item kernel
  16372. Kernel name in program.
  16373. @item size, s
  16374. Size of frames to generate. This must be set.
  16375. @item format
  16376. Pixel format to use for the generated frames. This must be set.
  16377. @item rate, r
  16378. Number of frames generated every second. Default value is '25'.
  16379. @end table
  16380. For details of how the program loading works, see the @ref{program_opencl}
  16381. filter.
  16382. Example programs:
  16383. @itemize
  16384. @item
  16385. Generate a colour ramp by setting pixel values from the position of the pixel
  16386. in the output image. (Note that this will work with all pixel formats, but
  16387. the generated output will not be the same.)
  16388. @verbatim
  16389. __kernel void ramp(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16390. unsigned int index)
  16391. {
  16392. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16393. float4 val;
  16394. val.xy = val.zw = convert_float2(loc) / convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  16395. write_imagef(dst, loc, val);
  16396. }
  16397. @end verbatim
  16398. @item
  16399. Generate a Sierpinski carpet pattern, panning by a single pixel each frame.
  16400. @verbatim
  16401. __kernel void sierpinski_carpet(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16402. unsigned int index)
  16403. {
  16404. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16405. float4 value = 0.0f;
  16406. int x = loc.x + index;
  16407. int y = loc.y + index;
  16408. while (x > 0 || y > 0) {
  16409. if (x % 3 == 1 && y % 3 == 1) {
  16410. value = 1.0f;
  16411. break;
  16412. }
  16413. x /= 3;
  16414. y /= 3;
  16415. }
  16416. write_imagef(dst, loc, value);
  16417. }
  16418. @end verbatim
  16419. @end itemize
  16420. @section sierpinski
  16421. Generate a Sierpinski carpet/triangle fractal, and randomly pan around.
  16422. This source accepts the following options:
  16423. @table @option
  16424. @item size, s
  16425. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  16426. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  16427. @item rate, r
  16428. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16429. value is "25".
  16430. @item seed
  16431. Set seed which is used for random panning.
  16432. @item jump
  16433. Set max jump for single pan destination. Allowed range is from 1 to 10000.
  16434. @item type
  16435. Set fractal type, can be default @code{carpet} or @code{triangle}.
  16436. @end table
  16437. @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
  16438. @chapter Video Sinks
  16439. @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
  16440. Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
  16441. @section buffersink
  16442. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
  16443. graph.
  16444. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  16445. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  16446. or the options system.
  16447. It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
  16448. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  16449. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  16450. @section nullsink
  16451. Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
  16452. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  16453. tools.
  16454. @c man end VIDEO SINKS
  16455. @chapter Multimedia Filters
  16456. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  16457. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
  16458. @section abitscope
  16459. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio bit scope.
  16460. The filter accepts the following options:
  16461. @table @option
  16462. @item rate, r
  16463. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16464. value is "25".
  16465. @item size, s
  16466. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16467. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16468. Default value is @code{1024x256}.
  16469. @item colors
  16470. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  16471. draw channels. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  16472. by white color.
  16473. @end table
  16474. @section adrawgraph
  16475. Draw a graph using input audio metadata.
  16476. See @ref{drawgraph}
  16477. @section agraphmonitor
  16478. See @ref{graphmonitor}.
  16479. @section ahistogram
  16480. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
  16481. The filter accepts the following options:
  16482. @table @option
  16483. @item dmode
  16484. Specify how histogram is calculated.
  16485. It accepts the following values:
  16486. @table @samp
  16487. @item single
  16488. Use single histogram for all channels.
  16489. @item separate
  16490. Use separate histogram for each channel.
  16491. @end table
  16492. Default is @code{single}.
  16493. @item rate, r
  16494. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16495. value is "25".
  16496. @item size, s
  16497. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16498. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16499. Default value is @code{hd720}.
  16500. @item scale
  16501. Set display scale.
  16502. It accepts the following values:
  16503. @table @samp
  16504. @item log
  16505. logarithmic
  16506. @item sqrt
  16507. square root
  16508. @item cbrt
  16509. cubic root
  16510. @item lin
  16511. linear
  16512. @item rlog
  16513. reverse logarithmic
  16514. @end table
  16515. Default is @code{log}.
  16516. @item ascale
  16517. Set amplitude scale.
  16518. It accepts the following values:
  16519. @table @samp
  16520. @item log
  16521. logarithmic
  16522. @item lin
  16523. linear
  16524. @end table
  16525. Default is @code{log}.
  16526. @item acount
  16527. Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
  16528. Default is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
  16529. @item rheight
  16530. Set histogram ratio of window height.
  16531. @item slide
  16532. Set sonogram sliding.
  16533. It accepts the following values:
  16534. @table @samp
  16535. @item replace
  16536. replace old rows with new ones.
  16537. @item scroll
  16538. scroll from top to bottom.
  16539. @end table
  16540. Default is @code{replace}.
  16541. @end table
  16542. @section aphasemeter
  16543. Measures phase of input audio, which is exported as metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase},
  16544. representing mean phase of current audio frame. A video output can also be produced and is
  16545. enabled by default. The audio is passed through as first output.
  16546. Audio will be rematrixed to stereo if it has a different channel layout. Phase value is in
  16547. range @code{[-1, 1]} where @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase
  16548. and @code{1} means channels are in phase.
  16549. The filter accepts the following options, all related to its video output:
  16550. @table @option
  16551. @item rate, r
  16552. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  16553. @item size, s
  16554. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16555. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16556. Default value is @code{800x400}.
  16557. @item rc
  16558. @item gc
  16559. @item bc
  16560. Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
  16561. @code{7} and @code{1}.
  16562. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  16563. @item mpc
  16564. Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
  16565. @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
  16566. @item video
  16567. Enable video output. Default is enabled.
  16568. @end table
  16569. @section avectorscope
  16570. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
  16571. scope.
  16572. The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
  16573. audio stream. A monaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
  16574. signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
  16575. as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
  16576. If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
  16577. indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
  16578. The filter accepts the following options:
  16579. @table @option
  16580. @item mode, m
  16581. Set the vectorscope mode.
  16582. Available values are:
  16583. @table @samp
  16584. @item lissajous
  16585. Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
  16586. @item lissajous_xy
  16587. Same as above but not rotated.
  16588. @item polar
  16589. Shape resembling half of circle.
  16590. @end table
  16591. Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
  16592. @item size, s
  16593. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16594. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16595. Default value is @code{400x400}.
  16596. @item rate, r
  16597. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  16598. @item rc
  16599. @item gc
  16600. @item bc
  16601. @item ac
  16602. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
  16603. @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
  16604. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  16605. @item rf
  16606. @item gf
  16607. @item bf
  16608. @item af
  16609. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
  16610. @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
  16611. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  16612. @item zoom
  16613. Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  16614. Values lower than @var{1} will auto adjust zoom factor to maximal possible value.
  16615. @item draw
  16616. Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
  16617. Available values are:
  16618. @table @samp
  16619. @item dot
  16620. Draw dot for each sample.
  16621. @item line
  16622. Draw line between previous and current sample.
  16623. @end table
  16624. Default value is @samp{dot}.
  16625. @item scale
  16626. Specify amplitude scale of audio samples.
  16627. Available values are:
  16628. @table @samp
  16629. @item lin
  16630. Linear.
  16631. @item sqrt
  16632. Square root.
  16633. @item cbrt
  16634. Cubic root.
  16635. @item log
  16636. Logarithmic.
  16637. @end table
  16638. @item swap
  16639. Swap left channel axis with right channel axis.
  16640. @item mirror
  16641. Mirror axis.
  16642. @table @samp
  16643. @item none
  16644. No mirror.
  16645. @item x
  16646. Mirror only x axis.
  16647. @item y
  16648. Mirror only y axis.
  16649. @item xy
  16650. Mirror both axis.
  16651. @end table
  16652. @end table
  16653. @subsection Examples
  16654. @itemize
  16655. @item
  16656. Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
  16657. @example
  16658. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  16659. [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
  16660. @end example
  16661. @end itemize
  16662. @section bench, abench
  16663. Benchmark part of a filtergraph.
  16664. The filter accepts the following options:
  16665. @table @option
  16666. @item action
  16667. Start or stop a timer.
  16668. Available values are:
  16669. @table @samp
  16670. @item start
  16671. Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key
  16672. @code{lavfi.bench.start_time}), and forward the frame to the next filter.
  16673. @item stop
  16674. Get the current time and fetch the @code{lavfi.bench.start_time} metadata from
  16675. the input frame metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average,
  16676. maximum and minimum time (respectively @code{t}, @code{avg}, @code{max} and
  16677. @code{min}) are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in seconds.
  16678. @end table
  16679. @end table
  16680. @subsection Examples
  16681. @itemize
  16682. @item
  16683. Benchmark @ref{selectivecolor} filter:
  16684. @example
  16685. bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop
  16686. @end example
  16687. @end itemize
  16688. @section concat
  16689. Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
  16690. other.
  16691. The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
  16692. segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
  16693. also be the number of streams at output.
  16694. The filter accepts the following options:
  16695. @table @option
  16696. @item n
  16697. Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
  16698. @item v
  16699. Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
  16700. streams in each segment. Default is 1.
  16701. @item a
  16702. Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
  16703. streams in each segment. Default is 0.
  16704. @item unsafe
  16705. Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
  16706. @end table
  16707. The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
  16708. @var{a} audio outputs.
  16709. There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
  16710. segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
  16711. segment, etc.
  16712. Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
  16713. reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
  16714. related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
  16715. concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
  16716. stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
  16717. audio streams with silence.
  16718. For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
  16719. All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
  16720. filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
  16721. streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
  16722. audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
  16723. explicitly by the user.
  16724. Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
  16725. at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
  16726. @subsection Examples
  16727. @itemize
  16728. @item
  16729. Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
  16730. (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
  16731. @example
  16732. ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
  16733. '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
  16734. concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
  16735. -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
  16736. @end example
  16737. @item
  16738. Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
  16739. (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
  16740. @example
  16741. movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
  16742. movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
  16743. [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
  16744. @end example
  16745. Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
  16746. do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
  16747. @end itemize
  16748. @subsection Commands
  16749. This filter supports the following commands:
  16750. @table @option
  16751. @item next
  16752. Close the current segment and step to the next one
  16753. @end table
  16754. @anchor{ebur128}
  16755. @section ebur128
  16756. EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream and analyzes its loudness
  16757. level. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
  16758. Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
  16759. Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
  16760. The filter can only analyze streams which have a sampling rate of 48000 Hz and whose
  16761. sample format is double-precision floating point. The input stream will be converted to
  16762. this specification, if needed. Users may need to insert aformat and/or aresample filters
  16763. after this filter to obtain the original parameters.
  16764. The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
  16765. time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
  16766. message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
  16767. unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
  16768. short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
  16769. the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds), but can optionally be configured
  16770. to instead display short-term loudness (see @var{gauge}).
  16771. The green area marks a +/- 1LU target range around the target loudness
  16772. (-23LUFS by default, unless modified through @var{target}).
  16773. More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
  16774. @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
  16775. The filter accepts the following options:
  16776. @table @option
  16777. @item video
  16778. Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
  16779. option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
  16780. activated. Default is @code{0}.
  16781. @item size
  16782. Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
  16783. option, check the
  16784. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16785. Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
  16786. @item meter
  16787. Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
  16788. @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
  16789. other integer value between this range is allowed.
  16790. @item metadata
  16791. Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
  16792. into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
  16793. in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
  16794. Default is @code{0}.
  16795. @item framelog
  16796. Force the frame logging level.
  16797. Available values are:
  16798. @table @samp
  16799. @item info
  16800. information logging level
  16801. @item verbose
  16802. verbose logging level
  16803. @end table
  16804. By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
  16805. the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
  16806. @item peak
  16807. Set peak mode(s).
  16808. Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
  16809. values are:
  16810. @table @samp
  16811. @item none
  16812. Disable any peak mode (default).
  16813. @item sample
  16814. Enable sample-peak mode.
  16815. Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
  16816. for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
  16817. @item true
  16818. Enable true-peak mode.
  16819. If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
  16820. stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
  16821. (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
  16822. This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
  16823. @end table
  16824. @item dualmono
  16825. Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  16826. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  16827. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  16828. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  16829. @item panlaw
  16830. Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
  16831. This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
  16832. @item target
  16833. Set a specific target level (in LUFS) used as relative zero in the visualization.
  16834. This parameter is optional and has a default value of -23LUFS as specified
  16835. by EBU R128. However, material published online may prefer a level of -16LUFS
  16836. (e.g. for use with podcasts or video platforms).
  16837. @item gauge
  16838. Set the value displayed by the gauge. Valid values are @code{momentary} and s
  16839. @code{shortterm}. By default the momentary value will be used, but in certain
  16840. scenarios it may be more useful to observe the short term value instead (e.g.
  16841. live mixing).
  16842. @item scale
  16843. Sets the display scale for the loudness. Valid parameters are @code{absolute}
  16844. (in LUFS) or @code{relative} (LU) relative to the target. This only affects the
  16845. video output, not the summary or continuous log output.
  16846. @end table
  16847. @subsection Examples
  16848. @itemize
  16849. @item
  16850. Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
  16851. @example
  16852. ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
  16853. @end example
  16854. @item
  16855. Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
  16856. @example
  16857. ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
  16858. @end example
  16859. @end itemize
  16860. @section interleave, ainterleave
  16861. Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
  16862. @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
  16863. These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
  16864. queued frame to the output.
  16865. Input streams must have well defined, monotonically increasing frame
  16866. timestamp values.
  16867. In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
  16868. at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
  16869. input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
  16870. For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
  16871. which always drops input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
  16872. reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
  16873. to output until the input sends an end-of-stream signal.
  16874. Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
  16875. frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
  16876. the queue is already filled.
  16877. These filters accept the following options:
  16878. @table @option
  16879. @item nb_inputs, n
  16880. Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
  16881. @end table
  16882. @subsection Examples
  16883. @itemize
  16884. @item
  16885. Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
  16886. @example
  16887. ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
  16888. @end example
  16889. @item
  16890. Add flickering blur effect:
  16891. @example
  16892. select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
  16893. @end example
  16894. @end itemize
  16895. @section metadata, ametadata
  16896. Manipulate frame metadata.
  16897. This filter accepts the following options:
  16898. @table @option
  16899. @item mode
  16900. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  16901. Can be one of the following:
  16902. @table @samp
  16903. @item select
  16904. If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
  16905. which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
  16906. every frame that has such key in metadata.
  16907. @item add
  16908. Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
  16909. do nothing.
  16910. @item modify
  16911. Modify value of already present key.
  16912. @item delete
  16913. If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
  16914. Otherwise, delete key. If @code{key} is not set, delete all metadata values in
  16915. the frame.
  16916. @item print
  16917. Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
  16918. metadata values available in frame.
  16919. @end table
  16920. @item key
  16921. Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print} and @code{delete}.
  16922. @item value
  16923. Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
  16924. @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
  16925. @item function
  16926. Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
  16927. Can be one of following:
  16928. @table @samp
  16929. @item same_str
  16930. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
  16931. @item starts_with
  16932. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
  16933. the @code{value} option string.
  16934. @item less
  16935. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
  16936. @item equal
  16937. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
  16938. @item greater
  16939. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
  16940. @item expr
  16941. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
  16942. evaluates to true.
  16943. @item ends_with
  16944. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value ends with
  16945. the @code{value} option string.
  16946. @end table
  16947. @item expr
  16948. Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
  16949. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  16950. constants:
  16951. @table @option
  16952. @item VALUE1
  16953. Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
  16954. @item VALUE2
  16955. Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
  16956. @end table
  16957. @item file
  16958. If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. Instead of
  16959. plain filename any writable url can be specified. Filename ``-'' is a shorthand
  16960. for standard output. If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log
  16961. with AV_LOG_INFO loglevel.
  16962. @end table
  16963. @subsection Examples
  16964. @itemize
  16965. @item
  16966. Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.signalstats.YDIF} with values
  16967. between 0 and 1.
  16968. @example
  16969. signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
  16970. @end example
  16971. @item
  16972. Print silencedetect output to file @file{metadata.txt}.
  16973. @example
  16974. silencedetect,ametadata=mode=print:file=metadata.txt
  16975. @end example
  16976. @item
  16977. Direct all metadata to a pipe with file descriptor 4.
  16978. @example
  16979. metadata=mode=print:file='pipe\:4'
  16980. @end example
  16981. @end itemize
  16982. @section perms, aperms
  16983. Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
  16984. These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
  16985. following filter in the filtergraph.
  16986. The filters accept the following options:
  16987. @table @option
  16988. @item mode
  16989. Select the permissions mode.
  16990. It accepts the following values:
  16991. @table @samp
  16992. @item none
  16993. Do nothing. This is the default.
  16994. @item ro
  16995. Set all the output frames read-only.
  16996. @item rw
  16997. Set all the output frames directly writable.
  16998. @item toggle
  16999. Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
  17000. @item random
  17001. Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
  17002. @end table
  17003. @item seed
  17004. Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
  17005. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  17006. @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
  17007. basis.
  17008. @end table
  17009. Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
  17010. following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
  17011. following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
  17012. perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
  17013. @section realtime, arealtime
  17014. Slow down filtering to match real time approximately.
  17015. These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
  17016. match the output rate with the input timestamps.
  17017. They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
  17018. They accept the following options:
  17019. @table @option
  17020. @item limit
  17021. Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
  17022. a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
  17023. @item speed
  17024. Speed factor for processing. The value must be a float larger than zero.
  17025. Values larger than 1.0 will result in faster than realtime processing,
  17026. smaller will slow processing down. The @var{limit} is automatically adapted
  17027. accordingly. Default is 1.0.
  17028. A processing speed faster than what is possible without these filters cannot
  17029. be achieved.
  17030. @end table
  17031. @anchor{select}
  17032. @section select, aselect
  17033. Select frames to pass in output.
  17034. This filter accepts the following options:
  17035. @table @option
  17036. @item expr, e
  17037. Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
  17038. If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
  17039. If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
  17040. first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
  17041. @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
  17042. For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
  17043. @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
  17044. @item outputs, n
  17045. Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
  17046. frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
  17047. @end table
  17048. The expression can contain the following constants:
  17049. @table @option
  17050. @item n
  17051. The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
  17052. @item selected_n
  17053. The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
  17054. @item prev_selected_n
  17055. The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17056. @item TB
  17057. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  17058. @item pts
  17059. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  17060. expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
  17061. @item t
  17062. The PTS of the filtered video frame,
  17063. expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  17064. @item prev_pts
  17065. The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17066. @item prev_selected_pts
  17067. The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17068. @item prev_selected_t
  17069. The PTS of the last previously selected video frame, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  17070. @item start_pts
  17071. The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  17072. @item start_t
  17073. The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  17074. @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
  17075. The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
  17076. values:
  17077. @table @option
  17078. @item I
  17079. @item P
  17080. @item B
  17081. @item S
  17082. @item SI
  17083. @item SP
  17084. @item BI
  17085. @end table
  17086. @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
  17087. The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
  17088. @table @option
  17089. @item PROGRESSIVE
  17090. The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
  17091. @item TOPFIRST
  17092. The frame is top-field-first.
  17093. @item BOTTOMFIRST
  17094. The frame is bottom-field-first.
  17095. @end table
  17096. @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
  17097. the number of selected samples before the current frame
  17098. @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
  17099. the number of samples in the current frame
  17100. @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
  17101. the input sample rate
  17102. @item key
  17103. This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
  17104. @item pos
  17105. the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
  17106. is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
  17107. @item scene @emph{(video only)}
  17108. value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  17109. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  17110. value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
  17111. @item concatdec_select
  17112. The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
  17113. inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
  17114. in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
  17115. generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
  17116. interval.
  17117. This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
  17118. and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
  17119. present in the decoded frames.
  17120. The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
  17121. start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
  17122. than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
  17123. missing.
  17124. That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
  17125. interval set by the concat demuxer.
  17126. @end table
  17127. The default value of the select expression is "1".
  17128. @subsection Examples
  17129. @itemize
  17130. @item
  17131. Select all frames in input:
  17132. @example
  17133. select
  17134. @end example
  17135. The example above is the same as:
  17136. @example
  17137. select=1
  17138. @end example
  17139. @item
  17140. Skip all frames:
  17141. @example
  17142. select=0
  17143. @end example
  17144. @item
  17145. Select only I-frames:
  17146. @example
  17147. select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
  17148. @end example
  17149. @item
  17150. Select one frame every 100:
  17151. @example
  17152. select='not(mod(n\,100))'
  17153. @end example
  17154. @item
  17155. Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17156. @example
  17157. select=between(t\,10\,20)
  17158. @end example
  17159. @item
  17160. Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17161. @example
  17162. select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
  17163. @end example
  17164. @item
  17165. Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
  17166. @example
  17167. select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
  17168. @end example
  17169. @item
  17170. Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
  17171. @example
  17172. aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
  17173. @end example
  17174. @item
  17175. Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
  17176. @example
  17177. ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
  17178. @end example
  17179. Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
  17180. choice.
  17181. @item
  17182. Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
  17183. @example
  17184. select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
  17185. @end example
  17186. @item
  17187. Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
  17188. outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
  17189. @example
  17190. ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
  17191. @end example
  17192. @end itemize
  17193. @section sendcmd, asendcmd
  17194. Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
  17195. These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
  17196. filtergraph.
  17197. @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
  17198. @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
  17199. from that they act the same way.
  17200. The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
  17201. with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
  17202. @var{filename} option.
  17203. These filters accept the following options:
  17204. @table @option
  17205. @item commands, c
  17206. Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
  17207. @item filename, f
  17208. Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
  17209. filters.
  17210. @end table
  17211. @subsection Commands syntax
  17212. A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
  17213. specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
  17214. particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
  17215. is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
  17216. interval.
  17217. An interval is specified by the following syntax:
  17218. @example
  17219. @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
  17220. @end example
  17221. The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
  17222. @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
  17223. The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
  17224. it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
  17225. the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
  17226. @var{END}.
  17227. @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
  17228. specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
  17229. syntax of a command specification is given by:
  17230. @example
  17231. [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
  17232. @end example
  17233. @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
  17234. the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
  17235. be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
  17236. enclosed between "[" and "]".
  17237. The following flags are recognized:
  17238. @table @option
  17239. @item enter
  17240. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
  17241. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  17242. previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
  17243. current is.
  17244. @item leave
  17245. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
  17246. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  17247. previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
  17248. current is not.
  17249. @end table
  17250. If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
  17251. assumed.
  17252. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  17253. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  17254. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  17255. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
  17256. the given @var{COMMAND}.
  17257. Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
  17258. sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
  17259. are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
  17260. A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
  17261. follows:
  17262. @example
  17263. @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
  17264. @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
  17265. @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  17266. @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
  17267. @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
  17268. @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
  17269. @end example
  17270. @subsection Examples
  17271. @itemize
  17272. @item
  17273. Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
  17274. @example
  17275. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
  17276. @end example
  17277. @item
  17278. Target a specific filter instance:
  17279. @example
  17280. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo@@my tempo 1.5',atempo@@my
  17281. @end example
  17282. @item
  17283. Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
  17284. @example
  17285. # show text in the interval 5-10
  17286. 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
  17287. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
  17288. # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
  17289. 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
  17290. [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
  17291. [leave] hue s 1,
  17292. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
  17293. # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
  17294. 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
  17295. @end example
  17296. A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
  17297. stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
  17298. @example
  17299. sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
  17300. @end example
  17301. @end itemize
  17302. @anchor{setpts}
  17303. @section setpts, asetpts
  17304. Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
  17305. @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
  17306. This filter accepts the following options:
  17307. @table @option
  17308. @item expr
  17309. The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
  17310. @end table
  17311. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  17312. constants:
  17313. @table @option
  17314. @item FRAME_RATE, FR
  17315. frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
  17316. @item PTS
  17317. The presentation timestamp in input
  17318. @item N
  17319. The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
  17320. not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
  17321. @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
  17322. The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
  17323. audio)
  17324. @item NB_SAMPLES, S
  17325. The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
  17326. @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
  17327. The audio sample rate.
  17328. @item STARTPTS
  17329. The PTS of the first frame.
  17330. @item STARTT
  17331. the time in seconds of the first frame
  17332. @item INTERLACED
  17333. State whether the current frame is interlaced.
  17334. @item T
  17335. the time in seconds of the current frame
  17336. @item POS
  17337. original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  17338. for the current frame
  17339. @item PREV_INPTS
  17340. The previous input PTS.
  17341. @item PREV_INT
  17342. previous input time in seconds
  17343. @item PREV_OUTPTS
  17344. The previous output PTS.
  17345. @item PREV_OUTT
  17346. previous output time in seconds
  17347. @item RTCTIME
  17348. The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
  17349. instead.
  17350. @item RTCSTART
  17351. The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
  17352. @item TB
  17353. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  17354. @end table
  17355. @subsection Examples
  17356. @itemize
  17357. @item
  17358. Start counting PTS from zero
  17359. @example
  17360. setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
  17361. @end example
  17362. @item
  17363. Apply fast motion effect:
  17364. @example
  17365. setpts=0.5*PTS
  17366. @end example
  17367. @item
  17368. Apply slow motion effect:
  17369. @example
  17370. setpts=2.0*PTS
  17371. @end example
  17372. @item
  17373. Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
  17374. @example
  17375. setpts=N/(25*TB)
  17376. @end example
  17377. @item
  17378. Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
  17379. @example
  17380. setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
  17381. @end example
  17382. @item
  17383. Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
  17384. @example
  17385. setpts=PTS+10/TB
  17386. @end example
  17387. @item
  17388. Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
  17389. @example
  17390. setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
  17391. @end example
  17392. @item
  17393. Generate timestamps by counting samples:
  17394. @example
  17395. asetpts=N/SR/TB
  17396. @end example
  17397. @end itemize
  17398. @section setrange
  17399. Force color range for the output video frame.
  17400. The @code{setrange} filter marks the color range property for the
  17401. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  17402. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  17403. following filters.
  17404. The filter accepts the following options:
  17405. @table @option
  17406. @item range
  17407. Available values are:
  17408. @table @samp
  17409. @item auto
  17410. Keep the same color range property.
  17411. @item unspecified, unknown
  17412. Set the color range as unspecified.
  17413. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  17414. Set the color range as limited.
  17415. @item full, pc, jpeg
  17416. Set the color range as full.
  17417. @end table
  17418. @end table
  17419. @section settb, asettb
  17420. Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
  17421. It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
  17422. It accepts the following parameters:
  17423. @table @option
  17424. @item expr, tb
  17425. The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
  17426. @end table
  17427. The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
  17428. rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
  17429. timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
  17430. audio only). Default value is "intb".
  17431. @subsection Examples
  17432. @itemize
  17433. @item
  17434. Set the timebase to 1/25:
  17435. @example
  17436. settb=expr=1/25
  17437. @end example
  17438. @item
  17439. Set the timebase to 1/10:
  17440. @example
  17441. settb=expr=0.1
  17442. @end example
  17443. @item
  17444. Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
  17445. @example
  17446. settb=1+0.001
  17447. @end example
  17448. @item
  17449. Set the timebase to 2*intb:
  17450. @example
  17451. settb=2*intb
  17452. @end example
  17453. @item
  17454. Set the default timebase value:
  17455. @example
  17456. settb=AVTB
  17457. @end example
  17458. @end itemize
  17459. @section showcqt
  17460. Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
  17461. logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
  17462. direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
  17463. is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
  17464. with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
  17465. The filter accepts the following options:
  17466. @table @option
  17467. @item size, s
  17468. Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
  17469. check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17470. Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
  17471. @item fps, rate, r
  17472. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17473. @item bar_h
  17474. Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  17475. computes the bargraph height automatically.
  17476. @item axis_h
  17477. Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
  17478. the axis height automatically.
  17479. @item sono_h
  17480. Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  17481. computes the sonogram height automatically.
  17482. @item fullhd
  17483. Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
  17484. instead. Default value is @code{1}.
  17485. @item sono_v, volume
  17486. Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
  17487. @table @option
  17488. @item bar_v
  17489. the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
  17490. @item frequency, freq, f
  17491. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17492. @item timeclamp, tc
  17493. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  17494. @end table
  17495. and functions:
  17496. @table @option
  17497. @item a_weighting(f)
  17498. A-weighting of equal loudness
  17499. @item b_weighting(f)
  17500. B-weighting of equal loudness
  17501. @item c_weighting(f)
  17502. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  17503. @end table
  17504. Default value is @code{16}.
  17505. @item bar_v, volume2
  17506. Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
  17507. @table @option
  17508. @item sono_v
  17509. the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
  17510. @item frequency, freq, f
  17511. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17512. @item timeclamp, tc
  17513. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  17514. @end table
  17515. and functions:
  17516. @table @option
  17517. @item a_weighting(f)
  17518. A-weighting of equal loudness
  17519. @item b_weighting(f)
  17520. B-weighting of equal loudness
  17521. @item c_weighting(f)
  17522. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  17523. @end table
  17524. Default value is @code{sono_v}.
  17525. @item sono_g, gamma
  17526. Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
  17527. higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
  17528. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
  17529. @item bar_g, gamma2
  17530. Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
  17531. @code{[1, 7]}.
  17532. @item bar_t
  17533. Specify the bargraph transparency level. Lower value makes the bargraph sharper.
  17534. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  17535. @item timeclamp, tc
  17536. Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
  17537. accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
  17538. event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
  17539. otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
  17540. (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.002, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
  17541. @item attack
  17542. Set attack time in seconds. The default is @code{0} (disabled). Otherwise, it
  17543. limits future samples by applying asymmetric windowing in time domain, useful
  17544. when low latency is required. Accepted range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  17545. @item basefreq
  17546. Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
  17547. which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  17548. @item endfreq
  17549. Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
  17550. which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  17551. @item coeffclamp
  17552. This option is deprecated and ignored.
  17553. @item tlength
  17554. Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
  17555. trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
  17556. It can contain variables:
  17557. @table @option
  17558. @item frequency, freq, f
  17559. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17560. @item timeclamp, tc
  17561. the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
  17562. @end table
  17563. Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
  17564. @item count
  17565. Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
  17566. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
  17567. @item fcount
  17568. Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
  17569. which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  17570. @item fontfile
  17571. Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
  17572. use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
  17573. implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
  17574. option instead.
  17575. @item font
  17576. Specify fontconfig pattern. This has lower priority than @var{fontfile}. The
  17577. @code{:} in the pattern may be replaced by @code{|} to avoid unnecessary
  17578. escaping.
  17579. @item fontcolor
  17580. Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
  17581. integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
  17582. @table @option
  17583. @item frequency, freq, f
  17584. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17585. @item timeclamp, tc
  17586. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  17587. @end table
  17588. and functions:
  17589. @table @option
  17590. @item midi(f)
  17591. midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
  17592. @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
  17593. red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
  17594. @end table
  17595. Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
  17596. st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
  17597. r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
  17598. @item axisfile
  17599. Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
  17600. @var{fontcolor} option.
  17601. @item axis, text
  17602. Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
  17603. the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
  17604. Default value is @code{1}.
  17605. @item csp
  17606. Set colorspace. The accepted values are:
  17607. @table @samp
  17608. @item unspecified
  17609. Unspecified (default)
  17610. @item bt709
  17611. BT.709
  17612. @item fcc
  17613. FCC
  17614. @item bt470bg
  17615. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  17616. @item smpte170m
  17617. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  17618. @item smpte240m
  17619. SMPTE-240M
  17620. @item bt2020ncl
  17621. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  17622. @end table
  17623. @item cscheme
  17624. Set spectrogram color scheme. This is list of floating point values with format
  17625. @code{left_r|left_g|left_b|right_r|right_g|right_b}.
  17626. The default is @code{1|0.5|0|0|0.5|1}.
  17627. @end table
  17628. @subsection Examples
  17629. @itemize
  17630. @item
  17631. Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
  17632. @example
  17633. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  17634. @end example
  17635. @item
  17636. Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
  17637. @example
  17638. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
  17639. @end example
  17640. @item
  17641. Playing at 1280x720:
  17642. @example
  17643. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
  17644. @end example
  17645. @item
  17646. Disable sonogram display:
  17647. @example
  17648. sono_h=0
  17649. @end example
  17650. @item
  17651. A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
  17652. @example
  17653. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  17654. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  17655. @end example
  17656. @item
  17657. Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
  17658. @example
  17659. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  17660. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
  17661. @end example
  17662. @item
  17663. Custom volume:
  17664. @example
  17665. bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
  17666. @end example
  17667. @item
  17668. Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
  17669. @example
  17670. bar_g=2:sono_g=2
  17671. @end example
  17672. @item
  17673. Custom tlength equation:
  17674. @example
  17675. tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
  17676. @end example
  17677. @item
  17678. Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
  17679. @example
  17680. fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
  17681. @end example
  17682. @item
  17683. Custom font using fontconfig:
  17684. @example
  17685. font='Courier New,Monospace,mono|bold'
  17686. @end example
  17687. @item
  17688. Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
  17689. @example
  17690. axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
  17691. @end example
  17692. @end itemize
  17693. @section showfreqs
  17694. Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
  17695. Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
  17696. The filter accepts the following options:
  17697. @table @option
  17698. @item size, s
  17699. Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17700. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17701. Default is @code{1024x512}.
  17702. @item mode
  17703. Set display mode.
  17704. This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
  17705. It accepts the following values:
  17706. @table @samp
  17707. @item line
  17708. @item bar
  17709. @item dot
  17710. @end table
  17711. Default is @code{bar}.
  17712. @item ascale
  17713. Set amplitude scale.
  17714. It accepts the following values:
  17715. @table @samp
  17716. @item lin
  17717. Linear scale.
  17718. @item sqrt
  17719. Square root scale.
  17720. @item cbrt
  17721. Cubic root scale.
  17722. @item log
  17723. Logarithmic scale.
  17724. @end table
  17725. Default is @code{log}.
  17726. @item fscale
  17727. Set frequency scale.
  17728. It accepts the following values:
  17729. @table @samp
  17730. @item lin
  17731. Linear scale.
  17732. @item log
  17733. Logarithmic scale.
  17734. @item rlog
  17735. Reverse logarithmic scale.
  17736. @end table
  17737. Default is @code{lin}.
  17738. @item win_size
  17739. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 65536.
  17740. Default is @code{2048}
  17741. @item win_func
  17742. Set windowing function.
  17743. It accepts the following values:
  17744. @table @samp
  17745. @item rect
  17746. @item bartlett
  17747. @item hanning
  17748. @item hamming
  17749. @item blackman
  17750. @item welch
  17751. @item flattop
  17752. @item bharris
  17753. @item bnuttall
  17754. @item bhann
  17755. @item sine
  17756. @item nuttall
  17757. @item lanczos
  17758. @item gauss
  17759. @item tukey
  17760. @item dolph
  17761. @item cauchy
  17762. @item parzen
  17763. @item poisson
  17764. @item bohman
  17765. @end table
  17766. Default is @code{hanning}.
  17767. @item overlap
  17768. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  17769. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  17770. @item averaging
  17771. Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
  17772. Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
  17773. @item colors
  17774. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  17775. draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  17776. by white color.
  17777. @item cmode
  17778. Set channel display mode.
  17779. It accepts the following values:
  17780. @table @samp
  17781. @item combined
  17782. @item separate
  17783. @end table
  17784. Default is @code{combined}.
  17785. @item minamp
  17786. Set minimum amplitude used in @code{log} amplitude scaler.
  17787. @end table
  17788. @section showspatial
  17789. Convert stereo input audio to a video output, representing the spatial relationship
  17790. between two channels.
  17791. The filter accepts the following options:
  17792. @table @option
  17793. @item size, s
  17794. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17795. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17796. Default value is @code{512x512}.
  17797. @item win_size
  17798. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  17799. @item win_func
  17800. Set window function.
  17801. It accepts the following values:
  17802. @table @samp
  17803. @item rect
  17804. @item bartlett
  17805. @item hann
  17806. @item hanning
  17807. @item hamming
  17808. @item blackman
  17809. @item welch
  17810. @item flattop
  17811. @item bharris
  17812. @item bnuttall
  17813. @item bhann
  17814. @item sine
  17815. @item nuttall
  17816. @item lanczos
  17817. @item gauss
  17818. @item tukey
  17819. @item dolph
  17820. @item cauchy
  17821. @item parzen
  17822. @item poisson
  17823. @item bohman
  17824. @end table
  17825. Default value is @code{hann}.
  17826. @item overlap
  17827. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  17828. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  17829. window function currently used.
  17830. @end table
  17831. @anchor{showspectrum}
  17832. @section showspectrum
  17833. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
  17834. spectrum.
  17835. The filter accepts the following options:
  17836. @table @option
  17837. @item size, s
  17838. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17839. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17840. Default value is @code{640x512}.
  17841. @item slide
  17842. Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
  17843. It accepts the following values:
  17844. @table @samp
  17845. @item replace
  17846. the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
  17847. @item scroll
  17848. the samples scroll from right to left
  17849. @item fullframe
  17850. frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
  17851. @item rscroll
  17852. the samples scroll from left to right
  17853. @end table
  17854. Default value is @code{replace}.
  17855. @item mode
  17856. Specify display mode.
  17857. It accepts the following values:
  17858. @table @samp
  17859. @item combined
  17860. all channels are displayed in the same row
  17861. @item separate
  17862. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  17863. @end table
  17864. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  17865. @item color
  17866. Specify display color mode.
  17867. It accepts the following values:
  17868. @table @samp
  17869. @item channel
  17870. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  17871. @item intensity
  17872. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  17873. @item rainbow
  17874. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  17875. @item moreland
  17876. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  17877. @item nebulae
  17878. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  17879. @item fire
  17880. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  17881. @item fiery
  17882. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  17883. @item fruit
  17884. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  17885. @item cool
  17886. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  17887. @item magma
  17888. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  17889. @item green
  17890. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  17891. @item viridis
  17892. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  17893. @item plasma
  17894. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  17895. @item cividis
  17896. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  17897. @item terrain
  17898. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  17899. @end table
  17900. Default value is @samp{channel}.
  17901. @item scale
  17902. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  17903. It accepts the following values:
  17904. @table @samp
  17905. @item lin
  17906. linear
  17907. @item sqrt
  17908. square root, default
  17909. @item cbrt
  17910. cubic root
  17911. @item log
  17912. logarithmic
  17913. @item 4thrt
  17914. 4th root
  17915. @item 5thrt
  17916. 5th root
  17917. @end table
  17918. Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
  17919. @item fscale
  17920. Specify frequency scale.
  17921. It accepts the following values:
  17922. @table @samp
  17923. @item lin
  17924. linear
  17925. @item log
  17926. logarithmic
  17927. @end table
  17928. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  17929. @item saturation
  17930. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  17931. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  17932. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  17933. Default value is @code{1}.
  17934. @item win_func
  17935. Set window function.
  17936. It accepts the following values:
  17937. @table @samp
  17938. @item rect
  17939. @item bartlett
  17940. @item hann
  17941. @item hanning
  17942. @item hamming
  17943. @item blackman
  17944. @item welch
  17945. @item flattop
  17946. @item bharris
  17947. @item bnuttall
  17948. @item bhann
  17949. @item sine
  17950. @item nuttall
  17951. @item lanczos
  17952. @item gauss
  17953. @item tukey
  17954. @item dolph
  17955. @item cauchy
  17956. @item parzen
  17957. @item poisson
  17958. @item bohman
  17959. @end table
  17960. Default value is @code{hann}.
  17961. @item orientation
  17962. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  17963. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  17964. @item overlap
  17965. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
  17966. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  17967. window function currently used.
  17968. @item gain
  17969. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  17970. Default value is @code{1}.
  17971. @item data
  17972. Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
  17973. @item rotation
  17974. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  17975. Default value is @code{0}.
  17976. @item start
  17977. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  17978. @item stop
  17979. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  17980. @item fps
  17981. Set upper frame rate limit. Default is @code{auto}, unlimited.
  17982. @item legend
  17983. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is disabled.
  17984. @end table
  17985. The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
  17986. section.
  17987. @subsection Examples
  17988. @itemize
  17989. @item
  17990. Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
  17991. @example
  17992. showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
  17993. @end example
  17994. @item
  17995. Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
  17996. @example
  17997. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  17998. [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
  17999. @end example
  18000. @end itemize
  18001. @section showspectrumpic
  18002. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
  18003. spectrum.
  18004. The filter accepts the following options:
  18005. @table @option
  18006. @item size, s
  18007. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18008. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18009. Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
  18010. @item mode
  18011. Specify display mode.
  18012. It accepts the following values:
  18013. @table @samp
  18014. @item combined
  18015. all channels are displayed in the same row
  18016. @item separate
  18017. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  18018. @end table
  18019. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  18020. @item color
  18021. Specify display color mode.
  18022. It accepts the following values:
  18023. @table @samp
  18024. @item channel
  18025. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  18026. @item intensity
  18027. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  18028. @item rainbow
  18029. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  18030. @item moreland
  18031. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  18032. @item nebulae
  18033. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  18034. @item fire
  18035. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  18036. @item fiery
  18037. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  18038. @item fruit
  18039. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  18040. @item cool
  18041. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  18042. @item magma
  18043. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  18044. @item green
  18045. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  18046. @item viridis
  18047. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  18048. @item plasma
  18049. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  18050. @item cividis
  18051. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  18052. @item terrain
  18053. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  18054. @end table
  18055. Default value is @samp{intensity}.
  18056. @item scale
  18057. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  18058. It accepts the following values:
  18059. @table @samp
  18060. @item lin
  18061. linear
  18062. @item sqrt
  18063. square root, default
  18064. @item cbrt
  18065. cubic root
  18066. @item log
  18067. logarithmic
  18068. @item 4thrt
  18069. 4th root
  18070. @item 5thrt
  18071. 5th root
  18072. @end table
  18073. Default value is @samp{log}.
  18074. @item fscale
  18075. Specify frequency scale.
  18076. It accepts the following values:
  18077. @table @samp
  18078. @item lin
  18079. linear
  18080. @item log
  18081. logarithmic
  18082. @end table
  18083. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  18084. @item saturation
  18085. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  18086. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  18087. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  18088. Default value is @code{1}.
  18089. @item win_func
  18090. Set window function.
  18091. It accepts the following values:
  18092. @table @samp
  18093. @item rect
  18094. @item bartlett
  18095. @item hann
  18096. @item hanning
  18097. @item hamming
  18098. @item blackman
  18099. @item welch
  18100. @item flattop
  18101. @item bharris
  18102. @item bnuttall
  18103. @item bhann
  18104. @item sine
  18105. @item nuttall
  18106. @item lanczos
  18107. @item gauss
  18108. @item tukey
  18109. @item dolph
  18110. @item cauchy
  18111. @item parzen
  18112. @item poisson
  18113. @item bohman
  18114. @end table
  18115. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18116. @item orientation
  18117. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  18118. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18119. @item gain
  18120. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  18121. Default value is @code{1}.
  18122. @item legend
  18123. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
  18124. @item rotation
  18125. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  18126. Default value is @code{0}.
  18127. @item start
  18128. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18129. @item stop
  18130. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18131. @end table
  18132. @subsection Examples
  18133. @itemize
  18134. @item
  18135. Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
  18136. in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  18137. @example
  18138. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
  18139. @end example
  18140. @end itemize
  18141. @section showvolume
  18142. Convert input audio volume to a video output.
  18143. The filter accepts the following options:
  18144. @table @option
  18145. @item rate, r
  18146. Set video rate.
  18147. @item b
  18148. Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
  18149. @item w
  18150. Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.
  18151. @item h
  18152. Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.
  18153. @item f
  18154. Set fade, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.95.
  18155. @item c
  18156. Set volume color expression.
  18157. The expression can use the following variables:
  18158. @table @option
  18159. @item VOLUME
  18160. Current max volume of channel in dB.
  18161. @item PEAK
  18162. Current peak.
  18163. @item CHANNEL
  18164. Current channel number, starting from 0.
  18165. @end table
  18166. @item t
  18167. If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
  18168. @item v
  18169. If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
  18170. @item o
  18171. Set orientation, can be horizontal: @code{h} or vertical: @code{v},
  18172. default is @code{h}.
  18173. @item s
  18174. Set step size, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means
  18175. step is disabled.
  18176. @item p
  18177. Set background opacity, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.
  18178. @item m
  18179. Set metering mode, can be peak: @code{p} or rms: @code{r},
  18180. default is @code{p}.
  18181. @item ds
  18182. Set display scale, can be linear: @code{lin} or log: @code{log},
  18183. default is @code{lin}.
  18184. @item dm
  18185. In second.
  18186. If set to > 0., display a line for the max level
  18187. in the previous seconds.
  18188. default is disabled: @code{0.}
  18189. @item dmc
  18190. The color of the max line. Use when @code{dm} option is set to > 0.
  18191. default is: @code{orange}
  18192. @end table
  18193. @section showwaves
  18194. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
  18195. The filter accepts the following options:
  18196. @table @option
  18197. @item size, s
  18198. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18199. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18200. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  18201. @item mode
  18202. Set display mode.
  18203. Available values are:
  18204. @table @samp
  18205. @item point
  18206. Draw a point for each sample.
  18207. @item line
  18208. Draw a vertical line for each sample.
  18209. @item p2p
  18210. Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
  18211. @item cline
  18212. Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
  18213. @end table
  18214. Default value is @code{point}.
  18215. @item n
  18216. Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
  18217. larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
  18218. integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
  18219. is not explicitly specified.
  18220. @item rate, r
  18221. Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
  18222. option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
  18223. @item split_channels
  18224. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  18225. @item colors
  18226. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  18227. @item scale
  18228. Set amplitude scale.
  18229. Available values are:
  18230. @table @samp
  18231. @item lin
  18232. Linear.
  18233. @item log
  18234. Logarithmic.
  18235. @item sqrt
  18236. Square root.
  18237. @item cbrt
  18238. Cubic root.
  18239. @end table
  18240. Default is linear.
  18241. @item draw
  18242. Set the draw mode. This is mostly useful to set for high @var{n}.
  18243. Available values are:
  18244. @table @samp
  18245. @item scale
  18246. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  18247. @item full
  18248. Draw every sample directly.
  18249. @end table
  18250. Default value is @code{scale}.
  18251. @end table
  18252. @subsection Examples
  18253. @itemize
  18254. @item
  18255. Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
  18256. at the same time:
  18257. @example
  18258. amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
  18259. @end example
  18260. @item
  18261. Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
  18262. frame rate of 30 frames per second:
  18263. @example
  18264. aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
  18265. @end example
  18266. @end itemize
  18267. @section showwavespic
  18268. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
  18269. The filter accepts the following options:
  18270. @table @option
  18271. @item size, s
  18272. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18273. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18274. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  18275. @item split_channels
  18276. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  18277. @item colors
  18278. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  18279. @item scale
  18280. Set amplitude scale.
  18281. Available values are:
  18282. @table @samp
  18283. @item lin
  18284. Linear.
  18285. @item log
  18286. Logarithmic.
  18287. @item sqrt
  18288. Square root.
  18289. @item cbrt
  18290. Cubic root.
  18291. @end table
  18292. Default is linear.
  18293. @item draw
  18294. Set the draw mode.
  18295. Available values are:
  18296. @table @samp
  18297. @item scale
  18298. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  18299. @item full
  18300. Draw every sample directly.
  18301. @end table
  18302. Default value is @code{scale}.
  18303. @end table
  18304. @subsection Examples
  18305. @itemize
  18306. @item
  18307. Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
  18308. in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  18309. @example
  18310. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
  18311. @end example
  18312. @end itemize
  18313. @section sidedata, asidedata
  18314. Delete frame side data, or select frames based on it.
  18315. This filter accepts the following options:
  18316. @table @option
  18317. @item mode
  18318. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  18319. Can be one of the following:
  18320. @table @samp
  18321. @item select
  18322. Select every frame with side data of @code{type}.
  18323. @item delete
  18324. Delete side data of @code{type}. If @code{type} is not set, delete all side
  18325. data in the frame.
  18326. @end table
  18327. @item type
  18328. Set side data type used with all modes. Must be set for @code{select} mode. For
  18329. the list of frame side data types, refer to the @code{AVFrameSideDataType} enum
  18330. in @file{libavutil/frame.h}. For example, to choose
  18331. @code{AV_FRAME_DATA_PANSCAN} side data, you must specify @code{PANSCAN}.
  18332. @end table
  18333. @section spectrumsynth
  18334. Synthesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
  18335. magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
  18336. The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
  18337. to time domain as presented in audio output.
  18338. This filter is primarily created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
  18339. filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
  18340. But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
  18341. available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
  18342. it's just recreated from random noise.
  18343. For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
  18344. @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
  18345. @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
  18346. @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
  18347. slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
  18348. The filter accepts the following options:
  18349. @table @option
  18350. @item sample_rate
  18351. Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
  18352. spectrum was generated may differ.
  18353. @item channels
  18354. Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
  18355. @item scale
  18356. Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
  18357. Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
  18358. @item slide
  18359. Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
  18360. Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
  18361. Default is @code{fullframe}.
  18362. @item win_func
  18363. Set window function used for resynthesis.
  18364. @item overlap
  18365. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  18366. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  18367. @item orientation
  18368. Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
  18369. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18370. @end table
  18371. @subsection Examples
  18372. @itemize
  18373. @item
  18374. First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
  18375. then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
  18376. @example
  18377. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
  18378. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
  18379. ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
  18380. @end example
  18381. @end itemize
  18382. @section split, asplit
  18383. Split input into several identical outputs.
  18384. @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
  18385. The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
  18386. unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  18387. @subsection Examples
  18388. @itemize
  18389. @item
  18390. Create two separate outputs from the same input:
  18391. @example
  18392. [in] split [out0][out1]
  18393. @end example
  18394. @item
  18395. To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
  18396. outputs, like in:
  18397. @example
  18398. [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
  18399. @end example
  18400. @item
  18401. Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
  18402. one padded:
  18403. @example
  18404. [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
  18405. [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
  18406. [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
  18407. @end example
  18408. @item
  18409. Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
  18410. @example
  18411. ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
  18412. @end example
  18413. @end itemize
  18414. @section zmq, azmq
  18415. Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
  18416. filters in the filtergraph.
  18417. @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
  18418. must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
  18419. audio filters. Both are capable to send messages to any filter type.
  18420. To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
  18421. headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
  18422. For more information about libzmq see:
  18423. @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
  18424. The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
  18425. receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
  18426. @option{bind_address} (or the abbreviation "@option{b}") option.
  18427. Default value of this option is @file{tcp://localhost:5555}. You may
  18428. want to alter this value to your needs, but do not forget to escape any
  18429. ':' signs (see @ref{filtergraph escaping}).
  18430. The received message must be in the form:
  18431. @example
  18432. @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  18433. @end example
  18434. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  18435. the filter class or a specific filter instance name. The default
  18436. filter instance name uses the pattern @samp{Parsed_<filter_name>_<index>},
  18437. but you can override this by using the @samp{filter_name@@id} syntax
  18438. (see @ref{Filtergraph syntax}).
  18439. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  18440. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
  18441. given @var{COMMAND}.
  18442. Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
  18443. is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
  18444. will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
  18445. @example
  18446. @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
  18447. @var{MESSAGE}
  18448. @end example
  18449. @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
  18450. @subsection Examples
  18451. Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
  18452. be used to send commands processed by these filters.
  18453. Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}.
  18454. In this example the last overlay filter has an instance name. All other
  18455. filters will have default instance names.
  18456. @example
  18457. ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
  18458. color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
  18459. color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
  18460. nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
  18461. [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
  18462. [bg+l][r] overlay@@my=x=100 "
  18463. @end example
  18464. To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
  18465. command can be used:
  18466. @example
  18467. echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
  18468. @end example
  18469. To change the right side:
  18470. @example
  18471. echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
  18472. @end example
  18473. To change the position of the right side:
  18474. @example
  18475. echo overlay@@my x 150 | tools/zmqsend
  18476. @end example
  18477. @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  18478. @chapter Multimedia Sources
  18479. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
  18480. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
  18481. @section amovie
  18482. This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
  18483. stream by default.
  18484. @anchor{movie}
  18485. @section movie
  18486. Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
  18487. It accepts the following parameters:
  18488. @table @option
  18489. @item filename
  18490. The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
  18491. device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
  18492. @item format_name, f
  18493. Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
  18494. the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
  18495. format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
  18496. @item seek_point, sp
  18497. Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
  18498. starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
  18499. @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
  18500. postfix. The default value is "0".
  18501. @item streams, s
  18502. Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
  18503. separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
  18504. same order. The syntax is explained in the @ref{Stream specifiers,,"Stream specifiers"
  18505. section in the ffmpeg manual,ffmpeg}. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
  18506. respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
  18507. is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
  18508. @item stream_index, si
  18509. Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
  18510. the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
  18511. value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
  18512. audio instead of video.
  18513. @item loop
  18514. Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
  18515. If the value is 0, the stream will be looped infinitely.
  18516. Default value is "1".
  18517. Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
  18518. changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
  18519. @item discontinuity
  18520. Specifies the time difference between frames above which the point is
  18521. considered a timestamp discontinuity which is removed by adjusting the later
  18522. timestamps.
  18523. @end table
  18524. It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
  18525. a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
  18526. @example
  18527. input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
  18528. ^
  18529. |
  18530. movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
  18531. @end example
  18532. @subsection Examples
  18533. @itemize
  18534. @item
  18535. Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
  18536. on top of the input labelled "in":
  18537. @example
  18538. movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  18539. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  18540. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  18541. @end example
  18542. @item
  18543. Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
  18544. labelled "in":
  18545. @example
  18546. movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  18547. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  18548. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  18549. @end example
  18550. @item
  18551. Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
  18552. dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
  18553. connected to the pad named "audio":
  18554. @example
  18555. movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
  18556. @end example
  18557. @end itemize
  18558. @subsection Commands
  18559. Both movie and amovie support the following commands:
  18560. @table @option
  18561. @item seek
  18562. Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".
  18563. The syntax is: seek @var{stream_index}|@var{timestamp}|@var{flags}
  18564. @itemize
  18565. @item
  18566. @var{stream_index}: If stream_index is -1, a default
  18567. stream is selected, and @var{timestamp} is automatically converted
  18568. from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.
  18569. @item
  18570. @var{timestamp}: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
  18571. or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  18572. @item
  18573. @var{flags}: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.
  18574. @end itemize
  18575. @item get_duration
  18576. Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  18577. @end table
  18578. @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES